Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 25, 2005
Registration No. 333-127375
 
 
UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
Amendment No. 4
to
Form S-1
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
CLEAR CHANNEL OUTDOOR HOLDINGS, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
         
Delaware   7312   86-0812139
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  (Primary standard industrial
classification code number)
  (I.R.S. employer
identification number)
200 East Basse Road
San Antonio, Texas 78209
(210) 832-3700
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number,
including area code, of registrant’s principal executive offices)
 
Mark P. Mays
Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
200 East Basse Road
San Antonio, Texas 78209
(210) 832-3700
(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number,
including area code, of agent for service)
 
Copies to:
     
Daryl L. Lansdale, Jr., Esq.
Fulbright & Jaworski L.L.P.
300 Convent Street, Suite 2200
San Antonio, Texas 78205
Telephone: (210) 224-5575
Facsimile: (210) 270-7205
  John W. White, Esq.
Cravath, Swaine & Moore LLP
825 Eighth Avenue
New York, New York 10019
Telephone: (212) 474-1000
Facsimile: (212) 474-3700
      Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after this registration statement becomes effective.
      If any of the securities being registered on this form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act, check the following box.     o
      If this form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.     o
      If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.     o
      If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.     o
      If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434, check the following box.     o
 
CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
             
             
             
Title of Each Class of     Proposed Maximum     Amount of
Securities to be Registered     Offering Price(1)(2)     Registration Fee
             
Class A Common Stock, $0.01 par value per share
    $350,000,000     $41,195(3)
             
             
(1)  Includes shares to be sold upon exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock. See “Underwriting.”
 
(2)  Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee under Rule 457(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
 
(3)  Previously paid.
          The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the commission acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.
 
 


Table of Contents

The information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any state where the offer or sale is not permitted.

SUBJECT TO COMPLETION. DATED OCTOBER 25, 2005.
CLEAR CHANNEL OUTDOOR LOGO
                             Shares
Class A Common Stock
 
     This is the initial public offering of shares of Class A common stock of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. All of the                    shares are being sold by us. We intend to use all of the net proceeds from this offering to repay a portion of the outstanding intercompany indebtedness owed to our parent company, Clear Channel Communications, Inc. See “Use of Proceeds.”
     Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the shares of Class A common stock. It is currently estimated that the initial public offering price per share will be between $         and $         . We intend to list the shares of Class A common stock on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “CCO.”
     We are an indirect, wholly owned subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications and have two classes of common stock outstanding: Class A common stock and Class B common stock. After this offering, Clear Channel Communications will own all of our outstanding shares of Class B common stock, representing approximately          % of the outstanding shares of our common stock and approximately          % of the total voting power of our common stock, or approximately          % and          %, respectively, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock. The rights of the Class A common stock and the Class B common stock are substantially similar, except with respect to voting, conversion and transferability. Our Class A common stock and Class B common stock vote as a single class on all matters on which stockholders are entitled to vote, except as otherwise provided in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or as required by law. Each share of Class A common stock entitles its holder to one vote and each share of Class B common stock entitles its holder to 20 votes.
     See “Risk Factors” beginning on page 13 to read about factors you should consider before deciding to invest in shares of our Class A common stock.
 
     Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any other regulatory body has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the accuracy or adequacy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.
 
                 
    Per Share   Total
         
Initial public offering price
  $       $    
Underwriting discount
  $       $    
Proceeds, before expenses, to us
  $       $    
     To the extent that the underwriters sell more than                    shares of Class A common stock, the underwriters have the option to purchase up to an additional                    shares of Class A common stock from us at the initial public offering price, less the underwriting discount. To the extent the underwriters do not exercise this option in full, we intend to exchange up to                  additional shares of Class B common stock with Clear Channel Communications for the portion of the intercompany indebtedness owed by us to Clear Channel Communications that the proceeds from the exercise of such option otherwise would have been used to repay.
 
     The underwriters expect to deliver the shares of Class A common stock against payment in New York, New York on                   , 2005.
Global Coordinator & Senior Bookrunner
Goldman, Sachs & Co.
Joint Bookrunners
Deutsche Bank Securities
                       JPMorgan
  Merrill Lynch & Co.
  UBS Investment Bank
Co-Managers
Banc of America Securities LLC
              Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc.
  Credit Suisse First Boston
Allen & Company LLC Barrington Research
Harris Nesbitt SunTrust Robinson Humphrey Wachovia Securities
 
Prospectus dated                     , 2005.


Table of Contents

(MAP OF OUR DOMESTIC MARKETS)
      See inside back cover for a map of our international markets.
      The information contained in this prospectus contains references to certain trademarks and registered marks. The trademark Adshel tm is owned by us.


Table of Contents

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
      This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this prospectus and provides an overview of the material aspects of this offering. This summary does not contain all of the information you should consider before deciding to invest in shares of our Class A common stock. You should read this entire prospectus carefully, especially the risks of investing in shares of our Class A common stock discussed under “Risk Factors” beginning on page 13. Except as otherwise noted, we present all financial and operating data on fiscal year and fiscal quarter bases. Our fiscal year ends on December 31 of each year.
      Unless the context otherwise requires, references in this prospectus to “Clear Channel Communications” shall mean Clear Channel Communications, Inc. and its combined subsidiaries (other than us).
      Prior to the completion of this offering, Clear Channel Communications will, and will cause its affiliates to, transfer to us certain assets related to our business not currently owned by us. We or our subsidiaries will assume and agree to perform, discharge and fulfill certain liabilities related to our business. In this prospectus, the description of our business includes these assets and liabilities as if such assets and liabilities were ours for all historical periods described herein. Our historical financial results as part of Clear Channel Communications may not reflect our financial results in the future as an independent publicly traded company or what our financial results would have been had we operated as an independent publicly traded company during the periods presented.
Our Business
      Our principal business is to provide our clients with advertising opportunities through billboards, street furniture displays, transit displays and other out-of-home advertising displays, such as wallscapes, spectaculars and mall displays, that we own or operate in key markets worldwide. As of September 30, 2005, we owned or operated more than 870,000 advertising displays worldwide. For the year ended December 31, 2004, we generated revenues of approximately $2.4 billion, operating income of approximately $243.3 million and operating income before depreciation, amortization and non-cash compensation expense, or OIBDAN, of approximately $631.6 million. Our domestic reporting segment consists of our operations in the United States, Canada and Latin America, with approximately 95% of our 2004 revenues in this segment derived from the United States. Our international reporting segment consists of our operations in Europe, Australia, Asia and Africa, with approximately 52% of our 2004 revenues in this segment derived from France and the United Kingdom. Approximately 89% of our total 2004 operating income excluding corporate expenses was derived from our domestic segment and approximately 11% was derived from our international segment. Approximately 66% of our total 2004 OIBDAN excluding corporate expenses was derived from our domestic segment and approximately 34% was derived from our international segment. See “— Summary Historical and Pro Forma Combined Financial Data — Non-GAAP Financial Measure” for an explanation of OIBDAN and a reconciliation of OIBDAN to operating income (loss). Additionally, we own equity interests in various out-of-home advertising companies worldwide, which we account for under the equity method of accounting.
      Billboard displays are bulletin and poster advertising panels of various sizes that generally are mounted on structures we own. We believe that many of our billboards are strategically located to offer maximum visual impact to audiences. Larger billboards generally are located along major highways and freeways to target vehicular traffic. Smaller billboards generally are located on city streets to target both vehicular and pedestrian traffic.
      Street furniture displays, marketed under our global Adshel tm brand, are advertising surfaces on bus shelters, information kiosks, public toilets, freestanding units and other public structures. Generally, we own the street furniture structures and are responsible for their construction and maintenance. Contracts for the right to place our street furniture structures in the public domain and sell advertising space on them are awarded by municipal and transit authorities in competitive bidding processes. We believe that street furniture is growing in popularity with municipal and transit authorities, especially in international and larger U.S. markets.

1


Table of Contents

      Transit displays are advertising surfaces on various types of vehicles or within transit systems, including on the interior and exterior sides of buses, trains, trams and taxis and within the common areas of rail stations and airports. Contracts for the right to place our displays on vehicles or within transit systems and sell advertising space on them are awarded by public transit authorities in competitive bidding processes or are negotiated with private transit operators.
      We generate revenues worldwide from local, regional and national sales. Advertising rates generally are based on the “gross rating points,” or total number of impressions delivered expressed as a percentage of a market population, of a display or group of displays. The number of “impressions” delivered by a display is measured by the number of people passing the site during a defined period of time and, in some international markets, is weighted to account for such factors as illumination, proximity to other displays and the speed and viewing angle of approaching traffic. While price and availability of displays are important competitive factors, we believe that providing quality customer service and establishing strong client relationships are also critical components of sales.
Our Competitive Strengths
      We believe our key competitive strengths are as follows:
  •  We believe that our presence in key markets gives our clients the ability to reach a global audience through one advertising provider.
 
  •  We have long-standing relationships with a diversified group of local, regional and national advertising brands and agencies in the United States and worldwide. No single advertiser accounted for more than 2% of our 2004 domestic or international revenues.
 
  •  Our high levels of cash flow from operations provide us with strategic and financial flexibility and will position us to opportunistically pursue attractive acquisitions and investments.
 
  •  We believe that we are well-positioned to take advantage of significant technological advances and the corresponding improvements in advertisers’ abilities to present engaging campaigns to their target audiences.
 
  •  Our senior management team has extensive experience in the outdoor advertising industry.
 
  •  We believe that our financial strength and flexibility, our existing presence in key markets worldwide and our experienced senior management team position us well to capitalize on emerging acquisition and investment opportunities in the global industry.
      See “Business — Our Competitive Strengths.”
Our Strategy
      Our fundamental goal is to increase stockholder value by maximizing our cash flow from operations worldwide. Accomplishing this goal requires the successful implementation of the following strategies:
  •  We seek to capitalize on our global network and diversified product mix to maximize revenues, increase profits and launch new products and initiatives.
 
  •  We seek to enhance revenue opportunities by focusing on specific initiatives that highlight the value of outdoor advertising relative to other media.
 
  •  We continue to focus on achieving operating efficiencies throughout our global network.
 
  •  We have made significant commitments to provide innovative services to and enhance our accountability with our clients.
 
  •  We intend to strengthen our existing market presence and selectively enter into new markets through acquisitions and investments worldwide.
 
  •  We offer our clients alternative displays that incorporate new cost-effective technologies.

2


Table of Contents

  •  We maintain an entrepreneurial and customer-oriented culture that motivates local market managers to maximize our cash flow from operations.
      See “Business — Our Strategy.”
Our Risks
      We face a number of risks associated with our business and industry and must overcome a variety of challenges in implementing our operating strategy in order to be successful. For instance:
  •  Our past operating results have been negatively affected by, among other things, a global economic slowdown and a decline in our clients’ advertising budgets, resulting in our incurring net losses in each of 2002, 2003 and 2004 and an accrued retained deficit.
 
  •  The outdoor advertising industry is highly competitive. Our properties compete for audiences and advertising revenues with other outdoor advertising companies, as well as with other media.
 
  •  We are subject to U.S. and foreign government regulation. Regulations regarding permitting, nonconformance and taxes and the size, spacing, density and lighting of displays may restrict our outdoor advertising operations.
 
  •  After this offering, our total indebtedness for borrowed money will be approximately $          , approximately $2.5 billion of which will be intercompany indebtedness owed to Clear Channel Communications. If our cash flow and capital resources are insufficient to service our debt obligations, a default under any debt instrument could materially impair our financial condition and liquidity. In addition, our debt instruments may include restrictive covenants that limit our ability to refinance debt, sell assets or obtain additional equity capital.
 
  •  We have not previously operated as an independent publicly traded company and our historical and pro forma combined financial information is not necessarily representative of the results we may achieve and it is difficult to predict our future success.
 
  •  After this offering and for so long as Clear Channel Communications continues to own more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock, it will have the ability to direct the election of our board of directors, exercise control over our business and affairs and significantly influence the outcome of matters submitted to a vote of our stockholders.
 
  •  We derive benefits from our association with Clear Channel Communications. If Clear Channel Communications were to experience financial difficulty or if we were to separate from Clear Channel Communications in the future, our business could be materially adversely affected. In addition, conflicts of interest may arise between Clear Channel Communications and us relating to our past and ongoing relationships.
      For further discussion of these challenges and other risks that we face, see “Risk Factors.”
Our Relationship with Clear Channel Communications
      We are an indirect, wholly owned subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications, Inc. After this offering, Clear Channel Communications will own all of our outstanding shares of Class B common stock, representing approximately           % of the outstanding shares of our common stock and approximately           % of the total voting power of our common stock, or approximately           % and           %, respectively, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock. For as long as Clear Channel Communications is the owner of such number of shares representing more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock, it will have the ability to direct the election of all of the members of our board of directors and to exercise a controlling influence over our business and affairs, including any determination with respect to mergers or other business combinations involving us, the acquisition or disposition of assets by us, the incurrence of indebtedness by us, the issuance of any additional common stock or other equity securities by us, the repurchase or redemption of common stock

3


Table of Contents

or preferred stock by us and the payment of dividends by us. Similarly, Clear Channel Communications will have the power to determine or significantly influence the outcome of matters submitted to a vote of our stockholders, including the power to prevent an acquisition or any other change in control of us, and to take other actions that might be favorable to Clear Channel Communications. See “Description of Capital Stock.”
      Clear Channel Communications has advised us that its current intent is to continue to hold all the shares of our Class B common stock it owns after this offering. However, Clear Channel Communications is not subject to any contractual obligation that would prohibit it from selling, spinning off, splitting off or otherwise disposing of any shares of our common stock, except that Clear Channel Communications has agreed not to sell, spin off, split off or otherwise dispose of any shares of our common stock for a period of                     days after the date of this prospectus without the prior written consent of the underwriters, subject to certain limitations and limited exceptions. As a result, there can be no assurance concerning the period of time during which Clear Channel Communications will maintain its ownership of the shares of our Class B common stock owned by it after this offering. See “Underwriting.”
      Prior to the completion of this offering, we will enter into agreements with Clear Channel Communications that will govern the relationship between Clear Channel Communications and us after this offering and will provide for, among other things, the provision of services by Clear Channel Communications to us and the allocation of employee benefit, tax and other liabilities and obligations attributable to our operations. These agreements will include, among others, a master agreement, corporate services agreement, registration rights agreement, tax matters agreement and employee matters agreement. All of the agreements relating to our ongoing relationship with Clear Channel Communications will be made in the context of a parent-subsidiary relationship and the terms of these agreements may be more or less favorable to us than if they had been negotiated with unaffiliated third parties. See “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Relationship with Clear Channel Communications” and “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us.”
      After this offering and the application of all of the net proceeds from this offering to repay a portion of the intercompany indebtedness owed to Clear Channel Communications, we will have outstanding indebtedness of approximately $                    , approximately $2.5 billion of which will be intercompany indebtedness owed to Clear Channel Communications. See “Use of Proceeds” and “Description of Indebtedness.”
      The master agreement between Clear Channel Communications and us and the note evidencing the $2.5 billion intercompany indebtedness each contain covenants that restrict our ability to take certain actions and engage in certain transactions. See “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Business.” Certain of the restrictive covenants in these agreements may continue in force later than the time when Clear Channel Communications owns less than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock.
      After this offering, certain individuals will be officers and directors of both Clear Channel Communications and us. In addition, because Clear Channel Communications will continue to own more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock after this offering, we will be a “controlled company” under the New York Stock Exchange corporate governance standards. As a result of this status, we intend to utilize certain exemptions under the NYSE standards that free us from the obligation to comply with certain NYSE corporate governance requirements, which may include the requirements (i) that a majority of the board of directors consists of independent directors, (ii) that we have a nominating and governance committee, and that such committee be composed entirely of independent directors and governed by a written charter addressing the committee’s purpose and responsibilities, (iii) that we have a compensation committee composed entirely of independent directors with a written charter addressing the committee’s purpose and responsibilities and (iv) for an annual performance

4


Table of Contents

evaluation of the compensation committee. See “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Relationship with Clear Channel Communications” and “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us.”
      For a description of certain provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation concerning the allocation of business opportunities that may be suitable for both Clear Channel Communications and us, see “Description of Capital Stock.”
Our Corporate Structure
      Our principal executive offices are located at 200 East Basse Road, San Antonio, Texas 78209, and our telephone number is (210) 832-3700. We operate through Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and our combined subsidiaries. Our Internet website address is www.clearchanneloutdoor.com. Information contained on our website or that can be accessed through our website is not incorporated by reference in this prospectus. You should not consider information contained on our website or that can be accessed through our website to be part of this prospectus for any purpose.

5


Table of Contents

THE OFFERING
                   
Class A common stock offered
              shares          
Common stock to be outstanding after this offering:
               
 
Class A
              shares          
 
Class B
              shares          
 
Total common stock outstanding
              shares          
Common stock to be held by Clear Channel Communications after this offering:
               
 
Class A
     0 shares          
 
Class B
              shares          
Percentage of the outstanding shares of our common stock to be held by Clear Channel Communications after this offering
           %          
Percentage of the total voting power of our common stock to be held by Clear Channel Communications after this offering
           %          
Voting, conversion and transferability features Our Class A common stock and Class B common stock vote as a single class on all matters on which stockholders are entitled to vote, except as otherwise provided in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or as required by law. While the rights of our Class A common stock and Class B common stock are substantially similar, the Class A common stock and Class B common stock differ in certain respects, including the following:
 
     Class A • entitles holder to one vote per share on all matters on which stockholders are entitled to vote; and
 
• will be listed on the New York Stock Exchange.
 
     Class B • entitles holder to 20 votes per share on all matters on which stockholders are entitled to vote;
 
• will not be listed on any stock exchange;
 
• is convertible, at the option of the holder, at any time into shares of Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis, subject to certain limited exceptions; and
 
• will convert into shares of Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis upon any transfer, subject to certain limited exceptions.
 
Use of proceeds We estimate that our net proceeds from this offering, after deducting underwriting discounts and estimated offering expenses, will be approximately $                    , or approximately $                     if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock, assuming an initial public offering price of $           per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.
 
We intend to use all of the net proceeds of this offering to repay approximately $                    (based on the midpoint of the range of

6


Table of Contents

the offering price set forth on the cover page of this prospectus) of the outstanding balances of the intercompany notes issued to Clear Channel Communications in the original principal amounts of approximately $1.4 billion and $73.0 million. See “Use of Proceeds.”
 
Dividend policy We do not anticipate paying any dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future. If cash dividends were to be paid on our common stock, holders of Class A common stock and Class B common stock would share equally, on a per share basis, in any such cash dividend.
 
Proposed NYSE symbol for the Class A common stock CCO
 
Risk factors For a discussion of the risks related to our business, our relationship with Clear Channel Communications, our Class A common stock and this offering, see “Risk Factors” beginning on page 13.
      Unless otherwise indicated, the number of shares of Class A common stock to be outstanding after this offering excludes:
  •                      shares issuable upon the exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock; and
 
  •                      shares issuable upon the exercise of employee stock options to be issued by us in connection with the conversion of equity-based compensation awards of Clear Channel Communications granted to our employees (assuming the shares are issued at a price of $          , which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus) as well as shares issuable upon the exercise of options or shares of restricted stock that may be granted under our Stock Incentive Plan after this offering. See “Management — Employee Benefit Plans.”
      Additionally, because                      shares of our Class A common stock issuable upon the exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock are excluded from the number of shares of Class A common stock to be outstanding after this offering, the number of shares of Class B common stock to be outstanding after this offering includes                    additional shares of Class B common stock that are required to be issued to Clear Channel Communications upon expiration of the unexercised underwriters’ option in exchange for the portion of the intercompany indebtedness owed by us to Clear Channel Communications that otherwise would have been repaid with the proceeds from the exercise of such option had it been exercised in full. See “Use of Proceeds.”

7


Table of Contents

SUMMARY HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA COMBINED FINANCIAL DATA
      The following table sets forth summary historical and pro forma combined financial data and other information of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
      We have prepared our combined financial statements as if Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. had been in existence as a separate company throughout all relevant periods. The summary results of operations data, segment data and cash flow data for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002 and the summary combined balance sheet data as of December 31, 2004 and 2003 presented below were derived from our audited combined financial statements and the related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary combined balance sheet data as of December 31, 2002 is derived from our audited financial statements. The summary results of operations data, segment data and cash flow data for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 and the summary balance sheet data as of September 30, 2005 presented below were derived from our unaudited combined financial statements and the related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. The operating results for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 include all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring adjustments) that we believe are necessary for a fair statement of the results for such interim periods.
      Results for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 are not necessarily indicative of the results expected for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2005 or any future period.
      Our unaudited pro forma as adjusted results of operations data present our pro forma as adjusted results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2004:
  •  as if this offering had been completed on January 1, 2004, at an assumed initial public offering price of $          per share of Class A common stock, which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover of this prospectus, and assuming:
  –  the outstanding balances of the approximately $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes issued to Clear Channel Communications are reduced by approximately $                    , representing the balance at                     , 2005 in the “Due from Clear Channel Communications” intercompany account;
 
  –  then, approximately $                    of the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes is contributed to our capital by Clear Channel Communications;
 
  –  then, approximately $                    of the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes is repaid with all of the net proceeds of this offering; and
 
  –  then, to the extent the underwriters do not exercise in full their option to purchase up to an additional                 shares of our Class A common stock (the proceeds of which would be used to repay the then-outstanding balances of the approximately $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes), we exchange up to                additional shares of our Class B common stock with Clear Channel Communications for the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes that the proceeds from the exercise of such option otherwise would have been used to repay, such that the notes are repaid in full.
  •  after giving effect to our distribution of an intercompany note in the original principal amount of $2.5 billion as a dividend on our common stock, which note was ultimately distributed to Clear Channel Communications, as if issued to Clear Channel Communications on January 1, 2004.

8


Table of Contents

      Our pro forma as adjusted balance sheet and results of operations data as of September 30, 2005 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2005, present, using the same assumptions and application of estimated net proceeds described above:
  •  our as adjusted financial position as of September 30, 2005, as if this offering had been completed on September 30, 2005; and
 
  •  our as adjusted results of operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2005, as if this offering and the issuance of the $2.5 billion intercompany note had been completed on January 1, 2004.
      The unaudited pro forma information set forth below is based upon available information and assumptions that we believe are reasonable. The historical financial and other data have been prepared on a combined basis from Clear Channel Communications’ consolidated financial statements using the historical results of operations and bases of the assets and liabilities of Clear Channel Communications’ outdoor advertising business and give effect to allocations of expenses from Clear Channel Communications. Our historical financial data is not indicative of our future performance, nor does such data reflect what our financial position and results of operations would have been had we operated as an independent publicly traded company during the periods shown.
      The unaudited pro forma statements of operations do not reflect the complete impact of one-time and ongoing incremental costs required for us to operate as a separate company. Clear Channel Communications allocated to us $16.6 million in 2004, $19.6 million in 2003 and $17.6 million in 2002 of expenses incurred by it for providing us accounting, treasury, tax, legal, public affairs, executive oversight, human resources and other services. Through September 30, 2005, Clear Channel Communications allocated to us $11.8 million of expenses. After this offering, we expect to continue to receive from Clear Channel Communications substantially all of these services, the cost of which will be allocated to us.
      You should read the information contained in this table in conjunction with “Selected Historical Combined Financial Data,” “Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial Data,” “Capitalization,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” and the historical audited and unaudited combined financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto of us and our combined subsidiaries included elsewhere in this prospectus.
      The following table presents a non-GAAP financial measure, OIBDAN, which we use to evaluate segment and combined performance of our business. OIBDAN is not calculated or presented in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, or GAAP. In Note 3 and in “— Non-GAAP Financial Measure” below, we explain OIBDAN and reconcile it to operating income (loss), its most directly comparable financial measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP.

9


Table of Contents

                                                           
    Year Ended   Pro Forma   Nine Months Ended   Pro Forma
(In thousands, except per share data)   December 31,   as Adjusted   September 30,   as Adjusted
        December 31,       September 30,
    2002   2003   2004   2004   2004   2005   2005
                             
                (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
Results of Operations Data:
                                                       
Revenue
  $ 1,859,641     $ 2,174,597     $ 2,447,040     $ 2,447,040     $ 1,761,308     $ 1,931,471     $ 1,931,471  
Operating expenses:
                                                       
 
Direct operating expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    957,830       1,133,386       1,262,317       1,262,317       924,420       988,448       988,448  
 
Selling, general and administrative expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    392,803       456,893       499,457       499,457       358,188       410,075       410,075  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    336,895       379,640       388,217       388,217       288,810       290,233       290,233  
 
Corporate expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    52,218       54,233       53,770       53,770       39,451       39,397       39,397  
                                           
Operating income
    119,895       150,445       243,279       243,279       150,439       203,318       203,318  
Interest expense
    11,623       14,201       14,177       14,177       11,111       9,874       9,874  
Intercompany interest expense
    227,402       145,648       145,653       143,208       109,239       133,093       107,409  
Equity in earnings (loss) of nonconsolidated affiliates
    3,620       (5,142 )     (76 )     (76 )     2,270       9,908       9,908  
Other income (expense) — net
    9,164       (8,595 )     (13,341 )     (13,341 )     (17,210 )     (17,353 )     (17,353 )
                                           
Income (loss) before income taxes and cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    (106,346 )     (23,141 )     70,032       72,477       15,149       52,906       78,590  
Income tax benefit (expense):
                                                       
 
Current
    72,008       12,092       (23,422 )     (24,400 )     6,481       (37,767 )     (48,041 )
 
Deferred
    (21,370 )     (23,944 )     (39,132 )     (39,132 )     (17,730 )     6,023       6,023  
                                           
Income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    (55,708 )     (34,993 )     7,478     $ 8,945       3,900       21,162     $ 36,572  
                                           
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax of $504,927 in 2002 and $113,173 in 2004(1)
    (3,527,198 )           (162,858 )                            
                                           
Net income (loss)
  $ (3,582,906 )   $ (34,993 )   $ (155,380 )           $ 3,900     $ 21,162          
                                           
Basic and diluted income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle per common share(2)
  $       $       $       $       $       $       $    
                                           
Segment Data:
                                                       
Revenue:
                                                       
 
Domestic
  $ 911,493     $ 1,006,376     $ 1,092,089     $ 1,092,089     $ 800,744     $ 886,649     $ 886,649  
 
International
    948,148       1,168,221       1,354,951       1,354,951       960,564       1,044,822       1,044,822  
                                           
 
Total revenue
  $ 1,859,641     $ 2,174,597     $ 2,447,040     $ 2,447,040     $ 1,761,308     $ 1,931,471     $ 1,931,471  
                                           
Operating income (loss):
                                                       
 
Domestic
  $ 174,381     $ 215,485     $ 263,772     $ 263,772     $ 184,808     $ 263,448     $ 263,448  
 
International
    (2,268 )     (10,807 )     33,277       33,277       5,082       (20,733 )     (20,733 )
 
Corporate
    (52,218 )     (54,233 )     (53,770 )     (53,770 )     (39,451 )     (39,397 )     (39,397 )
                                           
 
Total operating income
  $ 119,895     $ 150,445     $ 243,279     $ 243,279     $ 150,439     $ 203,318     $ 203,318  
                                           

10


Table of Contents

                                                           
    Year Ended   Pro Forma   Nine Months Ended   Pro Forma
(In thousands)   December 31,   as Adjusted   September 30,   as Adjusted
        December 31,       September 30,
    2002   2003   2004   2004   2004   2005   2005
                             
                (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
Cash Flow Data:
                                                       
Cash flow provided by (used in):
                                                       
 
Operating activities
  $ 320,235     $ 433,459     $ 492,495             $ 329,893     $ 336,637          
 
Investing activities
  $ (430,844 )   $ (230,162 )   $ (310,658 )           $ (227,386 )   $ (223,189 )        
 
Financing activities
  $ 173,193     $ (222,491 )   $ (182,006 )           $ (95,759 )   $ (48,154 )        
Capital expenditures
  $ 290,187     $ 205,145     $ 176,140             $ 117,733     $ 130,484          
Other Data:
                                                       
OIBDAN(3)
                                                       
 
Domestic
  $ 354,328     $ 409,722     $ 450,494     $ 450,494     $ 326,359     $ 390,867     $ 390,867  
 
International
    154,680       174,596       234,888       234,888       152,423       142,593       142,593  
 
Corporate
    (52,218 )     (54,233 )     (53,770 )     (53,770 )     (39,451 )     (39,397 )     (39,397 )
                                           
 
Total OIBDAN(3)
  $ 456,790     $ 530,085     $ 631,612     $ 631,612     $ 439,331     $ 494,063     $ 494,063  
                                           
                                         
        As of September 30, 2005
(In thousands)   As of December 31,    
            Pro Forma
    2002   2003   2004   Historical   as Adjusted
                     
                (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
Balance Sheet Data:
                                       
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 45,741     $ 34,105     $ 37,948     $ 91,676     $    
Current assets
    753,289       958,669       1,107,240       1,243,287          
Property, plant and equipment — net
    2,213,817       2,264,106       2,195,985       2,172,197          
Total assets
    4,926,205       5,232,820       5,240,933       5,295,522          
Current liabilities
    642,330       736,202       749,055       807,900          
Long-term debt, including current maturities
    1,713,493       1,670,017       1,639,380       4,212,136          
Total liabilities
    2,347,262       2,472,656       2,511,280       5,207,173          
Owner’s equity
    2,578,943       2,760,164       2,729,653       88,349          
Total liabilities and owner’s equity
    4,926,205       5,232,820       5,240,933       5,295,522          
 
(1)  Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle for the year ended December 31, 2002, related to an impairment of goodwill recognized in accordance with the adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets.” Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle for the year ended December 31, 2004, related to a non-cash charge recognized in accordance with the adoption of Topic D-108, Use of Residual Method to Value Acquired Assets other than Goodwill . See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Estimates — Indefinite-lived Assets.”
 
(2)  Basic and diluted income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle per share is calculated by dividing income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle by the weighted average of common shares outstanding. The historic basic and diluted is based on                      shares outstanding and the pro forma basic and diluted is based on                      shares outstanding.
 
(3)  We evaluate segment and combined performance based on several factors, one of the primary measures of which is operating income (loss) before depreciation, amortization and non-cash compensation expense, which we refer to as OIBDAN. See “— Non-GAAP Financial Measure” below, “Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial Data” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Use of OIBDAN.”

11


Table of Contents

Non-GAAP Financial Measure
      In addition to operating income, we evaluate segment and combined performance based on other factors, one primary measure of which is operating income (loss) before depreciation, amortization and non-cash compensation expense, which we refer to as OIBDAN. We use OIBDAN as a measure of the operational strengths and performance of our business and not as a measure of liquidity. However, a limitation of the use of OIBDAN as a performance measure is that it does not reflect the periodic costs of certain capitalized tangible and intangible assets used in generating revenues in our business. Accordingly, OIBDAN should be considered in addition to, and not as a substitute for, operating income (loss), net income (loss) and other measures of financial performance reported in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Furthermore, this measure may vary among other companies; thus, OIBDAN as presented below may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies.
      We believe OIBDAN is useful to investors and other external users of our financial statements in evaluating our operating performance because it is widely used in the outdoor advertising industry to measure a company’s operating performance and it helps investors more meaningfully evaluate and compare the results of our operations from period to period and with those of other companies in the outdoor advertising industry (to the extent the same components of OIBDAN are used), in each case without regard to items such as non-cash depreciation and amortization and non-cash compensation expense, which can vary depending upon the accounting method used and the book value of assets.
      Our management uses OIBDAN (i) as a measure for planning and forecasting operating and individual expectations and for evaluating actual results against such expectations, (ii) as a basis for incentive bonuses paid to our executive officers and our branch managers and (iii) in presentations to our board of directors to enable them to have the same consistent measurement basis of operating performance used by management.
      The following table presents a reconciliation of OIBDAN to operating income, which is a GAAP measure of our operating results:
                                                           
        Pro Forma   Nine Months Ended   Pro Forma as
    Year Ended December 31,   as Adjusted   September 30,   Adjusted
        December 31,       September 30,
(In thousands)   2002   2003   2004   2004   2004   2005   2005
                             
                (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
Reconciliation of OIBDAN to operating income:
                                                       
Combined:
                                                       
 
OIBDAN
  $ 456,790     $ 530,085     $ 631,612     $ 631,612     $ 439,331     $ 494,063     $ 494,063  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    336,895       379,640       388,217       388,217       288,810       290,233       290,233  
 
Non-cash compensation
                116       116       82       512       512  
                                           
Operating income
  $ 119,895     $ 150,445     $ 243,279     $ 243,279     $ 150,439     $ 203,318     $ 203,318  
                                           
Domestic:
                                                       
 
OIBDAN
  $ 354,328     $ 409,722     $ 450,494     $ 450,494     $ 326,359     $ 390,867     $ 390,867  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    179,947       194,237       186,620       186,620       141,479       127,019       127,019  
 
Non-cash compensation
                102       102       72       400       400  
                                           
Operating income
  $ 174,381     $ 215,485     $ 263,772     $ 263,772     $ 184,808     $ 263,448     $ 263,448  
                                           
International:
                                                       
 
OIBDAN
  $ 154,680     $ 174,596     $ 234,888     $ 234,888     $ 152,423     $ 142,593     $ 142,593  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    156,948       185,403       201,597       201,597       147,331       163,214       163,214  
 
Non-cash compensation
                14       14       10       112       112  
                                           
Operating income (loss)
  $ (2,268 )   $ (10,807 )   $ 33,277     $ 33,277     $ 5,082     $ (20,733 )   $ (20,733 )
                                           

12


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS
      You should carefully consider the following risks before investing in our Class A common stock. These risks could materially adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition. In such an event, the trading price of our Class A common stock could decline and you could lose part or all of your investment.
Risks Related to Our Business
We have incurred net losses and may experience future net losses, which could adversely affect our stock price.
      In the past, our operating results have been adversely affected by, among other things, a global economic slowdown and a decline in our clients’ advertising budgets. We incurred net losses in each of 2002, 2003 and 2004 of approximately $3.6 billion, $35.0 million and $155.4 million, respectively, and had an accumulated retained deficit of $4.2 billion at September 30, 2005. Due to market conditions in the advertising industry generally and slow economic times and other factors that cause advertisers to cut back their advertising budgets or change their advertising strategies, we may face reduced demand for our advertising products, underutilization of our advertising faces and other factors that could adversely affect our results of operations in the near term. We cannot predict whether we will achieve profitability in future periods.
Government regulation of outdoor advertising may restrict our outdoor advertising operations.
      Changes in laws and regulations affecting outdoor advertising at any level of government, including laws of the foreign jurisdictions in which we operate, could have a significant financial impact on us by requiring us to make significant expenditures or otherwise limiting or restricting some of our operations.
      U.S. federal, state and local regulations have had an impact on the outdoor advertising industry. One of the seminal laws was The Highway Beautification Act of 1965 (HBA), which regulates outdoor advertising on the 306,000 miles of Federal-Aid Primary, Interstate and National Highway Systems roads. HBA regulates the locations of billboards, mandates a state compliance program, requires the development of state standards, promotes the expeditious removal of illegal signs, and requires just compensation for takings. Size, spacing and lighting are regulated by state and local municipalities.
      From time to time, certain state and local governments have attempted to force the removal of billboards not governed by the HBA under various amortization theories. Amortization permits the billboard owner to operate its billboard only as a nonconforming use for a specified period of time, after which it must remove or otherwise conform its billboard to the applicable regulations at its own cost without any compensation. Several municipalities within our existing markets have adopted amortization ordinances. Restrictive regulations also limit our ability to rebuild or replace nonconforming billboards. Such regulations have not had a material impact on our results of operations to date, but if we are increasingly unable to negotiate acceptable arrangements in circumstances in which our billboards are subject to removal or amortization or if there occurs an increase in such regulations, our results could suffer.
      Legislation has from time to time been introduced in state and local jurisdictions attempting to impose taxes on revenues of outdoor advertising companies. Several jurisdictions have already imposed such taxes as a percentage of our gross receipts of outdoor advertising revenues in that jurisdiction. While these taxes have not had a material impact on our business and financial results to date, we expect states to continue to try to impose such taxes as a way of increasing revenues. The increased imposition of these taxes and our inability to pass on the cost of these taxes to our clients could negatively affect our operating income.
      In addition, we are unable to predict what additional regulations may be imposed on outdoor advertising in the future. Legislation that would regulate the content of billboard advertisements and implement additional billboard restrictions has been introduced in Congress from time to time in the past.

13


Table of Contents

We recently were fined $30,000 by the City of Los Angeles for our inadvertent failure to properly disclose our role in providing billboards to a local political candidate.
      International regulation of the outdoor advertising industry varies by region and country, but generally limits the size, placement, nature and density of out-of-home displays. Significant international regulations include the Law of December 29, 1979 in France, the Town and Country Planning (Control of Advertisements) Regulations 1992 in the United Kingdom, and Règlement Régional Urbain de l’agglomération bruxelloise in Belgium. These laws define issues such as the extent to which advertisements can be erected in rural areas, the hours during which illuminated signs may be lit and whether the consent of local authorities is required to place a sign in certain communities. Other regulations limit the subject matter and language of out-of-home displays. For instance, the United States and France, among other nations, ban outdoor advertisements for tobacco products. Our failure to comply with these or any future international regulations could have an adverse impact on the effectiveness of our displays or their attractiveness to clients as an advertising medium and may require us to make significant expenditures to ensure compliance. As a result, we may experience a significant impact on our operations, revenues, international client base and overall financial condition.
We face intense competition in the outdoor advertising industry that may adversely affect the advertising fees we can charge, and consequently lower our operating margins and profits.
      We operate in a highly competitive industry, and we may not be able to maintain or increase the fees we charge our customers, which may consequently lower our operating margins and profits. Our advertising properties compete for audiences and advertising revenues with other outdoor advertising companies, as well as with other media, such as radio, newsweekly magazines, newspapers, prime time television, direct mail, the Internet and telephone directories. It is possible that new competitors may emerge and rapidly acquire significant market share. Competitive factors in our industry could adversely affect our financial performance by, among other things, leading to decreases in overall revenues, numbers of advertising clients, advertising fees or profit margins. These factors include:
  •  our competitors offering reduced advertising rates, which we may be unable or unwilling to match;
 
  •  our competitors adopting technological changes and innovations that we are unable to adopt or are delayed in adopting and that offer more attractive advertising alternatives than those we currently offer;
 
  •  shifts in the general population or specific demographic groups to markets where we have fewer outdoor advertising displays;
 
  •  our competitors securing more effective advertising sites than those sites where our displays are located;
 
  •  our competitors’ abilities to complete and integrate acquisitions better than our ability to complete and integrate acquisitions;
 
  •  our inability to secure street furniture contracts on favorable terms; and
 
  •  development, governmental actions and strategic trading or retirement of displays, which, excluding acquisitions, may result in a reduction of our existing displays and increased competition for attractive display locations.

14


Table of Contents

Doing business in foreign countries creates certain risks not involved in doing business in the United States that may disrupt our international operations or cause us to realize lower returns from our international operations.
      Doing business in foreign countries involves certain risks that may not exist when doing business in the United States. The risks involved in foreign operations that could result in disruptions to our business or financial losses in our international operations against which we are not insured include:
  •  exposure to local economic conditions, foreign exchange restrictions and restrictions on the withdrawal of foreign investment and earnings, investment restrictions or requirements, expropriations of property and changes in foreign taxation structures, each of which could reduce our profit from international operations;
 
  •  potential adverse changes in the diplomatic relations of foreign countries with the United States and government policies against businesses owned by foreigners, each of which could affect our ability to continue operations in or enter into an otherwise profitable market;
 
  •  changes in foreign regulations, such as the decision in France to lift the ban on retail advertising on television by 2007;
 
  •  hostility from local populations, potential instability of foreign governments and risks of insurrections, each of which could disrupt our ability to conduct normal business operations; and
 
  •  risks of renegotiation or modification of existing agreements with governmental authorities and diminished ability to legally enforce our contractual rights in foreign countries, each of which could cause financial losses in otherwise profitable operations.
      In addition, we may incur substantial tax liabilities if we repatriate any of the cash generated by our international operations back to the United States, due to our current inability to recognize any foreign tax credits that would be associated with such repatriation. We are not currently in a position to recognize any tax assets in the United States that are the result of payments of income or withholding taxes in foreign jurisdictions.
      Exchange rates may cause fluctuations in our results of operations that are not related to our operations.
      Because we own assets overseas and derive revenues from our international operations, we may incur currency translation losses or gains due to changes in the values of foreign currencies relative to the United States dollar. For the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002, foreign exchange rate gains had a significant positive effect on our results of operations. However, for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, exchange rate fluctuations negatively affected our results of operations. We cannot predict the effect of exchange rate fluctuations upon future operating results. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Market Risk Management — Foreign Currency Risk.”
Our results of operations vary from quarter to quarter, and our financial performance in certain financial quarters may not be indicative of or comparable to our financial performance in subsequent financial quarters.
      Typically, we experience our lowest financial performance in the first quarter of our calendar year as retailers scale back their advertising budgets following the year-end holiday season. Because our results vary widely from quarter to quarter, our financial results for one quarter cannot necessarily be compared to another quarter and may not be indicative of our financial performance in subsequent quarters. These variations in our financial results could have an effect on our stock price.

15


Table of Contents

The success of our street furniture and transit products is dependent on our obtaining key municipal concessions, which we may not be able to obtain on favorable terms.
      Our street furniture and transit products businesses require us to obtain contracts with municipalities and other governmental entities. Many of these contracts require us to participate in competitive bidding processes, have terms typically ranging from three to 20 years and have revenue share or fixed payment components. Our inability to successfully negotiate or complete these contracts due to governmental demands and delay and the highly competitive bidding processes for these contracts could affect our ability to offer these products to our clients, or to offer them to our clients at rates that are competitive to other forms of advertising, without adversely affecting our net income.
Future acquisitions of businesses or properties could have adverse consequences on our existing business or assets.
      We may acquire outdoor advertising assets and other assets or businesses that we believe will assist our clients in marketing their products and services. Our acquisition strategy involves numerous risks, including:
  •  possible failures of our acquisitions to be profitable or to generate anticipated cash flows, which could affect our overall profitability and cash flows;
 
  •  entry into markets and geographic areas where our competitors are operating but where we have limited or no experience;
 
  •  potential difficulties in integrating our operations and systems with those of acquired companies, causing delays in realizing the potential benefits of acquisitions;
 
  •  diversion of our management team’s attention away from other business concerns; and
 
  •  loss of key employees of acquired companies or the inability to recruit additional senior management to supplement or replace senior management of acquired companies.
Antitrust regulations may limit future acquisitions due to our current inventory of advertising properties in certain markets.
      Additional acquisitions by us may require antitrust review by U.S. antitrust agencies and may require review by foreign antitrust agencies under the antitrust laws of foreign jurisdictions. We can give no assurances that the Department of Justice, the Federal Trade Commission or foreign antitrust agencies will not investigate, possibly challenge or seek divestitures or other remedies as a condition to not challenging future acquisitions. If those agencies take any such action, we may not be able to complete, or realize the desired benefits of, the proposed acquisition.
The lack of availability of potential acquisitions at reasonable prices could harm our growth strategy.
      We face stiff competition from other outdoor advertising companies for acquisition opportunities. If the prices sought by sellers of these companies were to rise, we may find fewer acceptable acquisition opportunities. In addition, the purchase price of possible acquisitions could require the incurrence of additional debt or equity financing on our part. Since the terms and availability of this financing depend to a large degree upon general economic conditions and third parties over which we have no control, we can give no assurance that we will obtain the needed financing or that we will obtain such financing on attractive terms. In addition, our ability to obtain financing depends on a number of other factors, many of which are also beyond our control, such as interest rates and national and local business conditions. If the cost of obtaining needed financing is too high or the terms of such financing are otherwise unacceptable in relation to the acquisition opportunity we are presented with, we may decide to forgo that opportunity. Additional indebtedness could increase our leverage and make us more vulnerable to economic downturns and may limit our ability to withstand competitive pressures. Additional equity financing could result in dilution to our stockholders.

16


Table of Contents

After this offering, we will have substantial debt obligations that could restrict our operations and impair our financial condition.
      After this offering, the application of all of the net proceeds of this offering to repay a portion of the outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes owed to Clear Channel Communications, the reduction of a portion of the outstanding balances of such notes through offset to the “Due from Clear Channel Communications” account and the contribution of the remaining portion of the outstanding balances of such notes to our capital, our total indebtedness for borrowed money will be approximately $                    , approximately $2.5 billion of which will be intercompany indebtedness owed to Clear Channel Communications. Approximately $146.3 million of such total indebtedness (excluding interest) is due in 2005, $4.6 million is due in 2006 and 2007, $0.8 million is due in 2008 and 2009 and $2.5 billion thereafter. We may also incur additional substantial indebtedness in the future.
      Our substantial indebtedness could have adverse consequences, including:
  •  increasing our vulnerability to adverse economic, regulatory and industry conditions;
 
  •  limiting our ability to compete and our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industry;
 
  •  limiting our ability to borrow additional funds; and
 
  •  requiring us to dedicate a substantial portion of our cash flow from operations to payments on our debt, thereby reducing funds available for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions and other purposes.
      If our cash flow and capital resources are insufficient to service our debt obligations, we may be forced to sell assets, seek additional equity or debt capital or restructure our debt. However, these measures might be unsuccessful or inadequate in permitting us to meet scheduled debt service obligations. We may be unable to restructure or refinance our obligations and obtain additional equity financing or sell assets on satisfactory terms or at all. As a result, inability to meet our debt obligations could cause us to default on those obligations. A default under any debt instrument could, in turn, result in defaults under other debt instruments. Any such defaults could materially impair our financial condition and liquidity.
To service our debt obligations and to fund potential capital expenditures, we will require a significant amount of cash to meet our needs, which depends on many factors beyond our control.
      Our ability to service our debt obligations and to fund potential capital expenditures for display construction or renovation will require a significant amount of cash, which depends on many factors beyond our control. Our ability to make payments on and to refinance our debt will also depend on our ability to generate cash in the future. This, to an extent, is subject to general economic, financial, competitive, legislative, regulatory and other factors that are beyond our control.
      We cannot assure you that our business will generate sufficient cash flow or that future borrowings will be available to us in an amount sufficient to enable us to pay our debt, including our intercompany notes, or to fund our other liquidity needs. If our future cash flow from operations and other capital resources are insufficient to pay our obligations as they mature or to fund our liquidity needs, we may be forced to reduce or delay our business activities and capital expenditures, sell assets, obtain additional equity capital or restructure or refinance all or a portion of our debt, including the intercompany notes, on or before maturity. We cannot assure you that we will be able to refinance any of our debt, including the intercompany notes, on a timely basis or on satisfactory terms, if at all. In addition, the terms of our existing debt, including the intercompany notes, and other future debt may limit our ability to pursue any of these alternatives.

17


Table of Contents

The $2.5 billion intercompany note and agreements with Clear Channel Communications impose restrictions on our ability to finance operations and capital needs, make acquisitions or engage in other business activities and requires prepayment from substantially all proceeds from debt or equity raised by us.
      The $2.5 billion intercompany note and Master Agreement with Clear Channel Communications include restrictive covenants that, among other things, restrict our ability to:
  •  incur additional debt;
 
  •  pay dividends and make distributions;
 
  •  make certain acquisitions and investments;
 
  •  repurchase our stock;
 
  •  create liens;
 
  •  enter into transactions with affiliates;
 
  •  enter into sale-leaseback transactions;
 
  •  dispose of all or substantially all of our assets; and
 
  •  merge or consolidate.
      The existence of these restrictions could limit our ability to grow and increase our revenues or respond to competitive changes.
      In addition, the intercompany note requires us to prepay it in full upon a change of control (as defined in the note), and, upon our issuances of equity and incurrences of debt, subject to certain exceptions, to prepay the note in the amount of net proceeds received from such events. Our failure to comply with the terms and covenants in our indebtedness could lead to a default under the terms of those documents, which would entitle Clear Channel Communications or other holders to accelerate the indebtedness and declare all amounts owed due and payable. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us — Master Agreement — Approval Rights of Clear Channel Communications on Certain of Our Activities” and “Description of Indebtedness.”
Additional restrictions on outdoor advertising of tobacco, alcohol and other products may further restrict the categories of clients that can advertise using our products.
      Out-of-court settlements between the major U.S. tobacco companies and all 50 states, the District of Columbia, the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico and four other U.S. territories include a ban on the outdoor advertising of tobacco products. Our domestic revenues from the outdoor advertising of tobacco products were approximately $1.2 million, $1.6 million and $3.1 million in 2002, 2003 and 2004, respectively. Other products and services may be targeted in the future, including alcohol products. Our domestic revenues from the outdoor advertising of alcohol products were approximately $68.5 million, $74.0 million and $71.0 million in 2002, 2003 and 2004. Legislation regulating tobacco and alcohol advertising has also been introduced in a number of European countries in which we conduct business and could have a similar impact. Any significant reduction in alcohol-related advertising due to content-related restrictions could cause a reduction in our direct revenues from such advertisements and an increase in the available space on the existing inventory of billboards in the outdoor advertising industry.
A general deterioration in economic conditions may cause our clients to reduce their advertising budgets or to choose advertising plans other than outdoor advertising.
      The risks associated with our businesses become more acute in periods of a slowing economy or recession, which may be accompanied by a decrease in advertising and which could have an adverse effect on our revenues and profit margins or result in an impairment in the value of our assets. The impact of slowdowns on our business is difficult to predict, but they may result in reductions in purchases of

18


Table of Contents

advertising. In addition, to the extent our street furniture and transit businesses rely on long-term guaranteed contracts with government entities, we may suffer losses on those contracts in times of economic slowdowns.
Our outdoor advertising properties and revenues may be adversely affected by the occurrence of extraordinary events.
      The occurrence of extraordinary events with respect to our properties or the economy generally, such as terrorist attacks, severe weather conditions such as hurricanes or similar events may substantially decrease the use of and demand for advertising or expose us to substantial liability, which may decrease our revenues or increase our expenses. The September 11, 2001 terrorist attacks, for example, caused a nationwide disruption of commercial activities. The occurrence of future terrorist attacks, military actions, contagious disease outbreaks or similar events cannot be predicted, and their occurrence can be expected to further negatively affect the economies of the United States and other foreign countries where we do business generally, specifically the market for advertising.
Risks Related to Our Relationship with Clear Channel Communications
We have no operating history as an independent company and our historical and pro forma combined financial information is not necessarily representative of the results we would have achieved as an independent publicly traded company and may not be a reliable indicator of our future results.
      The historical and pro forma combined financial information included in this prospectus does not reflect the financial condition, results of operations or cash flows we would have achieved as an independent publicly traded company during the periods presented or those results we will achieve in the future. This is primarily a result of the following factors:
  •  Our historical and pro forma combined financial results reflect allocations of corporate expenses from Clear Channel Communications. Those allocations may be different from the comparable expenses we would have incurred had we operated as an independent publicly traded company.
 
  •  Our working capital requirements and capital for our general corporate purposes, including acquisitions and capital expenditures, historically have been satisfied as part of the corporate-wide cash management policies of Clear Channel Communications. Subsequent to this offering, Clear Channel Communications will not be required to provide us with funds to finance our working capital or other cash requirements. Without the opportunity to obtain financing from Clear Channel Communications, we may in the future need to obtain additional financing from banks, or through public offerings or private placements of debt or equity securities, strategic relationships or other arrangements. We may have a credit rating that is lower than Clear Channel Communications’ credit rating and may incur debt on terms and at interest rates that will not be as favorable as those generally enjoyed by Clear Channel Communications.
 
  •  Significant changes may occur in our cost structure, management, financing and business operations as a result of our operating as an independent public subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications. These changes could result in increased costs associated with reduced economies of scale, stand-alone costs for services currently provided by Clear Channel Communications, the need for additional personnel to perform services currently provided by Clear Channel Communications and the legal, accounting, compliance and other costs associated with being a public company with equity securities listed on a national stock exchange. We are obligated to continue to use the services of Clear Channel Communications under the Corporate Services Agreement until such time as Clear Channel Communications owns less than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock, or longer for certain information technology services, and, in the event our Corporate Services Agreement with Clear Channel Communications terminates, we may not be able to replace the services that Clear Channel Communications provides us until such time or in a timely manner or on comparable terms.

19


Table of Contents

  •  Pursuant to a cash management arrangement, substantially all of our cash generated from our domestic operations will be transferred daily by Clear Channel Communications into accounts where funds of ours and of Clear Channel Communications may be commingled. The amounts so held by Clear Channel Communications will be evidenced in a cash management note issued by Clear Channel Communications to us. We do not have a commitment from Clear Channel Communications to advance funds to us, and we will have no access to the cash transferred from our concentration account to the master account of Clear Channel Communications. If Clear Channel Communications were to become insolvent, we would be an unsecured creditor like other unsecured creditors of Clear Channel Communications and could experience a liquidity shortfall.
Because Clear Channel Communications controls substantially all the voting power of our common stock, investors will not be able to affect the outcome of any stockholder vote.
      After this offering, Clear Channel Communications will own all of our outstanding shares of Class B common stock, representing approximately           % of the outstanding shares of our common stock, or approximately           % if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock. Each share of our Class B common stock entitles its holder to 20 votes and each share of our Class A common stock entitles its holder to one vote on all matters on which stockholders are entitled to vote. As a result, after this offering, Clear Channel Communications will control approximately           % of the total voting power of our common stock, or approximately           % if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock.
      For so long as Clear Channel Communications continues to own shares of our common stock representing more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock, it will have the ability to direct the election of all members of our board of directors and to exercise a controlling influence over our business and affairs, including any determinations with respect to mergers or other business combinations involving us, our acquisition or disposition of assets, our incurrence of indebtedness, our issuance of any additional common stock or other equity securities, our repurchase or redemption of common stock or preferred stock and our payment of dividends. Similarly, Clear Channel Communications will have the power to determine or significantly influence the outcome of matters submitted to a vote of our stockholders, including the power to prevent an acquisition or any other change in control of us. Because Clear Channel Communications’ interests as our controlling stockholder may differ from your interests, actions taken by Clear Channel Communications with respect to us may not be favorable to you.
      Prior to the completion of this offering, we also will enter into a master agreement, a corporate services agreement, a trademark license agreement and a number of other agreements with Clear Channel Communications setting forth various matters governing our relationship with Clear Channel Communications while it remains a significant stockholder in us. These agreements, along with the $2.5 billion intercompany note, will govern our relationship with Clear Channel Communications after this offering and will allow Clear Channel Communications to retain control over, among other things, the continued use of the trademark “Clear Channel,” the provision of corporate services to us and our ability to make certain acquisitions or to merge or consolidate or to sell all or substantially all our assets. The rights of Clear Channel Communications under these agreements may allow Clear Channel Communications to delay or prevent an acquisition of us that our other stockholders may consider favorable. We will not be able to terminate these agreements or amend them in a manner we deem more favorable so long as Clear Channel Communications continues to own shares of our common stock representing more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock. See “Description of Capital Stock”, “Description of Indebtedness” and “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us.”
Conflicts of interest may arise between Clear Channel Communications and us that could be resolved in a manner unfavorable to us.
      Questions relating to conflicts of interest may arise between Clear Channel Communications and us in a number of areas relating to our past and ongoing relationships. After this offering,                     of our directors will continue to serve as directors of Clear Channel Communications and two of these will be our

20


Table of Contents

executive officers. For as long as Clear Channel Communications continues to own shares of our common stock representing more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock, it will have the ability to direct the election of all the members of our board of directors and to exercise a controlling influence over our business and affairs.
      Areas in which conflicts of interest between Clear Channel Communications and us could arise include, but are not limited to, the following:
  •  Cross officerships, directorships and stock ownership. The ownership interests of our directors or executive officers in the common stock of Clear Channel Communications or service as a director or officer of both Clear Channel Communications and us could create, or appear to create, conflicts of interest when directors and executive officers are faced with decisions that could have different implications for the two companies. For example, these decisions could relate to (i) the nature, quality and cost of services rendered to us by Clear Channel Communications, (ii) disagreement over the desirability of a potential acquisition opportunity, (iii) employee retention or recruiting or (iv) our dividend policy.
 
  •  Intercompany transactions. From time to time, Clear Channel Communications or its affiliates may enter into transactions with us or our subsidiaries or other affiliates. Although the terms of any such transactions will be established based upon negotiations between employees of Clear Channel Communications and us and, when appropriate, subject to the approval of the independent directors on our board or a committee of disinterested directors, there can be no assurance that the terms of any such transactions will be as favorable to us or our subsidiaries or affiliates as may otherwise be obtained in arm’s length negotiations.
 
  •  Intercompany agreements. We have entered into certain agreements with Clear Channel Communications pursuant to which it will provide us certain management, administrative, accounting, tax, legal and other services, for which we will reimburse Clear Channel Communications on a cost basis. In addition, we will enter into a number of intercompany agreements covering matters such as tax sharing and our responsibility for certain liabilities previously undertaken by Clear Channel Communications for certain of our businesses. Pursuant to the corporate services agreement between Clear Channel Communications and us, we are contractually obligated to utilize the services of the chief executive officer of Clear Channel Communications as our Chief Executive Officer and the chief financial officer of Clear Channel Communications as our Chief Financial Officer until Clear Channel Communications owns less than 50% of the voting power of our common stock, or we provide Clear Channel Communications with six months prior written notice of termination. The terms of these agreements were established while we were a wholly owned subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications and were not the result of arm’s length negotiations. In addition, conflicts could arise in the interpretation or any extension or renegotiation of these existing agreements after this offering. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us.”
If Clear Channel Communications engages in the same type of business we conduct or takes advantage of business opportunities that might be attractive to us, our ability to successfully operate and expand our business may be hampered.
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that, subject to any contractual provision to the contrary, Clear Channel Communications will have no obligation to refrain from:
  •  engaging in the same or similar business activities or lines of business as us; or
 
  •  doing business with any of our clients, customers or vendors.
      In addition, the corporate opportunity policy set forth in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation addresses potential conflicts of interest between our company, on the one hand, and Clear Channel Communications and its officers and directors who are officers or directors of our company, on the other hand. The policy provides that if Clear Channel Communications acquires knowledge of a

21


Table of Contents

potential transaction or matter which may be a corporate opportunity for both Clear Channel Communications and us, we will have renounced our interest in the corporate opportunity. It also provides that if one of our directors or officers who is also a director or officer of Clear Channel Communications learns of a potential transaction or matter that may be a corporate opportunity for both Clear Channel Communications and us, we will have renounced our interest in the corporate opportunity, unless that opportunity is expressly offered to that person in writing solely in his or her capacity as our director or officer.
      If one of our officers or directors, who also serves as a director or officer of Clear Channel Communications, learns of a potential transaction or matter that may be a corporate opportunity for both Clear Channel Communications and us, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that the director or officer will have no duty to communicate or present that corporate opportunity to us and will not be liable to us or our stockholders for breach of fiduciary duty by reason of Clear Channel Communications’ actions with respect to that corporate opportunity.
      This policy could result in Clear Channel Communications having rights to corporate opportunities in which both we and Clear Channel Communications have an interest.
      By becoming a stockholder in our company, you will be deemed to have notice of and have consented to these provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation. The principles for resolving such potential conflicts of interest are described under “Description of Capital Stock — Provisions of Our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation Relating to Related-Party Transactions and Corporate Opportunities.”
We are a “controlled company” within the meaning of the New York Stock Exchange rules and, as a result, will qualify for, and intend to rely on, exemptions from certain corporate governance requirements that may not provide as many protections as those afforded to stockholders of other companies.
      After this offering, Clear Channel Communications will continue to own more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock and we will be a “controlled company” under the NYSE corporate governance standards. As a controlled company, we may elect to utilize certain exemptions under the NYSE standards that free us from the obligation to comply with certain NYSE corporate governance requirements, including the requirements (i) that a majority of the board of directors consists of independent directors, (ii) that we have a nominating and governance committee, and that such committee be composed entirely of independent directors and governed by a written charter addressing the committee’s purpose and responsibilities, (iii) that we have a compensation committee that is composed entirely of independent directors with a written charter addressing the committee’s purpose and responsibilities and (iv) for an annual performance evaluation of the compensation committee. After this offering, we intend to utilize certain of these exemptions and, as a result, we may not create or maintain a nominating and governance committee, and the nominating and governance committee, if created, and the compensation committee may not consist entirely of independent directors, and our board of directors may not consist of a majority of independent directors. Accordingly, you may not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to all of the NYSE corporate governance requirements.
We will only have the right to use the Clear Channel brand name, logo and corporate name for so long as Clear Channel Communications owns at least 50% of the total voting power of our common stock. If Clear Channel Communications’ ownership falls below such 50% threshold and we fail to establish in a timely manner a new, independently recognized brand name with a strong reputation, our revenue and profitability could decline.
      Upon completion of this offering, our corporate name will be “Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.,” and we and our subsidiaries may use the Clear Channel brand name and logo in marketing our products and services. Pursuant to a trademark license agreement, Clear Channel Communications will grant us the right to use the “Clear Channel” mark and logo in connection with our products and services

22


Table of Contents

and the right to use “Clear Channel” in our corporate name and the corporate names of our subsidiaries until 12 months after the date on which Clear Channel Communications owns less than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock. In the event our right to use the Clear Channel brand name and logo and corporate name expires, we will be required to conduct our business under a new brand name, which may not be immediately recognized by our clients and suppliers or by potential employees we are trying to recruit. We will need to expend significant time, effort and resources to establish a new brand name in the marketplace. We cannot guarantee that this effort will ultimately be successful. If our effort to establish a new brand identity is unsuccessful, our business, financial condition and results of operations may suffer.
Any future separation from Clear Channel Communications could adversely affect our business and profitability due to Clear Channel Communications’ strong brand and reputation.
      As a subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications, our businesses have marketed many of their products and services using the “Clear Channel” brand name and logo, and we believe the association with Clear Channel Communications has provided many benefits, including:
  •  a world-class brand associated with trust, integrity and longevity;
 
  •  perception of high-quality products and services;
 
  •  preferred status among our clients and employees;
 
  •  strong capital base and financial strength; and
 
  •  established relationships with U.S. federal and state regulators and non-U.S. regulators.
      Any future separation from Clear Channel Communications could adversely affect our ability to attract and retain highly qualified dedicated sales specialists for our products and services. We may be required to lower the prices of our products and services, increase our sales commissions and fees, change long-term advertising and marketing agreements and take other action to maintain our relationship with our clients, suppliers and dedicated sales specialists, all of which could have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Any future separation from Clear Channel Communications also could cause some of our existing clients to choose to stop doing business with us, and could cause other potential clients to decide not to purchase our products and services because we are no longer part of Clear Channel Communications.
      We cannot accurately predict the effect that a separation from Clear Channel Communications would have on our sales, clients or employees. The risks relating to a separation from Clear Channel Communications could materialize at various times, including:
  •  if and when Clear Channel Communications reduces its ownership in our common stock to a level below 50% of the total voting power; and
 
  •  if and when we are required to cease using the Clear Channel name and logo in our sales and marketing materials.
We will not have control over our tax decisions and could be liable for income taxes owed by Clear Channel Communications.
      For so long as Clear Channel Communications continues to own at least 80% of the total voting power and value of our common stock, we and certain of our subsidiaries will be included in Clear Channel Communications’ consolidated group for U.S. federal income tax purposes. In addition, we or one or more of our subsidiaries may be included in the combined, consolidated or unitary tax returns of Clear Channel Communications or one or more of its subsidiaries for foreign, state and local income tax purposes. Under the Tax Matters Agreement, we will pay to Clear Channel Communications the amount of federal, foreign, state and local income taxes which we would be required to pay to the relevant taxing authorities if we and our subsidiaries filed combined, consolidated or unitary tax returns and were not included in the consolidated, combined or unitary tax returns of Clear Channel Communications or its

23


Table of Contents

subsidiaries. In addition, by virtue of its controlling ownership and the Tax Matters Agreement, Clear Channel Communications will effectively control all of our tax decisions. The Tax Matters Agreement provides that Clear Channel Communications will have sole authority to respond to and conduct all tax proceedings (including tax audits) relating to us, to file all income tax returns on our behalf and to determine the amount of our liability to (or entitlement to payment from) Clear Channel Communications under the Tax Matters Agreement. This arrangement may result in conflicts of interest between Clear Channel Communications and us. For example, under the Tax Matters Agreement, Clear Channel Communications will be able to choose to contest, compromise or settle any adjustment or deficiency proposed by the relevant taxing authority in a manner that may be beneficial to Clear Channel Communications and detrimental to us.
      Moreover, notwithstanding the Tax Matters Agreement, federal law provides that each member of a consolidated group is liable for the group’s entire tax obligation. Thus, to the extent Clear Channel Communications or other members of the group fail to make any U.S. federal income tax payments required by law, we would be liable for the shortfall. Similar principles may apply for foreign, state and local income tax purposes where we file combined, consolidated or unitary returns with Clear Channel Communications or its subsidiaries for federal, foreign, state and local income tax purposes.
If Clear Channel Communications spins off our Class B common stock to its stockholders, we have agreed in the Tax Matters Agreement to indemnify Clear Channel Communications for its tax-related liabilities in certain circumstances.
      If Clear Channel Communications spins off our Class B common stock to its stockholders in a distribution that is intended to be tax-free under Section 355 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, which we refer to herein as the Code, we have agreed in the Tax Matters Agreement to indemnify Clear Channel Communications and its affiliates against any and all tax-related liabilities if such a spin-off fails to qualify as a tax-free distribution (including as a result of Section 355(e) of the Code) due to actions, events or transactions relating to our stock, assets or business, or a breach of the relevant representations or covenants made by us in the Tax Matters Agreement. If neither we nor Clear Channel Communications is responsible under the Tax Matters Agreement for any such spin-off not being tax-free under Section 355 of the Code, we and Clear Channel Communications have agreed that we will each be responsible for 50% of the tax-related liabilities arising from the failure of such a spin-off to so qualify. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us — Tax Matters Agreement.”
Future sales or distributions of our shares by Clear Channel Communications could depress the market price for shares of our Class A common stock.
      After this offering, Clear Channel Communications may sell all or part of the shares of our common stock that it owns or distribute those shares to its stockholders, including pursuant to demand registration rights described herein. Sales or distributions by Clear Channel Communications of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market or to its stockholders could adversely affect prevailing market prices for our Class A common stock. Clear Channel Communications has advised us that it currently intends to continue to hold all of our common stock that it owns following this offering. However, Clear Channel Communications is not subject to any contractual obligation that would prohibit it from selling, spinning off, splitting off or otherwise disposing of any shares of our common stock, except that Clear Channel Communications has agreed not to sell, spin off, split off or otherwise dispose of any of our shares of common stock for a period of                    days after the date of this prospectus without the prior written consent of the underwriters, subject to certain limitations and limited exceptions. Consequently, we cannot assure you that Clear Channel Communications will maintain its ownership of our common stock after the                    -day period following this offering.

24


Table of Contents

The terms of our arrangements with Clear Channel Communications may be more favorable than we will be able to obtain from an unaffiliated third party, and we may be unable to replace the services Clear Channel Communications provides us in a timely manner or on comparable terms.
      We and Clear Channel Communications will enter into a Corporate Services Agreement and other agreements prior to the completion of this offering. Pursuant to the Corporate Services Agreement, Clear Channel Communications and its affiliates will agree to provide us with corporate services after this offering, including treasury, payroll and other financial services, executive officer services, human resources and employee benefit services, legal services, information systems and network services and procurement and sourcing support.
      We are negotiating these arrangements with Clear Channel Communications in the context of a parent-subsidiary relationship. Although Clear Channel Communications will be contractually obligated to provide us with services during the term of the Corporate Services Agreement, we cannot assure you that these services will be sustained at the same level after the expiration of that agreement, or that we will be able to replace these services in a timely manner or on comparable terms. In addition, we cannot provide assurance that the amount we pay Clear Channel Communications for the services will be as favorable to us as that which may be available for comparable services provided by unrelated third parties. Other agreements with Clear Channel Communications will also govern our relationship with Clear Channel Communications after this offering and will provide for the allocation of employee benefit, tax and other liabilities and obligations attributable to our operations. The agreements also contain terms and provisions that may be more or less favorable than terms and provisions we might have obtained in arm’s length negotiations with unaffiliated third parties. If Clear Channel Communications ceases to provide services to us pursuant to those agreements, our costs of procuring those services from third parties may increase. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us — Relationship with Clear Channel Communications.”
Any deterioration in the financial condition of Clear Channel Communications could adversely affect our access to the credit markets and increase our borrowing costs.
      For so long as Clear Channel Communications maintains a significant interest in us, a deterioration in the financial condition of Clear Channel Communications could have the effect of increasing our borrowing costs or impairing our access to the capital markets because of our reliance on Clear Channel Communications for availability under its revolving credit facility. In addition, because the interest rate we pay on the $2.5 billion intercompany note is based on the weighted average cost of debt for Clear Channel Communications, any such deterioration would likely result in an increase in Clear Channel Communications’ cost of debt and in our interest rate. To the extent we do not pass on our increased borrowing costs to our clients, our profitability, and potentially our ability to raise capital, could be materially affected. Also, until the first date Clear Channel Communications owns less than 50% of our voting stock, pursuant to the Master Agreement between us and Clear Channel Communications, as well as pursuant to the $2.5 billion intercompany note, Clear Channel Communications will have the ability to limit our ability to incur debt or issue equity securities, which could adversely affect our ability to meet our liquidity needs or to grow our business. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us” and “Description of Indebtedness.”
Risks Related to Our Class A Common Stock and This Offering
There is no existing market for our Class A common stock, and a trading market that will provide you with adequate liquidity may not develop, the price of our Class A common stock may fluctuate significantly, and you could lose all or part of your investment.
      Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our Class A common stock. We cannot predict the extent to which investor interest will lead to the development of an active and liquid trading market in our Class A common stock on the NYSE or otherwise. If an active trading market does not develop, you may have difficulty selling any of our Class A common stock that you buy.

25


Table of Contents

      The initial public offering price per share for our Class A common stock will be determined by negotiations between us and the representatives of the underwriters and may not be indicative of the market price of our Class A common stock that will prevail in the trading market. The market price of our Class A common stock may decline below the initial public offering price. The market price of our Class A common stock may also be influenced by many factors, some of which are beyond our control, including:
  •  our quarterly or annual earnings, or those of other companies in our industry;
 
  •  our loss of a large client;
 
  •  announcements by us or our competitors of significant contracts or acquisitions;
 
  •  changes in accounting standards, policies, guidance, interpretations or principles;
 
  •  general economic conditions;
 
  •  the failure of securities analysts to cover our Class A common stock after this offering or changes in financial estimates by analysts;
 
  •  future sales by us or other stockholders of our Class A common stock; and
 
  •  other factors described in these “Risk Factors.”
      In recent years, the stock market has experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations. This volatility has had a significant impact on the market price of securities issued by many companies, including companies in our industry. The changes frequently appear to occur without regard to the operating performance of these companies. The price of our Class A common stock could fluctuate based upon factors that have little or nothing to do with our company, and these fluctuations could materially reduce our stock price.
      In the past, some companies that have had volatile market prices for their securities have been subject to securities class action suits filed against them. If a suit were to be filed against us, regardless of the outcome, it could result in substantial legal costs and a diversion of our management’s attention and resources. This could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Our stock ownership by Clear Channel Communications, provisions in our agreements with Clear Channel Communications and our corporate governance documents and Delaware law may delay or prevent an acquisition of us that our other stockholders may consider favorable, which could decrease the value of your shares of Class A common stock.
      After this offering, for as long as Clear Channel Communications continues to own shares of our common stock representing more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock, it will have the ability to control decisions regarding an acquisition of us by a third party. As a controlled company, we are exempt from some of the corporate governance requirements of the NYSE, including the requirement that our board of directors be comprised of a majority of independent directors. In addition, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, bylaws and Delaware law contain provisions that could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire us without the consent of our board of directors. These provisions include restrictions on the ability of our stockholders to remove directors, supermajority voting requirements for stockholders to amend our organizational documents, restrictions on a classified board of directors and limitations on action by our stockholders by written consent. Some of these provisions, such as the limitation on stockholder action by written consent, only become effective once Clear Channel Communications no longer controls us. In addition, our board of directors has the right to issue preferred stock without stockholder approval, which could be used to dilute the stock ownership of a potential hostile acquirer. Delaware law also imposes certain restrictions on mergers and other business combinations between any holder of 15% or more of our outstanding voting stock. These restrictions under Delaware law do not apply to Clear Channel Communications while it retains at least 15% or more of our Class B

26


Table of Contents

common stock. Although we believe these provisions protect our stockholders from coercive or otherwise unfair takeover tactics and thereby provide for an opportunity to receive a higher bid by requiring potential acquirers to negotiate with our board of directors, these provisions apply even if the offer may be considered beneficial by some stockholders. See “Description of Capital Stock.”
If Clear Channel Communications spins off our high vote Class B common stock to its stockholders and such shares do not convert into Class A common stock upon a sale or other transfer subsequent to such distribution, the voting rights of our Class A common stock will continue to be disproportionately lower than the voting rights of our Class B common stock.
      In connection with any distribution of shares of our Class B common stock to Clear Channel Communications’ common stockholders in a spin-off, Clear Channel Communications may elect in its sole discretion whether our Class B common stock so distributed will automatically convert into shares of Class A common stock upon a transfer or sale by the recipient subsequent to the spin-off or whether the Class B common stock will continue as high vote Class B common stock after the distribution. In the event the Class B common stock does not convert into Class A common stock upon a sale or transfer subsequent to a spin-off, the voting rights of Class A common stock will continue to be disproportionately lower than the voting rights of our Class B common stock. Therefore, the holders of our Class B common stock will continue to be able to direct the election of all the members of our board of directors and exercise a controlling influence over our business and affairs.
We currently do not intend to pay dividends on our Class A common stock.
      We do not expect to pay dividends on our Class A common stock in the foreseeable future. We are a holding company with no independent operations and no significant assets other than the stock of our subsidiaries. We therefore are dependent upon the receipt of dividends or other distributions from our subsidiaries to pay dividends. Accordingly, if you purchase shares in this offering, the price of our Class A common stock must appreciate in order to realize a gain on your investment. This appreciation may not occur.
You will suffer an immediate and substantial dilution in the net tangible book value of the Class A common stock you purchase.
      Based on an assumed initial public offering price of $           per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, purchasers of Class A common stock in this offering will experience immediate and substantial dilution of approximately $           per share in net tangible book value of the Class A common stock.
We will incur increased costs as a result of being a public company.
      The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as well as new rules subsequently implemented by the Securities and Exchange Commission and New York Stock Exchange, have required changes in corporate governance practices of public companies. We expect these new rules and regulations to increase our legal and financial compliance costs and to make some activities more time-consuming and costly. For example, when we cease to take advantage of the “controlled company” exemption available in the NYSE rules, we will have to add a number of independent directors in order that our board consist of a majority of independent directors and create additional board committees. In addition, we will incur additional costs associated with our public company reporting requirements. We also expect these new rules and regulations to make it more difficult and more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance and we may be required to accept reduced policy limits and coverage or incur substantially higher costs to obtain the same or similar coverage. As a result, it may be more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified persons to serve on our board of directors or as executive officers. We are currently evaluating and monitoring developments with respect to these new rules, and we cannot predict or estimate the amount of additional costs we may incur or the timing of such costs.

27


Table of Contents

If, after this offering, we are unable to satisfy the requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, or our internal controls over financial reporting are not effective, the reliability of our financial statements may be questioned and our stock price may suffer.
      Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act requires any company subject to the reporting requirements of the U.S. securities laws to do a comprehensive evaluation of its and its combined subsidiaries’ internal controls over financial reporting. To comply with this statute, we will be required to document and test our internal control procedures; our management will be required to assess and issue a report concerning our internal controls over financial reporting; and our independent auditors will be required to issue an opinion on management’s assessment of those matters. Our compliance with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act will first be tested in connection with the filing of our annual report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2006. The rules governing the standards that must be met for management to assess our internal controls over financial reporting are new and complex and require significant documentation, testing and possible remediation to meet the detailed standards under the rules. During the course of its testing, our management may identify material weaknesses or significant deficiencies which may not be remedied in time to meet the deadline imposed by the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. If our management cannot favorably assess the effectiveness of our internal controls over financial reporting or our auditors identify material weaknesses in our internal controls, investor confidence in our financial results may weaken, and our stock price may suffer. In connection with Clear Channel Communications’ internal controls testing as of December 31, 2004, a number of control deficiencies were identified, some of which relate to our business. If these control deficiencies exist at the time our compliance with Section 404 is tested, there can be no assurance that they will not be material weaknesses.

28


Table of Contents

SPECIAL NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
      All statements other than statements of historical facts included in this prospectus, including, without limitation, statements regarding our future financial position, business strategy, budgets, projected costs, savings and plans and objectives of management for future operations, are forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements generally can be identified by the use of forward-looking terminology such as “may,” “will,” “expect,” “intend,” “estimate,” “anticipate,” “believe” or “continue” or the negative thereof or variations thereon or similar terminology. Although we believe that the expectations reflected in such forward-looking statements are reasonable, we can give no assurance that such expectations will prove to have been correct. Important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from our expectations (“cautionary statements”) are disclosed under “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this prospectus, including, without limitation, in conjunction with the forward-looking statements included in this prospectus. All subsequent written and oral forward-looking statements attributable to us, or persons acting on our behalf, are expressly qualified in their entirety by the cautionary statements included in this prospectus.
      All forward-looking statements attributable to us or persons acting on our behalf apply only as of the date of this prospectus and are expressly qualified in their entirety by the cautionary statements included in this prospectus. We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances after the date made or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.

29


Table of Contents

USE OF PROCEEDS
      We estimate that our net proceeds from this offering, after deducting underwriting discounts and estimated offering expenses, will be approximately $          (approximately $          if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock), assuming an initial public offering price of $           per share of Class A common stock, which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.
      In 2003, two intercompany notes were issued to Clear Channel Communications in the aggregate original principal amount of approximately $1.5 billion. The first intercompany note in the original principal amount of approximately $1.4 billion, the entire principal balance of which remains outstanding, matures on December 31, 2017, may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 10%. The second intercompany note in the original principal amount of $73.0 million, the entire principal balance of which remains outstanding, matures on December 31, 2017, may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 9%. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us.”
      Assuming an initial public offering price of $          , the midpoint of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, we intend to use all of the net proceeds of this offering to repay approximately $ of the outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes. Prior to such use of proceeds, the outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes will be reduced by approximately $          , the balance at                     , 2005 in the “Due from Clear Channel Communications” intercompany account, and approximately $          of the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes will be contributed to our capital by Clear Channel Communications. Upon expiration of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of our Class A common stock, and to the extent the underwriters do not exercise the option in full, we intend to exchange up to                     additional shares of our Class B common stock with Clear Channel Communications for the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes that the proceeds from the exercise of such option otherwise would have been used to repay, such that they are repaid in full. The aggregate number of shares of our Class B common stock so exchanged will equal (i) the number of additional shares of Class A common stock that the underwriters have an option to purchase, less (ii) the actual number of shares of Class A common stock that the underwriters purchase from us pursuant to the option.
      Our total indebtedness after this offering and after application of all of the net proceeds of this offering to repay a portion of the intercompany indebtedness owed to Clear Channel Communications will be approximately $           , approximately $2.5 billion of which will be intercompany indebtedness owed to Clear Channel Communications. See “Description of Indebtedness.”

30


Table of Contents

DIVIDEND POLICY
      We do not anticipate paying any dividends on the shares of our common stock in the foreseeable future. If cash dividends were to be paid on our common stock, holders of Class A common stock and Class B common stock would share equally, on a per share basis, in any such cash dividend.
CAPITALIZATION
      The following table sets forth our capitalization as of September 30, 2005:
      (i) on an actual basis; and
      (ii) on an as adjusted post-offering basis, after giving effect to:
        (a) this offering;
 
        (b) the reduction of the outstanding balances of the approximately $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes by approximately $                     , representing the balance at                     , 2005 in the “Due from Clear Channel Communications” intercompany account;
 
        (c) the contribution of approximately $          of the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes to our capital by Clear Channel Communications;
 
        (d) the repayment of approximately $          of the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million notes with all of the net proceeds of this offering assuming an offering price of $          per share, the midpoint of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus; and
 
        (e) to the extent the underwriters do not exercise in full their option to purchase up to an additional                     shares of our Class A common stock (the proceeds of which would be used to repay the then outstanding balances of the approximately $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes), the exchange of up to                     additional shares of our Class B common stock with Clear Channel Communications for the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes that the proceeds from the exercise of such option otherwise would have been used to repay, such that they are repaid in full.
      You should read the information in this table in conjunction with the historical audited and unaudited combined financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto of us and our combined subsidiaries included elsewhere in this prospectus and “Use of Proceeds,” “Dividend Policy,” “Selected Historical Combined Financial Data,” “Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial Data” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

31


Table of Contents

                     
    As of September 30, 2005
     
        As Adjusted
    Actual   Post-Offering
         
(In thousands)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 91,676     $    
             
Due from Clear Channel Communications
  $ 362,154     $    
             
Debt:
               
 
Credit facility
  $ 49,732     $    
 
Intercompany note in the original principal amount of approximately $1.4 billion
    1,390,000        
 
Intercompany note in the original principal amount of $73.0 million
    73,000        
 
Intercompany note in the original principal amount of $2.5 billion(1)
    2,500,000       2,500,000  
 
Other borrowings
    199,404       199,404  
             
   
Total debt
    4,212,136          
             
Owner’s equity:
               
Actual and as adjusted pre-offering: common stock, par value $0.01 per share;            shares authorized,            shares issued; as adjusted post-offering: Class A common stock and Class B common stock, each par value $0.01 per share;            shares authorized,            shares of Class A common stock and            shares of Class B common stock issued(2)
             
 
Additional capital paid-in
             
 
Owner’s net investment(1)
    4,179,664       4,179,664  
 
Retained deficit
    (4,229,060 )     (4,229,060 )
 
Accumulated other comprehensive income
    137,745       137,745  
             
   
Total owner’s equity
    88,349          
             
 
Total capitalization
  $ 4,300,485     $    
             
 
(1)  On August 2, 2005, we paid a dividend of $2.5 billion on our common stock to Clear Channel Communications in the form of an intercompany note.
 
(2)  In connection with this offering, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that the shares of our common stock outstanding prior to this offering will be changed into and reclassified as                      shares of Class B common stock to be outstanding after this offering. After this offering, Clear Channel Communications will own all of our outstanding shares of Class B common stock.

32


Table of Contents

DILUTION
      Dilution is the amount by which the initial public offering price paid by the purchasers of shares of Class A common stock in this offering will exceed the net tangible book value per share of Class A common stock after this offering. The net tangible book value per share presented below equals the amount of our total tangible assets (total assets less intangible assets), less total liabilities as of September 30, 2005. As of September 30, 2005, we had a net tangible book value of $(          ), or $(          ) per share. On a pro forma basis, after giving effect to:
  •  the sale by us of                      shares of Class A common stock in this offering, assuming an initial public offering price of $           per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and the application of all of the net proceeds of this offering, after deducting underwriting discounts and estimated offering expenses, as described under “Use of Proceeds;” and
 
  •  the repayment or contribution of the remaining outstanding balances of the approximately $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes;
our pro forma net tangible book value as of September 30, 2005 would have been $(          ) or $(          ) per share, which represents an immediate increase in net tangible book value of $           per share to Clear Channel Communications, our current stockholder, and an immediate dilution in net tangible book value of $           per share to new stockholders purchasing shares of Class A common stock in this offering.
      The following table illustrates this dilution on a per share basis:
                   
Assumed initial public offering price per share
          $    
 
Net tangible book value per share as of           , 2005
  $            
 
Increase in net tangible book value per share attributable to new stockholders
  $            
             
Pro forma net tangible book value per share after this offering
          $    
             
Dilution per share to new stockholders
          $    
             
      The following table summarizes, on the same pro forma basis as of September 30, 2005, the total number of shares of Class A common stock purchased from us, the total consideration paid to us and the average price per share paid by Clear Channel Communications, our current stockholder, and by new stockholders purchasing shares of Class A common stock in this offering:
                                         
(In millions, except percentages)            
    Shares Purchased   Total Consideration    
            Average Price
    Number   Percent   Number   Percent   per Share
                     
Current stockholder(1)
              %   $           %   $    
New stockholders
              %   $           %   $    
                               
Total
            100 %   $         100 %   $    
                               
 
(1)  After giving effect to the reclassification, in connection with this offering, of                      shares of our common stock into                      shares of Class B common stock.
      The tables and calculations above exclude                      shares of Class A common stock reserved for issuance under our 2005 Stock Incentive Plan.

33


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED FINANCIAL DATA
      The following table sets forth unaudited pro forma combined financial data and other information of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings.
      We have prepared our combined financial statements as if Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings had been in existence as a separate company throughout all relevant periods. The pro forma combined statement of operations data for the year ended December 31, 2004 presented below was derived from our audited combined financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. The pro forma combined statement of operations data for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and the pro forma combined balance sheet data as of September 30, 2005 presented below were derived from our unaudited combined financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. The operating results for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 include all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring adjustments) that we believe are necessary for a fair statement of the results for such interim period.
      Results for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 are not necessarily indicative of the results expected for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2005 or any future period.
      Our unaudited pro forma results of operations data present our pro forma as adjusted results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2004 and the nine months ended September 30, 2005:
  •  as if this offering had been completed on January 1, 2004, at an assumed initial public offering price of $          per share of Class A common stock, which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and assuming:
  –  the outstanding balances of the approximately $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes issued to Clear Channel Communications are reduced by approximately $                    , representing the balance at                     , 2005 in the “Due from Clear Channel Communications” intercompany account;
 
  –  then, approximately $                    of the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes is contributed to our capital by Clear Channel Communications;
 
  –  then, approximately $                    of the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes is repaid with all of the net proceeds of this offering; and
 
  –  then, to the extent the underwriters do not exercise in full their option to purchase up to an additional                 shares of our Class A common stock (the proceeds of which would be used to repay the then-outstanding balances under the approximately $1.4 billion and $73.0 million of intercompany notes), we exchange up to                     additional shares of our Class B common stock with Clear Channel Communications for the remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes that the proceeds from the exercise of such option otherwise would have been used to repay, such that the notes are repaid in full.
  •  after giving effect to our distribution of an intercompany note in the original principal amount of $2.5 billion as a dividend on our common stock, which note was ultimately distributed to Clear Channel Communications, as if issued to Clear Channel Communications on January 1, 2004.
      Our as adjusted balance sheet and statement of operations data as of September 30, 2005 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2005, present, using the same assumptions and application of estimated net proceeds described above, our as adjusted results of operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2005, as if this offering and the issuance of the $2.5 billion intercompany note had been completed on January 1, 2004.
      The unaudited pro forma information set forth below is based upon available information and assumptions that we believe are reasonable. The historical financial and other data have been prepared on a combined basis from Clear Channel Communications’ consolidated financial statements using the historical results of operations and bases of the assets and liabilities of Clear Channel Communications’

34


Table of Contents

outdoor advertising business and give effect to allocations of expenses from Clear Channel Communications. Our historical financial data will not be indicative of our future performance, nor will such data reflect what our financial position and results of operations would have been had we operated as an independent publicly traded company during the periods shown. Also, the unaudited pro forma statement of operations does not reflect estimates of one-time and ongoing incremental costs required for us to operate as a separate company, which are described in Note 1 below to the unaudited pro forma statement of operations.
      You should read the information contained in this table in conjunction with “Selected Historical Combined Financial Data,” “Capitalization,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” and the historical audited and unaudited combined financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto of us and our combined subsidiaries included elsewhere in this prospectus.
Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Statement of Operations
                                                   
(In thousands, except per share data)        
    Year Ended December 31, 2004   Nine Months Ended September 30, 2005
         
    Historical   Adjustments   Pro Forma   Historical   Adjustments   Pro Forma
                         
Statement of Operations: (1)
                                               
Revenue
  $ 2,447,040     $     $ 2,447,040     $ 1,931,471     $     $ 1,931,471  
Operating expenses:
                                               
 
Direct operating expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    1,262,317             1,262,317       988,448             988,448  
 
Selling, general and administrative expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    499,457             499,457       410,075             410,075  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    388,217             388,217       290,233             290,233  
 
Corporate expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    53,770             53,770       39,397             39,397  
                                     
Operating income
    243,279             243,279       203,318             203,318  
Interest expense
    14,177             14,177       9,874             9,874  
Intercompany interest expense
    145,653       (2,445 )(3)     143,208       133,093       (25,684 )(3)     107,409  
Equity in earnings (loss) of nonconsolidated affiliates
    (76 )           (76 )     9,908             9,908  
Other income (expense) — net
    (13,341 )           (13,341 )     (17,353 )           (17,353 )
                                     
Income before income taxes and cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    70,032       2,445       72,477       52,906       25,684       78,590  
Income tax benefit (expense):
                                               
 
Current
    (23,422 )     (978 )(4)     (24,400 )     (37,767 )     (10,274 )(4)     (48,041 )
 
Deferred
    (39,132 )           (39,132 )     6,023             6,023  
                                     
Income before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
  $ 7,478     $ 1,467     $ 8,945     $ 21,162     $ 15,410     $ 36,572  
                                     
Basic and diluted income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle per common share(2)
  $       $       $       $       $       $    
                                     
Weighted average common shares outstanding
                                               
                                     

35


Table of Contents

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Statement of Operations
(1) The unaudited pro forma statement of operations does not reflect the complete impact of one-time and ongoing incremental costs required for us to operate as a separate company. Clear Channel Communications allocated to us $16.6 million in 2004, $19.6 million in 2003 and $17.6 million in 2002 of expenses incurred by it for providing us accounting, treasury, tax, legal, public affairs, executive oversight, human resources and other services. Through September 30, 2005, Clear Channel Communications allocated to us $11.8 million of expenses. After this offering, we expect to continue to receive from Clear Channel Communications substantially all of these services.
 
(2) Basic and diluted income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle per common share is calculated by dividing income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle by the weighted average of common shares outstanding. The historic basic and diluted is based on                      shares outstanding and the pro forma basic and diluted is based on                      shares outstanding.
 
(3) Includes estimated annual intercompany interest expense of $143.1 million related to $2.5 billion of intercompany indebtedness incurred on August 2, 2005, at an estimated weighted average interest rate of 5.725% for the year ended December 31, 2004 and 5.725% for the nine months ended September 30, 2005. The interest rate on this intercompany indebtedness is based upon the weighted average cost of funds of Clear Channel Communications, so that a change in the weighted average cost of funds for Clear Channel Communications could change the weighted average annual interest rate. A 25 basis point change to the weighted average cost of funds of Clear Channel Communications would change our annual interest expense by $6.3 million. Also includes the elimination of intercompany interest expense incurred pursuant to intercompany indebtedness between Clear Channel Communications and us of $145.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2004 and $109.2 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2005.
 
(4) Represents estimated tax (expense) benefit related to the estimated interest expense adjustment discussed in Note (3) above at our combined statutory rate of 40% for the year ended December 31, 2004 and 40% for the nine months ended September 30, 2005.

36


Table of Contents

Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Balance Sheet
                             
    As of September 30, 2005
     
    Historical   Adjustments   Pro Forma
(In thousands)            
Assets
Current assets:
                       
 
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 91,676     $     $ 91,676  
 
Accounts receivable, net
    679,469             679,469  
 
Due from Clear Channel Communications
    362,154          (1)        
 
Prepaid expenses
    69,060             69,060  
 
Other current assets
    40,928             40,928  
                   
   
Total current assets
    1,243,287                  
Property, plant & equipment, net
    2,172,197             2,172,197  
Intangible assets:
                       
 
Definite-lived intangibles, net
    255,028             255,028  
 
Indefinite-lived intangibles — permits
    212,507             212,507  
 
Goodwill
    760,455             760,455  
Other assets:
                       
 
Notes receivable
    5,821             5,821  
 
Investments in, and advances to, nonconsolidated affiliates
    99,447             99,447  
 
Deferred tax asset
    243,030             243,030  
 
Other assets
    302,915             302,915  
 
Other investments
    835             835  
                   
   
Total assets
  $ 5,295,522     $       $    
                   
 
Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
Current liabilities:
                       
 
Accounts payable
  $ 209,948     $     $ 209,948  
 
Accrued expenses
    325,477             325,477  
 
Accrued interest
    2,443             2,443  
 
Accrued income taxes
    19,520             19,520  
 
Deferred income
    98,135             98,135  
 
Current portion of long-term debt
    152,377             152,377  
                   
   
Total current liabilities
    807,900             807,900  
Long-term debt
    96,759             96,759  
Debt with Clear Channel Communications
    3,963,000       (1,390,000 )(2)     2,500,000  
              (73,000 )(2)        
Other long-term liabilities
    175,965             175,965  
Minority interest
    163,549             163,549  
Owner’s equity:
                       
 
Class A common stock
             (3)        
 
Class B common stock
             (4)        
 
Additional paid-in capital
             (5)        
                 (5)        
                 (5)        
 
Owner’s net investment
    4,179,664          (6)        
 
Retained deficit
    (4,229,060 )           (4,229,060 )
 
Accumulated other comprehensive income
    137,745               137,745  
                   
   
Total owner’s equity
    88,349                  
                   
   
Total liabilities and owner’s equity
  $ 5,295,522     $       $    
                   

37


Table of Contents

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Balance Sheet
(1) From September 30, 2005 through the date we complete this offering, we are recording intercompany transactions with Clear Channel Communications in “Due from Clear Channel Communications.” The balance in the “Due from Clear Channel Communications” intercompany account of approximately $                    on                           , 2005 will be settled by reducing the outstanding balances of the approximately $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes by such amount.
 
(2) All of the net proceeds from this offering will be used to repay approximately $          , assuming the initial public offering price of $           per share, the midpoint of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, of the outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes. The remaining outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes will otherwise be extinguished.
 
(3) Represents the par value of                      shares of Class A common stock issued in connection with this offering.
 
(4) Prior to this offering, shares of our common stock held by Clear Channel Communications will be converted into approximately            shares of Class B common stock.
 
(5) Represents (i) the net impact of the extinguishment of the remaining outstanding balance of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes, (ii) the reclassification of “Owner’s net investment” into “Additional paid-in capital,” and (iii) the receipt by us of approximately $          in this offering net of the par value of our Class A common stock issued in connection therewith.
 
(6) Represents a reclassification into “Additional paid-in capital.”

38


Table of Contents

SELECTED HISTORICAL COMBINED FINANCIAL DATA
      The historical financial and other data have been prepared on a combined basis from Clear Channel Communications combined financial statements using the historical results of operations and bases of the assets and liabilities of Clear Channel Communications’ outdoor advertising businesses and give effect to allocations of expenses from Clear Channel Communications. Our historical financial data will not be indicative of our future performance nor will such data reflect what our financial position and results of operations would have been had we operated as an independent publicly traded company during the periods shown.
      We have prepared our combined financial statements as if Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings had been in existence as a separate company throughout all relevant periods. The results of operations data, segment data and cash flow data for the years ended December 2001 and 2000 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 and the combined balance sheet data as of December 31, 2001 and 2000 and as of September 30, 2005 and 2004 presented below were derived from our unaudited combined financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto included elsewhere is this prospectus. The results of operations data, segment data and cash flow data for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002 and the balance sheet data as of December 31, 2004 and 2003 presented below were derived from our audited combined financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto included elsewhere is this prospectus. The combined balance sheet data as of December 31, 2002 is derived from our audited financial statements. The operating results for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 include all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring adjustments) that we believe are necessary for a fair statement of the results for such interim periods.
      Results for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 are not necessarily indicative of the results expected for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2005 or any future period.
      You should read the information contained in this table in conjunction with “Capitalization,” “Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial Data,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” and the historical audited and unaudited combined financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto of us and our combined subsidiaries included elsewhere in this prospectus.
      The following table presents a non-GAAP financial measure, OIBDAN, which we use to evaluate segment and combined performance of our business. OIBDAN is not calculated or presented in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, or GAAP. In Note 3 and “— Non-GAAP Financial Measure” below, we explain OIBDAN and reconcile it to operating income (loss), its most directly comparable financial measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP.

39


Table of Contents

                                                           
        Nine Months Ended
    Year Ended December 31,   September 30,
         
    2000   2001   2002   2003   2004   2004   2005
                             
(In thousands, except per share data)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)               (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
Results of Operations Data:
                                                       
Revenue
  $ 1,729,438     $ 1,748,030     $ 1,859,641     $ 2,174,597     $ 2,447,040     $ 1,761,308     $ 1,931,471  
Operating expenses:
                                                       
 
Direct operating expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    761,312       861,854       957,830       1,133,386       1,262,317       924,420       988,448  
 
Selling, general and administrative expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    323,871       355,370       392,803       456,893       499,457       358,188       410,075  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    437,349       559,498       336,895       379,640       388,217       288,810       290,233  
 
Corporate expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    52,431       62,266       52,218       54,233       53,770       39,451       39,397  
                                           
Operating income (loss)
    154,475       (90,958 )     119,895       150,445       243,279       150,439       203,318  
Interest expense
    23,037       13,331       11,623       14,201       14,177       11,111       9,874  
Intercompany interest expense
    178,253       220,798       227,402       145,648       145,653       109,239       133,093  
Equity in earnings (loss) of nonconsolidated affiliates
    5,888       (4,422 )     3,620       (5,142 )     (76 )     2,270       9,908  
Other income (expense) — net
    (4,593 )     (13,966 )     9,164       (8,595 )     (13,341 )     (17,210 )     (17,353 )
                                           
Income (loss) before income taxes and cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    (45,520 )     (343,475 )     (106,346 )     (23,141 )     70,032       15,149       52,906  
Income tax benefit (expense):
                                                       
 
Current
    (4,824 )     68,101       72,008       12,092       (23,422 )     6,481       (37,767 )
 
Deferred
    (37,640 )     (5,199 )     (21,370 )     (23,944 )     (39,132 )     (17,730 )     6,023  
                                           
Income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    (87,984 )     (280,573 )     (55,708 )     (34,993 )     7,478       3,900       21,162  
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax of $504,927 in 2002 and $113,173 in 2004(1)
                (3,527,198 )           (162,858 )            
                                           
Net income (loss)
  $ (87,984 )   $ (280,573 )   $ (3,582,906 )   $ (34,993 )   $ (155,380 )   $ 3,900     $ 21,162  
                                           
Basic and diluted income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle per common share(2)
  $       $       $       $       $       $       $    
                                           

40


Table of Contents

                                                           
        Nine Months Ended
    Year Ended December 31,   September 30,
         
    2000   2001   2002   2003   2004   2004   2005
(In thousands, except per share data)                            
    (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)               (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
Segment Data:
                                                       
Revenue:
                                                       
 
Domestic
  $ 885,563     $ 880,720     $ 911,493     $ 1,006,376     $ 1,092,089     $ 800,744     $ 886,649  
 
International
    843,875       867,310       948,148       1,168,221       1,354,951       960,564       1,044,822  
                                           
 
Total revenue
  $ 1,729,438     $ 1,748,030     $ 1,859,641     $ 2,174,597     $ 2,447,040     $ 1,761,308     $ 1,931,471  
                                           
Operating income (loss):
                                                       
 
Domestic
  $ 168,872     $ 30,767     $ 174,381     $ 215,485     $ 263,772     $ 184,808     $ 263,448  
 
International
    38,034       (59,459 )     (2,268 )     (10,807 )     33,277       5,082       (20,733 )
 
Corporate
    (52,431 )     (62,266 )     (52,218 )     (54,233 )     (53,770 )     (39,451 )     (39,397 )
                                           
 
Total operating income (loss)
  $ 154,475     $ (90,958 )   $ 119,895     $ 150,445     $ 243,279     $ 150,439     $ 203,318  
                                           
Cash Flow Data:
                                                       
Cash flow provided by (used in):
                                                       
 
Operating activities
                  $ 320,235     $ 433,459     $ 492,495     $ 329,893     $ 336,637  
 
Investing activities
                  $ (430,844 )   $ (230,162 )   $ (310,658 )   $ (227,386 )   $ (223,189 )
 
Financing activities
                  $ 173,193     $ (222,491 )   $ (182,006 )   $ (95,759 )   $ (48,154 )
Capital expenditures
                  $ 290,187     $ 205,145     $ 176,140     $ 117,733     $ 130,484  
Other Data:
                                                       
OIBDAN(3)
                                                       
 
Domestic
  $ 435,299     $ 362,604     $ 354,328     $ 409,722     $ 450,494     $ 326,359     $ 390,867  
 
International
    208,956       168,202       154,680       174,596       234,888       152,423       142,593  
 
Corporate
    (52,431 )     (62,266 )     (52,218 )     (54,233 )     (53,770 )     (39,451 )     (39,397 )
                                           
 
Total OIBDAN(3)
  $ 591,824     $ 468,540     $ 456,790     $ 530,085     $ 631,612     $ 439,331     $ 494,063  
                                           
                           
    For the Three Months Ended
     
    March 31   June 30   September 30
             
(In thousands)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
2005 Quarterly Results of Operations:
                       
Revenue
  $ 578,959     $ 684,509     $ 668,003  
Operating expenses:
                       
 
Direct operating expenses
    326,054       332,706       329,688  
 
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    129,597       127,316       153,162  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    98,266       96,562       95,405  
 
Corporate expenses
    12,975       13,423       12,999  
                   
Operating income (loss)
    12,067       114,502       76,749  
Interest expense
    3,244       3,223       3,407  
Intercompany interest expense
    36,414       36,414       60,265  
Equity in earnings of nonconsolidated affiliates
    345       5,602       3,961  
Other income (expense) — net
    (2,211 )     (4,524 )     (10,618 )
                   
Income (loss) before income taxes
    (29,457 )     75,943       6,420  
Income tax (expense) benefit
    23,565       (58,431 )     3,122  
                   
Net income (loss)
  $ (5,892 )   $ 17,512     $ 9,542  
                   

41


Table of Contents

                                                         
    As of December 31,   As of September 30,
         
    2000   2001   2002   2003   2004   2004   2005
                             
(In thousands)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)               (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
Balance Sheet Data:
                                                       
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 19,183     $     $ 45,741     $ 34,105     $ 37,948     $ 39,140     $ 91,676  
Current assets
    588,998       642,536       753,289       958,669       1,107,240       1,010,645       1,243,287  
Property, plant and equipment — net
    2,330,256       2,039,002       2,213,817       2,264,106       2,195,985       2,122,346       2,172,197  
Total assets
    7,705,526       7,807,624       4,926,205       5,232,820       5,240,933       5,200,407       5,295,522  
Current liabilities
    1,769,959       1,825,904       642,330       736,202       749,055       726,900       807,900  
Long-term debt, including current maturities
    1,490,135       1,526,427       1,713,493       1,670,017       1,639,380       1,660,164       4,212,136  
Total liabilities
    2,352,752       2,394,226       2,347,262       2,472,656       2,511,280       2,444,447       5,207,173 (4)
Owner’s equity
    5,352,774       5,413,398       2,578,943       2,760,164       2,729,653       2,755,960       88,349 (4)
Total liabilities and owner’s equity
  $ 7,705,526     $ 7,807,624     $ 4,926,205     $ 5,232,820     $ 5,240,933     $ 5,200,407     $ 5,295,522 (4)
 
(1)  Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle for the year ended December 31, 2002, related to an impairment of goodwill recognized in accordance with the adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets.” Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle for the year ended December 31, 2004, related to a non-cash charge recognized in accordance with the adoption of Topic D-108, Use of Residual Method to Value Acquired Assets other than Goodwill . See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Estimates — Indefinite-lived Assets.”
 
(2)  Basic and diluted income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle per share is calculated by dividing income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle by the weighted average common shares outstanding. The basic and diluted is based on           shares outstanding.
 
(3)  We evaluate segment and combined performance based on several factors, one of the primary measures of which is operating income (loss) before depreciation, amortization and non-cash compensation expense, which we refer to as OIBDAN.
 
     See “— Non-GAAP Financial Measure” below, “Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial Data” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Use of OIBDAN.”
 
(4)  Reflects the distribution by us to our parent company of an intercompany note in the original principal amount of $2.5 billion issued to us by one of our wholly owned subsidiaries on August 2, 2005.
Non-GAAP Financial Measure
      In addition to operating income, we evaluate segment and combined performance based on other factors, one primary measure of which is operating income (loss) before depreciation, amortization and non-cash compensation expense, which we refer to as OIBDAN. We use OIBDAN as a measure of the operational strengths and performance of our business and not as a measure of liquidity. However, a limitation of the use of OIBDAN as a performance measure is that it does not reflect the periodic costs of certain capitalized tangible and intangible assets used in generating revenues in our business. Accordingly, OIBDAN should be considered in addition to, and not as a substitute for, operating income (loss), net income (loss) and other measures of financial performance reported in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Furthermore, this measure may vary among other companies; thus, OIBDAN as presented below may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies.
      We believe OIBDAN is useful to investors and other external users of our financial statements in evaluating our operating performance because it is widely used in the outdoor advertising industry to

42


Table of Contents

measure a company’s operating performance and it helps investors more meaningfully evaluate and compare the results of our operations from period to period and with those of other companies in the outdoor advertising industry (to the extent the same components of OIBDAN are used), in each case without regard to items such as non-cash depreciation and amortization and non-cash compensation expense, which can vary depending upon the accounting method used and the book value of assets.
      Our management uses OIBDAN (i) as a measure for planning and forecasting overall and individual expectations and for evaluating actual results against such expectations, (ii) as a basis for incentive bonuses paid to our executive officers and our branch managers and (iii) in presentations to our board of directors to enable them to have the same consistent measurement basis of operating performance used by management.
      The following table presents a reconciliation of OIBDAN to operating income, which is a GAAP measure of our operating results:
                                                           
        Nine Months Ended
    Year Ended December 31,   September 30,
         
    2000   2001   2002   2003   2004   2004   2005
                             
(In thousands)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)               (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)
Reconciliation of OIBDAN to operating income (loss):
                                                       
Combined:
                                                       
 
OIBDAN
  $ 591,824     $ 468,540     $ 456,790     $ 530,085     $ 631,612     $ 439,331     $ 494,063  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    437,349       559,498       336,895       379,640       388,217       288,810       290,233  
 
Non-cash compensation
                            116       82       512  
                                           
Operating income (loss)
  $ 154,475     $ (90,958 )   $ 119,895     $ 150,445     $ 243,279     $ 150,439     $ 203,318  
                                           
Domestic:
                                                       
 
OIBDAN
  $ 435,299     $ 362,604     $ 354,328     $ 409,722     $ 450,494     $ 326,359     $ 390,867  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    266,428       331,837       179,947       194,237       186,620       141,479       127,019  
 
Non-cash compensation
                            102       72       400  
                                           
Operating income
  $ 168,871     $ 30,767     $ 174,381     $ 215,485     $ 263,772     $ 184,808     $ 263,448  
                                           
International:
                                                       
 
OIBDAN
  $ 208,956     $ 168,202     $ 154,680     $ 174,596     $ 234,888     $ 152,423     $ 142,593  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    170,921       227,661       156,948       185,403       201,597       147,331       163,214  
 
Non-cash compensation
                            14       10       112  
                                           
Operating income (loss)
  $ 38,035     $ (59,459 )   $ (2,268 )   $ (10,807 )   $ 33,277     $ 5,082     $ (20,733 )
                                           

43


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
INTRODUCTION
      Management’s discussion and analysis, or MD&A, of our financial condition and results of operations is provided as a supplement to the audited annual financial statements and unaudited interim financial statements and accompanying notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus to help provide an understanding of our financial condition, changes in our financial condition and results of our operations. The information included in MD&A should be read in conjunction with the annual and interim financial statements. MD&A is organized as follows:
  •  Overview. This section provides a general description of our business, as well as other matters that we believe are important in understanding our results of operations and financial condition and in anticipating future trends.
 
  •  Results of operations. This section provides an analysis of our results of operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 and the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002. Our discussion is presented on both a combined and segment basis. Our reportable operating segments are domestic and international. Approximately 95% of our 2004 domestic revenues were derived from the United States, with the balance derived from Canada and Latin America. Approximately 52% of our 2004 international revenues were derived from France and the United Kingdom. Our French operations incurred a restructuring charge in the third quarter of 2005 and in 2003. One measure we use to manage our segments is operating income. Corporate expenses, interest expense, equity in earnings (loss) of nonconsolidated affiliates, other income (expense) — net, income taxes and cumulative effect of change in accounting principle are managed on a total company basis and are, therefore, included only in our discussion of combined results.
 
  •  Financial condition and liquidity. This section provides a discussion of our financial condition as of September 30, 2005 and December 31, 2004, as well as an analysis of our cash flows for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 and the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003. The discussion of our financial condition and liquidity includes summaries of (i) our primary sources of liquidity, (ii) our key debt covenants and (iii) our outstanding debt and commitments (both firm and contingent) that existed as of September 30, 2005.
 
  •  Seasonality. This section discusses seasonal performance of our domestic and international segments.
 
  •  Market risk management. This section discusses how we manage exposure to potential losses arising from adverse changes in foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates.
 
  •  Critical accounting estimates. This section discusses accounting policies considered to be important to our financial condition and results of operations and which require significant judgment and estimates on the part of management in their application. In addition, all of our significant accounting policies, including our critical accounting policies, are summarized in Note A to our combined financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.
OVERVIEW
Description of Business
      Our revenues are derived from selling advertising space on the more than 870,000 displays that we own or operate as of September 30, 2005 in key markets worldwide, consisting primarily of billboards, street furniture displays and transit displays. We own the majority of our advertising displays, which typically are located on sites that we either lease or own or for which we have acquired permanent easements. Our advertising contracts with clients typically outline the number of displays reserved, the

44


Table of Contents

duration of the advertising campaign and the unit price per display. The margins on our billboard contracts tend to be higher than those on contracts for our other displays.
      Generally, our advertising rates are based on the “gross rating points,” or total number of impressions delivered expressed as a percentage of a market population, of a display or group of displays. The number of “impressions” delivered by a display is measured by the number of people passing the site during a defined period of time and, in some international markets, is weighted to account for such factors as illumination, proximity to other displays and the speed and viewing angle of approaching traffic. To monitor our business, management typically reviews the average rates, average revenues per display, occupancy and inventory levels of each of our display types by market. In addition, because a significant portion of our advertising operations are conducted in foreign markets, principally France and the United Kingdom, management reviews the operating results from our foreign operations on a constant dollar basis. A constant dollar basis allows for comparison of operations independent of foreign exchange movements. Because revenue-sharing and minimum guaranteed payment arrangements are more prevalent in our international operations, the margins in our international operations typically are less than the margins in our domestic operations. Foreign currency transaction gains and losses, as well as gains and losses from translation of financial statements of subsidiaries and investees in highly inflationary countries, are included in operations.
      The significant expenses associated with our operations include (i) direct production, maintenance and installation expenses, (ii) site lease expenses for land under our displays and (iii) revenue-sharing or minimum guaranteed amounts payable under our street furniture and transit display contracts. Our direct production, maintenance and installation expenses include costs for printing, transporting and changing the advertising copy on our displays, the related labor costs, the vinyl and paper costs and the costs for cleaning and maintaining our displays. Vinyl and paper costs vary according to the complexity of the advertising copy and the quantity of displays. Our site lease expenses include lease payments for use of the land under our displays, as well as any revenue-sharing arrangements we may have with the landlords. The terms of our domestic site leases typically range from one month to over 50 years, and typically provide for renewal options. Internationally, the terms of our site leases typically range from three to ten years, but may vary across our networks.
      We have long-standing relationships with a diversified group of local, regional and national advertising brands and agencies in the United States and worldwide.
Relationship with Clear Channel Communications
      Clear Channel Communications has advised us that its current intent is to continue to hold all of our Class B common stock owned by it after this offering and thereby retain its controlling interest in us. However, Clear Channel Communications is not subject to any contractual obligation that would prohibit it from selling, spinning off, splitting off or otherwise disposing of any shares of our common stock, except that Clear Channel Communications has agreed not to sell, spin off, split off or otherwise dispose of any shares of our common stock for a period of       days after the date of this prospectus without the prior written consent of the underwriters, subject to certain limitations and limited exceptions. See “Underwriting.”
Factors Affecting Results of Operations and Financial Condition
      Our revenues are derived primarily from the sale of advertising space on displays that we own and operate in key markets worldwide, and our operating results are therefore affected by general economic conditions, as well as trends in the out-of-home advertising industry.
      The outdoor advertising industry is significantly influenced by general local and national economic conditions, as well as the general advertising environment in individual markets. For instance, weak national advertising and a difficult competitive environment in France have led to a decline in our revenues of approximately $14.5 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2005, as compared to the same period for the prior year. In July 2005, we announced a plan to restructure our French operations to

45


Table of Contents

reduce approximately 6% of our French workforce and streamline our operations, which we anticipate will provide cost savings over the next three years. In connection with this restructuring effort, we recorded approximately $26.6 million as a component of selling, general and administrative expenses.
      Government regulation and geopolitical events also impact the outdoor advertising industry. In certain markets, deregulation of the advertising industry may have a negative impact on our revenues. For example, recent changes in French regulation will allow advertisers to place retail advertisements on television by January 1, 2007. We anticipate that such changes will impact our national advertising revenues derived from France as a portion of French retail advertising dollars shift from outdoor media to television. National retail advertising in France is approximately 2% of our consolidated global revenues.
      The outdoor advertising industry is also influenced by the commuting habits of the general population. Population growth and increasing drive and other commute times are key growth drivers for us. Outdoor advertising provides advertisers the ability to capture a growing mobile audience base that spends an increasing amount of time out-of-home. Technological advances also provide opportunities in the outdoor advertising industry. For example, digital display capabilities offer innovative advances in electronic displays. We recently converted seven billboards in the Cleveland area from standard to digital formats and have experienced increases in revenues from those displays. Technological advances are also expected to allow us to quickly and frequently change advertisements on displays, facilitating our transition from selling an advertiser display space to selling an advertiser time on multiple displays.
      There are several additional factors that could materially impact our results of operations. See “Risk Factors” for a more comprehensive list of these factors.
Basis of Presentation
      Our combined financial statements have been derived from the financial statements and accounting records of Clear Channel Communications, principally from the statements and records representing Clear Channel Communications’ Outdoor Segment, using the historical results of operations and historical bases of assets and liabilities of our business. The combined statements of operations include expense allocations for certain corporate functions historically provided to us by Clear Channel Communications. These allocations were made on a specifically identifiable basis or using relative percentages of headcount as compared to Clear Channel Communications’ other businesses or other methods. We and Clear Channel Communications considered these allocations to be a reflection of the utilization of services provided. Our expenses as a separate, stand-alone company may be higher or lower than the amounts reflected in the combined statements of operations. Additionally, Clear Channel Communications primarily uses a centralized approach to cash management and the financing of its operations with all related acquisition activity between Clear Channel Communications and us reflected in our owner’s equity as “Owner’s net investment” while all other cash transactions are recorded as part of “Due from Clear Channel Communications” on our combined balance sheets.
      We will incur increased costs as a result of becoming an independent publicly traded company, primarily from audit fees paid to our independent public accounting firm, Public Company Accounting Oversight Board fees, the hiring of additional staff to fulfill reporting requirements of a public company, NYSE listing fees and shareholder communications fees. Under the Corporate Services Agreement, we will bear the costs of certain services continued to be provided to us by Clear Channel Communications. We believe cash flow from operations will be sufficient to fund these additional corporate expenses.
      Under the Corporate Services Agreement, Clear Channel Communications will allocate to us our share of costs for services provided on our behalf based on actual direct costs incurred by Clear Channel Communications or an estimate of Clear Channel Communications’ expenses incurred on our behalf. For the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002, we recorded approximately $16.6 million, $19.6 million and $17.6 million, respectively, and for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, we recorded approximately $11.8 million and $11.8 million, respectively, as a component of corporate expenses for these services. As mentioned above, we will incur additional expenses associated

46


Table of Contents

with being an independent publicly traded company that were not incurred by Clear Channel Communications in the past. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us.”
      We do not believe that becoming an independent publicly traded company will have an adverse effect on our growth rates in the future because we will be comprised of substantially the same business as the outdoor segment of Clear Channel Communications, and Clear Channel Communications will retain a significant financial interest in us immediately after the offering. Our success will continue to be highly dependent on the overall health of the local and national economies in which we operate and the overall health of the advertising environment in each of our markets. We believe that being a publicly traded company will provide a stock-based currency that could potentially be used to raise capital and to more closely align our management and employee incentives with our business performance.
      We believe the assumptions underlying the combined financial statements are reasonable. However, the combined financial statements may not necessarily reflect our results of operations, financial position and cash flows in the future or what our results of operations, financial position and cash flows would have been had we been a separate, stand-alone company during the periods presented.

47


Table of Contents

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
Combined Results of Operations
      The following table summarizes our historical results of operations:
                                           
    Nine Months Ended    
    September 30,   Year Ended December 31,
         
    2005   2004   2004   2003   2002
                     
(In thousands)   (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)            
Revenues
  $ 1,931,471     $ 1,761,308     $ 2,447,040     $ 2,174,597     $ 1,859,641  
Operating expenses:
                                       
 
Direct operating expenses
    988,448       924,420       1,262,317       1,133,386       957,830  
 
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    410,075       358,188       499,457       456,893       392,803  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    290,233       288,810       388,217       379,640       336,895  
 
Corporate expenses
    39,397       39,451       53,770       54,233       52,218  
                               
Operating income
    203,318       150,439       243,279       150,445       119,895  
Interest expense (including intercompany)
    142,967       120,350       159,830       159,849       239,025  
Equity in earnings (loss) of nonconsolidated affiliates
    9,908       2,270       (76 )     (5,142 )     3,620  
Other income (expense) — net
    (17,353 )     (17,210 )     (13,341 )     (8,595 )     9,164  
                               
Income (loss) before income taxes and cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    52,906       15,149       70,032       (23,141 )     (106,346 )
Income tax (expense) benefit:
                                       
 
Current
    (37,767 )     6,481       (23,422 )     12,092       72,008  
 
Deferred
    6,023       (17,730 )     (39,132 )     (23,944 )     (21,370 )
                               
Income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    21,162       3,900       7,478       (34,993 )     (55,708 )
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax of $113,173 in 2004 and $504,927 in 2002
                (162,858 )           (3,527,198 )
                               
Net income (loss)
  $ 21,162     $ 3,900     $ (155,380 )   $ (34,993 )   $ (3,582,906 )
                               
Revenues
      Our revenues increased approximately $170.2 million, or 10%, during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the same period of 2004. Included in these results is approximately $33.9 million from increases in foreign exchange as compared to the same period of 2004. Our domestic operations contributed approximately $85.9 million primarily from increased bulletin and poster revenues of approximately $41.4 million. In addition to foreign exchange increases, our international operations contributed approximately $50.4 million from approximately $22.9 million related to our consolidation of Clear Media Limited, when we increased our investment to a majority controlling interest during the third quarter of 2005 and which we had previously accounted for as an equity method investment. Partially offsetting this international revenue growth was a decline in revenues of approximately $14.5 million from our media products in France as a result of a difficult economic and competitive environment.
      Our revenues increased approximately $272.4 million, or 13%, during 2004 as compared to 2003. Included in the increase is approximately $128.6 million from foreign exchange increases. Our domestic

48


Table of Contents

operations contributed approximately $85.7 million to the increase, primarily from increased rates on our bulletin and poster inventory. In addition to foreign exchange increases, our international operations contributed $58.1 million to the increase, principally from street furniture sales as a result of an increase in average revenue per display.
      Our revenues increased approximately $315.0 million, or 17%, during 2003 as compared to 2002. Included in the increase is approximately $169.9 million from foreign exchange increases. Our domestic operations contributed approximately $94.9 million to the increase, primarily from increased rates and occupancy on our bulletin inventory and our acquisition of The Ackerley Group in June 2002, which contributed approximately $35.4 million for the six months ended June 30, 2003. In addition to foreign exchange, our international operations contributed approximately $50.2 million to the increase, principally from street furniture sales as a result of an increase in the number of displays and average revenue per display.
Direct Operating Expenses
      Direct operating expenses increased approximately $64.0 million, or 7%, during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the same period of 2004. Included in these expenses is approximately $23.6 million from increases in foreign exchange as compared to the same period of 2004. Our domestic operations contributed approximately $11.6 million to the increased expense of which approximately $5.6 million related to direct production expenses and approximately $6.0 million related to site lease expenses, both of which were associated with the increase in revenues. In addition to foreign exchange increases, our international operations increased approximately $28.8 million, comprised from an approximately $21.7 million increase in fixed rent and minimum annual guarantees and approximately $8.7 million from our consolidation of Clear Media, partially offset by a decline of approximately $1.6 million of various other expenses.
      Direct operating expenses increased $128.9 million, or 11%, during 2004 as compared to 2003. Included in the increase is approximately $76.0 million from foreign exchange increases. Our domestic operations contributed approximately $33.6 million primarily from increased site lease rent expense. In addition to foreign exchange increases, our international operations contributed approximately $19.3 million, principally from higher site lease rent expense and approximately $6.2 million from the consolidation of a joint venture.
      Direct operating expenses increased $175.6 million, or 18%, during 2003 as compared to 2002. Included in the increase is approximately $102.0 million from foreign exchange increases. Our domestic operations contributed approximately $36.1 million, primarily from our acquisition of The Ackerley Group, which contributed approximately $19.3 million in direct operating expenses during the six months ended June 30, 2003. In addition to foreign exchange increases, our international operations contributed approximately $37.5 million to the increase principally from higher site lease rent expense.
Selling, General and Administrative Expenses (SG&A)
      SG&A increased approximately $51.9 million, or 14%, during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the same period of 2004. Included in these expenses is approximately $10.3 million from increases in foreign exchange as compared to the same period of 2004. Our domestic operations increased approximately $10.1 million principally from an approximately $2.9 million increase in commission expenses and an approximately $1.8 million increase in bad debt expense. In addition to foreign exchange increases, our international operations increased approximately $31.5 million, principally from approximately $26.6 million of costs related to the restructuring of our business in France and approximately $3.8 million from our consolidation of Clear Media.
      SG&A increased approximately $42.6 million, or 9%, during 2004 as compared to 2003. Included in the increase is approximately $31.3 million from foreign exchange increases. Our domestic operations contributed approximately $11.4 million primarily from commission expenses associated with the increase in revenue. In addition to foreign exchange, our international operations SG&A declined approximately

49


Table of Contents

$0.1 million. The decline is primarily due to a restructuring charge of $13.8 million in France taken during 2003, partially offset by a restructuring charge of $4.1 million in Spain taken during 2004, $2.6 million associated with the consolidation of a joint venture, as well as increased commission expenses associated with the increase in revenue during 2004.
      SG&A increased approximately $64.1 million, or 16%, during 2003 as compared to 2002. Included in the increase is approximately $43.2 million from foreign exchange increases. Our domestic operations contributed approximately $3.4 million primarily from increased commission expenses associated with the increase in revenue. In addition to foreign exchange, in 2003 our international operations contributed approximately $17.5 million principally from a restructuring charge in France of approximately $13.8 million taken during 2003.
      Our branch managers have historically followed a corporate policy allowing Clear Channel Communications to use, without charge, domestic displays that they or their staff believe would otherwise be unsold. Our sales personnel receive partial revenue credit for that usage for compensation purposes. This partial revenue credit is not included in our reported revenues. Clear Channel Communications bears the cost of producing the advertising and we bear the costs of installing and removing this advertising. In 2004, we estimated that these discounted revenues would have been less than 3% of our domestic revenues. Under the Master Agreement, this policy will continue.
Depreciation and Amortization
      Depreciation and amortization increased approximately $8.6 million in 2004 as compared to 2003. The increase is primarily attributable to approximately $3.0 million related to damage from the hurricanes that struck Florida and the Gulf Coast during the third quarter of 2004 and approximately $18.8 million from fluctuations in foreign exchange rates that impacted our international segment, largely offset by accelerated depreciation on display takedowns and abandonments of approximately $17.1 million recognized during 2003 that did not reoccur during 2004.
      Depreciation and amortization increased approximately $42.7 million in 2003 as compared to 2002. The increase is primarily attributable to approximately $25.0 million from foreign exchange increases, increased display takedowns in 2003 as compared to 2002 of approximately $12.2 million and our acquisition of The Ackerley Group in June 2002 which contributed approximately $2.4 million.
Corporate Expenses
      Clear Channel Communications provides management services to us, which include, among other things, (i) treasury, payroll and other financial related services, (ii) executive officer services, (iii) human resources and employee benefits services, (iv) legal, public affairs and related services, (v) information systems, network and related services, (vi) investment services, (vii) corporate services and (viii) procurement and sourcing support services. These services are allocated to us based on actual direct costs incurred or on Clear Channel Communications’ estimate of expenses relative to a seasonally adjusted headcount. For the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 and for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003, and 2002, we recorded approximately $11.8 million, $11.8 million, $16.6 million, $19.6 million, and $17.6 million, respectively, as a component of corporate expenses for these services.
Interest Expense (Including Intercompany)
      Interest expense increased $22.6 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 compared to the same period of 2004 primarily from a $2.5 billion intercompany note with Clear Channel Communications issued on August 2, 2005. The note accrues interest at a variable per annum rate based on the weighted average cost of debt for Clear Channel Communications, calculated on a monthly basis. The estimated weighted average interest rate for the period ended September 30, 2005 was 5.7%.

50


Table of Contents

      Throughout 2002, we had in place a revolving demand promissory note with Clear Channel Communications. Effective December 31, 2002, Clear Channel Communications capitalized amounts included in the revolving demand promissory note into two fixed principal and interest rate notes. The first note is in the original principal amount of approximately $1.4 billion and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 10%. The second note is in the original principal amount of $73.0 million and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 9%. This capitalization effectively lowered our interest expense for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003 as compared to 2002 because the revolving demand promissory note had a higher average balance than the two fixed rate promissory notes.
Other Income (Expense) — Net
      The principal components of other income (expense) — net were:
                         
    Year Ended December 31,
(In millions)    
    2004   2003   2002
             
Royalty fee
  $ (15.8 )   $ (14.1 )   $  
Gain on sale of operating and fixed assets
    11.7       11.1       7.1  
Transitional asset retirement obligation
          (7.0 )      
Minority interest
    (7.6 )     (3.9 )     1.8  
Other
    (1.6 )     5.3       .3  
                   
Total other income (expense) — net
  $ (13.3 )   $ (8.6 )   $ 9.2  
                   
      The royalty fee represents payments to Clear Channel Communications for our use of certain trademarks and licenses.
Income Taxes
      Our operations are included in a consolidated income tax return filed by Clear Channel Communications. However, for our financial statements, our provision for income taxes was computed on the basis that we file separate consolidated income tax returns with our subsidiaries.
      Current tax expense for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 increased approximately $44.2 million as compared to the nine months ended September 30, 2004. This increase is primarily due to an approximately $37.8 million increase in Income before income taxes for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the nine months ended September 30, 2004. In addition, current tax expense from foreign operations increased approximately $16.5 million during the current period as compared to the prior period primarily due to a change in local country tax law that resulted in the recognition of additional current tax expense and less deferred tax expense for the nine months ended September 30, 2005. During the nine months ended September 30, 2004, current tax expense was reduced by amounts associated with the disposition of certain assets.
      Deferred tax benefit for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 was approximately $6.0 million as compared to a tax expense of $17.7 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2004. The deferred tax benefit for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 primarily relates to the reversal of foreign deferred tax liabilities that were set up at acquisition for certain contract valuations. During the nine months ended September 30, 2004, deferred tax expense was increased $7.4 million related to the disposition of certain assets.
      Our effective tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2004 was 89%. The effective tax rate is a result of our mix of earnings and losses in foreign jurisdictions and certain deferred tax adjustments necessary to transition from being a wholly-owned subsidiary and certain other impacting events.
      Current and deferred foreign tax expense of $16.6 million was recorded on certain international subsidiaries generating net positive taxable income. There were no current and deferred foreign tax benefits recorded on certain international subsidiaries generating taxable losses due to the uncertainty of the ability

51


Table of Contents

to utilize such losses within the applicable carryforward periods. The impact of the foregoing provides for foreign tax expense of $16.6 million on foreign pre-tax earnings of $14.8 million, which is an effective tax rate of 112.2% The foreign tax rate in combination with certain adjustments to our domestic effective tax rate related to (i) additional state deferred tax expense necessary to adjust state deferred tax assets to an amount expected to be recoverable in future years considering the pending Clear Channel Communications group structure changes, and (ii) additional current tax expense of approximately $6.3 million necessary to accrue for tax and interest on ongoing tax contingencies, contribute to our overall effective tax rate for the period.
      During 2003, we recorded additional current tax expense due to certain tax contingencies of approximately $10.1 million. In addition, we did not record a tax benefit on certain tax losses from our foreign operations due to the uncertainty of the ability to utilize those tax losses in the future. As a result of the above items, our effective tax rate of negative 51% resulted in an income tax expense of approximately $11.9 million on an approximately $23.1 million loss before income taxes and cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle for the year ended December 31, 2003.
      During 2002, we recorded a tax benefit from foreign operations of approximately $17.0 million on foreign income before income tax of approximately $7.6 million. The tax benefit was the result of the blending of income taxed in low tax rate jurisdictions and losses benefited in high tax rate jurisdictions.
Cumulative Effect of a Change in Accounting Principle
      The SEC staff issued Staff Announcement No. D-108, Use of the Residual Method to Value Acquired Assets Other Than Goodwill , at the September 2004 meeting of the Emerging Issues Task Force which we adopted in the fourth quarter of 2004. The Staff Announcement states that the residual method should no longer be used to value intangible assets other than goodwill. Rather, a direct method should be used to determine the fair value of all intangible assets other than goodwill required to be recognized under Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 141, Business Combinations. Our adoption of the Staff Announcement resulted in an aggregate carrying value of our domestic permits that was in excess of their fair value. The Staff Announcement requires us to report the excess value of approximately $162.9 million, net of tax, as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle.
      The loss recorded as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle during 2002 relates to our adoption of Statement 142 on January 1, 2002. Statement 142 required that we test goodwill and permits for impairment using a fair value approach. As a result of the goodwill test, we recorded a non-cash, net of tax, impairment charge of approximately $3.5 billion. As required by Statement 142, a subsequent impairment test was performed at October 1, 2002, which resulted in no additional impairment charge. The non-cash impairment of our goodwill was generally caused by unfavorable economic conditions, which persisted throughout 2001. This weakness contributed to our clients’ reducing the number of advertising dollars spent on our inventory. These conditions adversely impacted the cash flow projections used to determine the fair value of each reporting unit at January 1, 2002 which resulted in the non-cash impairment charge of a portion of our goodwill.
Domestic Results of Operations
                                         
    Nine Months Ended    
    September 30,   Year Ended December 31,
         
    2005   2004   2004   2003   2002
(In thousands)                    
Revenues
  $ 886,649     $ 800,744     $ 1,092,089     $ 1,006,376     $ 911,493  
Direct operating expenses
    359,263       347,619       468,687       435,075       399,006  
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    136,919       126,838       173,010       161,579       158,159  
Depreciation and amortization
    127,019       141,479       186,620       194,237       179,947  
                               
Operating income
  $ 263,448     $ 184,808     $ 263,772     $ 215,485     $ 174,381  
                               

52


Table of Contents

      For the nine months ended September 30, 2005, our revenues grew approximately $85.9 million, or 11%, over the same period of the prior year. The increase was primarily due to approximately $41.4 million attributable to increased rates on our bulletin and poster inventory during 2005. Growth occurred across our markets including New York, Miami, Houston, Seattle, Cleveland and Las Vegas. Revenues from our airport, street furniture and transit advertising displays contributed the majority of the remaining $44.5 million increase. Strong advertising client categories for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 included automotive, entertainment and amusements, business and consumer services, retail and telecommunications.
      Direct operating expenses increased approximately $11.6 million, or 3%, during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the same period in 2004. The increase is from approximately $5.6 million related to direct production expenses and approximately $6.0 million related to site lease expenses, both of which were associated with the increase in revenues. SG&A increased $10.1 million, or 8%, principally from an approximately $2.9 million increase in commission expenses and an approximately $1.8 million increase in bad debt expense.
      Depreciation and amortization expense decreased approximately $14.5 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the same period of 2004, due to fewer display takedowns during the current period, which resulted in less accelerated deprecation. During the nine months ended September 30, 2004, our management team made strategic decisions to remove certain advertising structures to enhance overall geographic area profits. As a result of these decisions, advertising structures were removed and their remaining book value was written off as additional depreciation expense.
      During 2004, revenues increased approximately $85.7 million, or 9%, over 2003. Revenue growth occurred across our inventory, with bulletins and posters leading the way. Increased rates drove the growth in bulletin revenues, partially offset by a decrease in occupancy. We also grew rates on our poster inventory in 2004, with occupancy flat compared to 2003. Revenue growth occurred across the nation, fueled by growth in Los Angeles, New York, Miami, San Antonio, Seattle and Cleveland. The client categories leading revenue growth remained consistent throughout the year, the largest being entertainment. Business and consumer services was also a strong client category and was led by advertising spending from banking and telecommunications clients. Revenues from the automotive client category increased due to national, regional and local auto dealer advertisements.
      Direct operating expenses increased approximately $33.6 million, or 8%, during 2004 as compared to 2003 primarily as a result of $21.8 million from site lease rent expense as a result of an increase in revenue-share payments associated with the increase in revenues. Our SG&A in 2004 increased approximately $11.4 million, or 7%, primarily from approximately $5.1 million related to commission and wage expenses relative to the growth in revenue.
      During 2003, revenues increased approximately $94.9 million, or 10%, over 2002. Included in the increase is our acquisition of The Ackerley Group, acquired in June 2002, which contributed approximately $35.4 million in revenues during the six months ended June 30, 2003. In addition to the acquisition of The Ackerley Group, our bulletin inventory fueled the growth. Our bulletin inventory performed well year over year in the vast majority of our markets, with both rates and occupancy up. We saw strong growth in both large markets such as New York, San Francisco, Miami and Tampa and in smaller markets such as Albuquerque and Chattanooga. Top domestic advertising categories for us during 2003 were business and consumer services, media and entertainment and automotive.
      Direct operating expenses increased $36.1 million, or 9%, during 2003 as compared to 2002 primarily as a result of The Ackerley Group, which contributed approximately $19.3 million. The remaining $16.8 million of the increase is attributable to direct production and site lease rent expenses relative to the growth in revenue. SG&A in 2003 increased $3.4 million, or 2%, primarily from $2.6 million related to bonus and commission expenses relative to the growth in revenue.
      Depreciation and amortization increased approximately $14.3 million in 2003 as compared to 2002. The increase is primarily attributable to increased display takedowns in 2003 as compared to 2002 of

53


Table of Contents

approximately $12.2 million and our acquisition of The Ackerley Group in June 2002, which contributed approximately $2.4 million, offset by a decline in depreciation and amortization of $0.3 million.
International Results of Operations
                                         
    Nine Months Ended    
    September 30,   Year Ended December 31,
         
    2005   2004   2004   2003   2002
(In thousands)                    
Revenues
  $ 1,044,822     $ 960,564     $ 1,354,951     $ 1,168,221     $ 948,148  
Direct operating expenses
    629,185       576,801       793,630       698,311       558,824  
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    273,156       231,350       326,447       295,314       234,644  
Depreciation and amortization
    163,214       147,331       201,597       185,403       156,948  
                               
Operating income (loss)
  $ (20,733 )   $ 5,082     $ 33,277     $ (10,807 )   $ (2,268 )
                               
      Revenues increased approximately $84.3 million, or 9%, during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the same period in 2004. The growth includes approximately $33.9 million from foreign exchange increases. Also included in the nine months ended September 30, 2005 is approximately $22.9 million from our consolidation of Clear Media, which we acquired during the third quarter of 2005 and had previously accounted for as an equity method investment. Partially offsetting this increase is an approximately $14.5 million revenue decline from our media products in France. Our revenue growth was attributable to our street furniture and transit revenues.
      Direct operating expenses grew $52.4 million, or 9%, during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the same period of the prior year. Included in these results is approximately $23.6 million from increases in foreign exchange as compared to the same period of 2004. In addition to foreign exchange increases, our direct operating expenses grew approximately $28.8 million, principally from an approximately $21.7 million increase in fixed rent and minimum annual guarantees and approximately $8.7 million from our consolidation of Clear Media, partially offset by a decline of approximately $1.6 million of various other expenses. Our SG&A grew approximately $41.8 million, or 18%, during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the same period of the prior year. Included in these results is approximately $10.3 million from increases in foreign exchange as compared to the same period of 2004. In addition to foreign exchange increases, SG&A grew approximately $31.5 million, principally from an approximately $26.6 million of costs related to the restructuring of our business in France and approximately $3.8 million from our consolidation of Clear Media.
      Depreciation and amortization expense increased approximately $15.9 million during the first nine months of 2005 as compared to the same period of the prior year, due primarily to increases in foreign exchange.
      During 2004, revenues increased approximately $186.7 million, or 16%, over 2003, including approximately $128.6 million from foreign exchange increases. Street furniture sales in the United Kingdom, Belgium, Australia, New Zealand and Denmark were the leading contributors to our revenue growth. We saw strong demand for our street furniture inventory, enabling us to realize an increase in the average revenues per display. Our billboard revenues increased slightly as a result of an increase in average revenues per display. Also contributing to the increase was approximately $10.4 million related to the consolidation of our outdoor advertising joint venture in Australia during the second quarter of 2003, which we had previously accounted for under the equity method of accounting. Tempering our 2004 results were a difficult competitive environment for billboard sales in the United Kingdom and challenging market conditions for all of our products in France.
      Direct operating expenses increased $95.3 million, or 14%, during 2004 as compared to 2003. Included in the increase is approximately $76.0 million from foreign exchange increases. In addition to foreign exchange, direct operating expenses grew approximately $19.3 million during this period, principally from higher site lease rent expense and approximately $6.2 million from the consolidation of a joint venture in

54


Table of Contents

Australia, which was previously accounted for under the equity method. SG&A increased $31.1 million, or 11%, during 2004 as compared to 2003. Included in the increase is approximately $31.3 million from foreign exchange increases. After the effect of foreign exchange increases, SG&A declined approximately $0.2 million. The decline is primarily due to a restructuring charge of $13.8 million in France taken during 2003, partially offset by a restructuring charge of $4.1 million in Spain taken during 2004, $2.6 million associated with the consolidation of a joint venture, as well as increased commission expenses associated with the increase in revenue during 2004.
      Depreciation and amortization increased approximately $16.2 million in 2004 as compared to 2003 primarily attributable to foreign exchange increases.
      During 2003, revenues increased approximately $220.1 million, or 23%, over 2002, including approximately $169.9 million from foreign exchange increases. Revenue growth was spurred by our transit displays and street furniture inventory. This growth was due to an increase in displays and average revenues per display primarily from our street furniture products. Strong markets for our street furniture inventory were Australia, Norway and the United Kingdom. This revenue increase was slightly offset by a decline in our billboard revenues.
      Direct operating expenses increased $139.5 million, or 25%, during 2003 as compared to 2002. Included in the increase is approximately $102.0 million from foreign exchange increases. In addition to foreign exchange, direct operating expenses increased approximately $37.5 million during this period principally from higher site lease rent expense associated with the increase in revenue. SG&A increased $60.7 million, or 26%, during 2003 as compared to 2002. Included in the increase is approximately $43.2 million from foreign exchange increases. In addition to foreign exchange, SG&A grew approximately $17.5 million during this period principally from a restructuring charge in France of approximately $13.8 million taken during 2003.
      Depreciation and amortization increased approximately $28.5 million in 2003 as compared to 2002 primarily attributable to approximately $25.0 million from foreign exchange increases.
Reconciliation of Segment Operating Income (Loss)
                                         
    Nine Months Ended    
    September 30,   Year Ended December 31,
         
    2005   2004   2004   2003   2002
(In thousands)                    
Domestic outdoor
  $ 263,448     $ 184,808     $ 263,772     $ 215,485     $ 174,381  
International outdoor
    (20,733 )     5,082       33,277       (10,807 )     (2,268 )
Corporate
    (39,397 )     (39,451 )     (53,770 )     (54,233 )     (52,218 )
                               
Combined operating income
  $ 203,318     $ 150,439     $ 243,279     $ 150,445     $ 119,895  
                               
USE OF OIBDAN
      In addition to operating income, we evaluate segment and combined performance based on other factors, one primary measure of which is operating income (loss) before depreciation, amortization and non-cash compensation expense, which we refer to as OIBDAN. We use OIBDAN as a measure of the operational strengths and performance of our business and not as a measure of liquidity. However, a limitation of the use of OIBDAN as a performance measure is that it does not reflect the periodic costs of certain capitalized tangible and intangible assets used in generating revenues in our business. Accordingly, OIBDAN should be considered in addition to, and not as a substitute for, operating income (loss), net income (loss) and other measures of financial performance reported in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Furthermore, this measure may vary among other companies; thus, OIBDAN as presented below may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies.
      We believe OIBDAN is useful to investors and other external users of our financial statements in evaluating our operating performance because it is widely used in the outdoor advertising industry to

55


Table of Contents

measure a company’s operating performance and it helps investors more meaningfully evaluate and compare the results of our operations from period to period and with those of other companies in the outdoor advertising industry (to the extent the same components of OIBDAN are used), in each case without regard to items such as non-cash depreciation and amortization and non-cash compensation expense, which can vary depending upon the accounting method used and the book value of assets.
      Our management uses OIBDAN (i) as a measure for planning and forecasting overall and individual expectations and for evaluating actual results against such expectations, (ii) as a basis for incentive bonuses paid to our executive officers and our branch managers and (iii) in presentations to our board of directors to enable them to have the same consistent measurement basis of operating performance used by management.
      The following table presents a reconciliation of OIBDAN to operating income, which is a GAAP measure of our operating results:
                                         
    Nine Months Ended    
    September 30,   Year Ended December 31,
         
    2005   2004   2004   2003   2002
(In thousands)                    
    (Unaudited)   (Unaudited)            
Reconciliation of OIBDAN to operating income (loss):
                                       
Combined:
                                       
OIBDAN
  $ 494,063     $ 439,331     $ 631,612     $ 530,085     $ 456,790  
Depreciation and amortization
    290,233       288,810       388,217       379,640       336,895  
Non-cash compensation
    512       82       116              
                               
Operating income
  $ 203,318     $ 150,439     $ 243,279     $ 150,445     $ 119,895  
                               
Domestic:
                                       
OIBDAN
  $ 390,867     $ 326,359     $ 450,494     $ 409,722     $ 354,328  
Depreciation and amortization
    127,019       141,479       186,620       194,237       179,947  
Non-cash compensation
    400       72       102              
                               
Operating income
  $ 263,448     $ 184,808     $ 263,772     $ 215,485     $ 174,381  
                               
International:
                                       
OIBDAN
  $ 142,593     $ 152,423     $ 234,888     $ 174,596     $ 154,680  
Depreciation and amortization
    163,214       147,331       201,597       185,403       156,948  
Non-cash compensation
    112       10       14              
                               
Operating income (loss)
  $ (20,733 )   $ 5,082     $ 33,277     $ (10,807 )   $ (2,268 )
                               
      Our combined OIBDAN increased $54.7 million, or 12%, for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to the same period of 2004 primarily as a result of approximately $64.5 million from our domestic operations driven by increased revenues across our domestic inventory. Included in the increase is approximately $5.2 million from foreign exchange increases. In addition to the foreign exchange increase, our international segment’s OIBDAN declined approximately $15.0 million primarily from approximately $26.6 million related to restructuring expenses in France during the third quarter of 2005, partially offset by an OIBDAN increase of $10.4 million from our consolidation of Clear Media.
      Our combined OIBDAN increased $101.5 million, or 19%, for the year ended December 31, 2004 compared to the same period of 2003. Our domestic segment contributed $40.8 million and our international segment contributed $60.3 million, including approximately $21.3 million from foreign exchange increases, while our corporate expenses decreased during 2004 by $0.4 million. The domestic OIBDAN growth was attributable to increased bulletin and poster sales while international OIBDAN growth was led by increased street furniture sales. We experienced OIBDAN margin expansion during

56


Table of Contents

2004 compared to 2003 primarily related to a $13.8 million restructuring charge taken in France during the second quarter of 2003.
      Our combined OIBDAN increased $73.3 million, or 16%, for the year ended December 31, 2003 compared to the same period of 2002. Our domestic segment contributed $55.4 million and our international segment contributed $19.9 million, while our corporate expenses increased during 2003 by $2.0 million. Our domestic OIBDAN growth was attributable to bulletin sales and our domestic OIBDAN margin increased partially as a result of The Ackerley Group. The Ackerley Group contributed $16.1 million in OIBDAN and had a higher OIBDAN margin than our overall domestic OIBDAN margin for the first six months of 2003. Our combined OIBDAN margin decreased during 2003 compared to 2002 primarily from a $13.8 million restructuring charge taken in France during the second quarter of 2003. Included in OIBDAN for the year ended December 31, 2003 is approximately $24.7 million from foreign exchange increases over the same period of 2002.
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND LIQUIDITY
Financial Condition as of September 30, 2005
      As of September 30, 2005, we had approximately $4.2 billion of debt, approximately $91.7 million of cash and cash equivalents and approximately $88.3 million of owner’s equity. On August 2, 2005 we distributed an intercompany note in the original principal amount of $2.5 billion as a dividend on our common stock, which note was ultimately distributed to Clear Channel Communications. We intend to use all of the net proceeds from this offering to repay a portion of the intercompany indebtedness owed to Clear Channel Communications.
Financial Condition as of December 31, 2004
      As of December 31, 2004, we had approximately $1.6 billion of debt, approximately $37.9 million of cash and equivalents and approximately $2.7 billion of owner’s equity. This compares to approximately $1.7 billion of debt, approximately $34.1 million of cash and equivalents and approximately $2.8 billion of owner’s equity as of December 31, 2003.
Cash Flows
      The following table summarizes our historical cash flows. The financial data for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003 have been derived from our audited financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The financial data for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 are unaudited and are derived from our interim financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.
                                   
    Nine Months Ended    
    September 30,   Year Ended December 31,
(In thousands)        
    2005   2004   2004   2003
                 
Cash provided by (used in):
                               
 
Operating activities
  $ 336,637     $ 329,893     $ 492,495     $ 433,459  
 
Investing activities
  $ (223,189 )   $ (227,386 )   $ (310,658 )   $ (230,162 )
 
Financing activities
  $ (48,154 )   $ (95,759 )   $ (182,006 )   $ (222,491 )
Operating Activities
Nine Months Ended September 30, 2005 as Compared to Nine Months Ended September 30, 2004
      Cash provided by operations was approximately $336.6 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2005, compared to cash provided by operations of approximately $329.9 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2004. The approximately $6.7 million increase relates primarily to changes in working capital items.

57


Table of Contents

Year Ended December 31, 2004 as Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2003
      Cash provided by operations was approximately $492.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2004, as compared to cash provided by operations of approximately $433.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2003. The change in cash provided by operations resulted primarily from an increase in income before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle of approximately $42.5 million.
Investing Activities
Nine Months Ended September 30, 2005 as Compared to Nine Months Ended September 30, 2004
      Cash used in investing activities was approximately $223.2 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 as compared to approximately $227.4 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2004. The $4.2 million change relates primarily to the approximately $7.5 million used to purchase an additional interest in Clear Media Independent, a nonconsolidated affiliate in South Africa, offset by $12.1 million in cash received on the sale of our investment in SBS Broadcasting, Inc., both occurring in 2004. We purchased approximately $12.8 million more of property plant and equipment in 2005.
Year Ended December 31, 2004 as Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2003
      Cash used in investing activities was approximately $310.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2004, as compared to approximately $230.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2003. The increase in cash used in investing activities primarily related to an increase in acquisition activity during 2004. In 2004, we acquired Medallion Taxi Media for $31.6 million and acquired advertising display faces for $60.8 million.
Financing Activities
Nine Months Ended September 30, 2005 as Compared to Nine Months Ended September 30, 2004
      Cash used in financing activities was approximately $48.2 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2005, as compared to cash used in financing activities of approximately $95.8 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2004. Included in cash flow from financing activities is changes in the “Due from Clear Channel Communications” account which relates to cash transfers between our domestic operations and Clear Channel Communications. For the nine months ended September 30, 2005 we had a net transfer of cash to Clear Channel Communications of approximately $59.5 million compared to a net transfer of cash to Clear Channel Communications of approximately $86.0 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2004. The net amount transferred is significantly affected, among other things, by the change in our domestic operations operating income and cash flow for the relevant period. The “Due from Clear Channel Communications” account has grown during the relevant periods primarily as a result of increases in our operating income.
Year Ended December 31, 2004 as Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2003
      Cash used in financing activities was approximately $182.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2004, as compared to approximately $222.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2003. The decline is partially the result of decreased financing needs from our credit facility. Additionally, for the year ended December 31, 2004 we had a net transfer of cash to Clear Channel Communications of approximately $148.2 million compared to a net transfer of cash to Clear Channel Communications of approximately $154.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2003.

58


Table of Contents

Liquidity
Sources of Capital
      Our primary sources of liquidity and capital resources are cash flows generated from our operations, availability of up to $150.0 million under a revolving credit facility sublimit for use in our international operations through Clear Channel Communications, funding through a cash management note with Clear Channel Communications and available cash and cash equivalents.
      Management believes that future funds generated from our operations and available borrowing capacity of up to $150.0 million under the sub-limit of the Clear Channel Communications revolving credit facility discussed below will be sufficient to fund our debt service requirements, working capital requirements, capital expenditure requirements and the remaining one-time costs associated with this offering for a period of at least 18 months. However, our ability to continue to fund these items and to reduce debt may be affected by general economic, financial, competitive, legislative and regulatory factors, as well as other industry-specific factors.
      Our short and long term cash requirements consist of minimum annual guarantees for our street furniture contracts, operating leases and capital expenditures. Minimum annual guarantees and operating lease requirements are included in our direct operating expenses, which historically have been satisfied by cash flows from operations. For 2005, we are committed to $378.3 million and $177.6 million for minimum annual guarantees and operating leases, respectively. Our capital expenditures were $176.1 million, $205.1 million and $290.2 million for 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively, and have historically been satisfied by cash flow from operations. Our long-term commitments for minimum annual guarantees, operating leases and capital expenditure requirements are included in “— Contractual and Other Obligations,” below. Our cash flow from operations was $492.5 million, $433.5 million, and $320.2 million for 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively. Certain of our international subsidiaries have the ability to borrow under a $150.0 million sub-limit of the Clear Channel Communications revolving credit facility discussed below under “— Bank Credit Facility,” to the extent Clear Channel Communications has not already borrowed against this capacity. At September 30, 2005, approximately $100.3 million was available for future borrowings under this facility.
      As of September 30, 2005 and December 31, 2004 and 2003, we had the following debt outstanding, cash and cash equivalents and amounts due from Clear Channel Communications:
                         
        December 31,
         
    September 30, 2005   2004   2003
(In millions)            
Bank credit facility
  $ 49.7     $ 23.9     $ 50.1  
Debt with Clear Channel Communications
    3,963.0       1,463.0       1,463.0  
Other long-term debt
    199.4       152.4       156.9  
                   
Total debt
    4,212.1       1,639.3       1,670.0  
Less: cash and cash equivalents
    91.7       37.9       34.1  
Less: Due from Clear Channel Communications
    362.2       302.6       154.4  
                   
    $ 3,758.2     $ 1,298.8     $ 1,418.5  
                   
      Bank Credit Facility. In addition to cash flows from operations, a primary source of our liquidity is through borrowings under a $150.0 million sub-limit included in Clear Channel Communications’ five-year, multicurrency $1.75 billion revolving credit facility. Certain of our international subsidiaries may borrow under the sub-limit to the extent Clear Channel Communications has not already borrowed against this capacity and is in compliance with its covenants under the credit facility. The interest rate on outstanding balances under the credit facility is based upon LIBOR or, for Euro denominated borrowings, EURIBOR plus, in each case, a margin. At September 30, 2005, the outstanding balance on the sub-limit was approximately $49.7 million, and approximately $100.3 million was available for future borrowings,

59


Table of Contents

with the entire balance to be paid on July 12, 2009. At September 30, 2005, interest rates on borrowings under this credit facility ranged from 3.1% to 6.0%.
      Debt with Clear Channel Communications. In 2003, two intercompany notes were issued to Clear Channel Communications in the total original principal amount of approximately $1.5 billion. The first intercompany note in the original principal amount of approximately $1.4 billion matures on December 31, 2017, may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 10%. The second intercompany note in the original principal amount of $73.0 million matures on December 31, 2017, may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 9%. We intend to use all of the net proceeds of this offering, along with our balance in the “Due from Clear Channel Communications” account, to repay a portion of the outstanding balances of the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes. Any remaining balances will be otherwise capitalized by Clear Channel Communications.
      On August 2, 2005, we distributed a third intercompany note issued by our wholly-owned subsidiary to us in the original principal amount of $2.5 billion as a dividend on our common stock, which note was subsequently distributed as a dividend in a series of transfers to Clear Channel Communications. This note matures on August 2, 2010, may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time. The note accrues interest at a variable per annum rate equal to the weighted average cost of debt for Clear Channel Communications, calculated on a monthly basis. This note is mandatorily payable upon a change of control of us and, subject to certain exceptions, all proceeds from debt or equity raised by us must be used to prepay such note. At September 30, 2005, the interest rate on the $2.5 billion intercompany note was 5.7%. See “Use of Proceeds,” “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us” and “Description of Indebtedness.”
      Our working capital requirements and capital for our general corporate purposes, including acquisitions and capital expenditures, historically have been satisfied as part of the corporate-wide cash management policies of Clear Channel Communications. After this offering, our working capital requirements and capital for our general corporate purposes may be provided to us by Clear Channel Communications, in its sole discretion, pursuant to a cash management note issued by us to Clear Channel Communications. See “ — Cash and cash equivalents; cash management policies,” below. Without the opportunity to obtain financing from Clear Channel Communications, we may need to obtain additional financing from banks, or through public offerings or private placements of debt, strategic relationships or other arrangements at some future date. Management currently believes that we could raise the funds if needed given our credit profile. Additionally, we will have publicly traded stock that management believes could be used as a source to raise capital through public or private placements of our equity securities. Subject to certain exceptions, the first $2.5 billion of such debt or equity proceeds (plus an amount equal to accrued interest thereon) would be required to be used to prepay the $2.5 billion intercompany note, unless such requirement is waived by Clear Channel Communications.
      Other long-term debt. Other long-term debt consists primarily of loans with international banks and other types of debt. At September 30, 2005, approximately $199.4 million was outstanding as other long-term debt.
      Cash and cash equivalents; cash management policies. Pursuant to the Corporate Services Agreement to be entered into between Clear Channel Communications and us, Clear Channel Communications will be providing us with cash management services to assist us in managing our excess operating cash. These services include:
  •  managing our daily cash position and determining our liquidity needs;
 
  •  administering borrowings and repayments under the revolving credit facility available to our international operations;
 
  •  establishing cash management systems and procedures that help minimize investment in non-earning cash resources while providing adequate liquidity;

60


Table of Contents

  •  initiating all electronic funds transfers;
 
  •  providing bank administration for all domestic bank accounts and for all international accounts established by a domestic subsidiary;
 
  •  administering on-line bank reporting systems; and
 
  •  processing requests for cashier checks.
      As part of the cash management services to be provided to us, on a daily basis, cash from our domestic operations will be transferred to a concentration account maintained by us. The cash will consist of money received by, available funds transferred by wire to, and the collection of good funds on checks and other orders remitted to, us. Pending receipt of good funds on checks and other orders remitted to us, such items will be maintained in lockboxes to be maintained by us.
      In addition, on a daily basis, cash will be transferred from our concentration account to our disbursement account, from which our then due accounts payable and payroll obligations will be discharged. If, after cash is transferred to the disbursement account, there remains a balance in our concentration account, then that amount will be transferred to a master account maintained by Clear Channel Communications and either invested or subsequently disbursed by Clear Channel Communications for its general corporate purposes. If the cash in our concentration account is not sufficient to discharge our obligations for the corresponding day, then Clear Channel Communications may advance funds to us by transferring cash from its master account to our concentration account in an amount, which when added to the amount available in that concentration account, would discharge those daily obligations. We do not have a commitment from Clear Channel Communications to advance funds to us, and we will have no access to the cash transferred from our concentration account to the master account of Clear Channel Communications. Our claim in relation to cash transferred from our concentration account to Clear Channel Communications will be based on the net cash balances from time to time owed to us.
      At the conclusion of each day, the net cash position between Clear Channel Communications and us will be determined by Clear Channel Communications. We will have a daily net positive cash position if cash has been transferred from our concentration account to the account maintained by Clear Channel Communications, and a daily net negative cash position will exist if Clear Channel Communications has had to advance funds to our concentration account. The records of Clear Channel Communications will reflect the net cash balance between Clear Channel Communications and us, which, if owed to us, will be noted in our financial statements as “Due from Clear Channel Communications” or, if owed by us, will be noted in our financial statements as “Due to Clear Channel Communications.” The cash management note from us to Clear Channel Communications and the cash management note from Clear Channel Communications to us will evidence those respective obligations. Each of the notes will be a demand obligation. Interest on the cash management note owed by us will accrue on the daily net negative cash position at a per annum rate based on the average one-month LIBOR rate plus a percentage that corresponds to the percentage paid by Clear Channel Communications on LIBOR-based borrowings made by it under its corporate revolver facility. Interest on the cash management note owed by Clear Channel Communications will accrue on the daily net positive cash position at a per annum rate based on the average one-month generic treasury bill rate for the applicable period. The average one-month LIBOR rate and the average one-month generic treasury bill rate will correspond to the applicable respective rates from time to time published by Bloomberg financial services. If Clear Channel Communications were to become insolvent, we would be an unsecured creditor like other unsecured creditors of Clear Channel Communications and could experience a liquidity shortfall.
      Unlike the management of cash from our domestic operations, the amount of cash that is transferred from our foreign operations to Clear Channel Communications will be determined on a basis mutually agreeable to us and Clear Channel Communications, and not on a pre-determined basis. In arriving at such mutual agreement, the reasonably foreseeable cash needs of our foreign operations will be evaluated before a cash amount is to be considered as an excess or surplus amount for transfer to Clear Channel Communications. When an amount of excess cash from our foreign operations is agreed upon, any

61


Table of Contents

proposed transfer of that excess cash will be further subject to a consideration of the effects of repatriating all or any portion of that amount. Excess cash from our foreign operations which is transferred to Clear Channel Communications will be subject to the record-keeping procedures and note arrangements utilized for cash transferred from our domestic operations to Clear Channel Communications.
      For so long as Clear Channel Communications maintains a significant interest in us, a deterioration in the financial condition of Clear Channel Communications could increase our borrowing costs or impair our access to the capital markets because of our reliance on Clear Channel Communications for availability under its revolving credit facility. In addition, because the interest rate we pay on our $2.5 billion promissory note is based on the weighted average cost of debt for Clear Channel Communications, any such deterioration would likely result in an increase in Clear Channel Communications’ cost of debt and in our interest rate. To the extent we cannot pass on our increased borrowing costs to our clients, our profitability, and potentially our ability to raise capital, could be materially affected. Also, so long as Clear Channel Communications maintains a significant interest in us, pursuant to the Master Agreement between Clear Channel Communications and us, Clear Channel Communications will have the ability to limit our ability to incur debt or issue equity securities, which could adversely affect our ability to meet our liquidity needs. In addition, the $2.5 billion intercompany note requires us to prepay it in full upon a change of control (as defined in the note), and, upon our issuances of equity and incurrence of debt, subject to certain exceptions, to prepay the note in the amount of net proceeds received from such events. See “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Business” and “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us.”
Uses of Capital
      Our primary uses of capital are funding our working capital liabilities, debt service, acquisitions and capital expenditures. Our working capital liabilities are funded through cash flows from operations. Cash paid for interest during the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002 was approximately $175.4 million, $198.3 million and $268.0 million, respectively.
      We have entered into certain agreements relating to acquisitions that provide for purchase price adjustments and other future contingent payments based on the financial performance of the acquired company. We will continue to accrue additional amounts related to such contingent payments if and when it is determinable that the applicable financial performance targets will be met. The aggregate of these contingent payments, if performance targets are met, would not significantly impact our financial position or results of operations. The following is a summary of our acquisition activity for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002:
      2004 Acquisitions. In September 2004, we acquired Medallion Taxi Media, Inc. for approximately $31.6 million. In addition, during 2004 we acquired display faces for approximately $60.8 million in cash and acquired equity interests in international outdoor companies for approximately $2.5 million in cash. We also exchanged advertising assets, valued at approximately $23.7 million, for other advertising assets valued at approximately $32.3 million.
      2003 Acquisitions. During 2003 we acquired display faces for approximately $28.3 million in cash. We also acquired investments in nonconsolidated affiliates for approximately $10.7 million in cash and acquired an additional 10% interest in a subsidiary for approximately $5.1 million in cash.
      2002 Acquisitions. In June 2002 we acquired The Ackerley Group. The transaction was funded by approximately $26.3 million of our operating cash and a non-cash capital contribution from Clear Channel Communications of approximately $612.8 million. In addition, we acquired display faces for approximately $126.3 million in cash and acquired investments in nonconsolidated affiliates for approximately $2.1 million in cash.

62


Table of Contents

      Capital Expenditures. Our capital expenditures have consisted of the following:
                                         
    Nine Months            
    Ended    
    September 30,   Year Ended December 31,
         
    2005   2004   2004   2003   2002
(In millions)                    
Non-revenue producing
  $ 53.0     $ 44.5     $ 70.1     $ 63.4     $ 81.0  
Revenue producing
    77.5       73.2       106.0       141.7       209.2  
                               
Total capital expenditures
  $ 130.5     $ 117.7     $ 176.1     $ 205.1     $ 290.2  
                               
      We define non-revenue producing capital expenditures as those expenditures that are required on a recurring basis. Revenue producing capital expenditures are discretionary capital investments for new revenue streams, similar to an acquisition. Our capital expenditures have been declining since 2002, primarily as a result of fewer revenue producing capital expenditures in our international segment. Due to successful bidding on street furniture contracts in prior years, we needed to supply the street furniture required under the contracts. We have not been as actively bidding on international street furniture contracts since 2002 and therefore have not had the capital needs associated with these contracts.
      Part of our long-term strategy is to pursue the technology of electronic displays, including flat screens, LCDs and LEDs, as alternatives to traditional methods of displaying our clients’ advertisements. We are currently performing limited tests of these technologies in certain markets. We believe that cash flow from operations will be sufficient to fund these expenditures because we expect enhanced margins through: (i) lower cost of production as the advertisements will be digital and controlled by a central computer network, (ii) decreased down time on displays because the advertisements will be digitally changed rather than manually posted paper or vinyl on the face of the display, and (iii) incremental revenue through more targeted and time specific advertisements allowing us to sell more advertisements on a single display.
Covenant Compliance
      The newly issued $2.5 billion intercompany note requires us to comply with various negative covenants, including restrictions on the following activities: incurring consolidated funded indebtedness (as defined in the note), excluding intercompany indebtedness, in a principal amount in excess of $400.0 million at any one time outstanding; creating liens; making investments; entering into sale and leaseback transactions (as defined in the note), which when aggregated with consolidated funded indebtedness secured by liens, will not exceed an amount equal to 10% of our total consolidated shareholder’s equity (as defined in the note) as shown on our most recently reported annual audited consolidated financial statements; disposing of all or substantially all of our assets; entering into mergers and consolidations; declaring or making dividends or other distributions; repurchasing our equity; and entering into transactions with our affiliates. In addition, the note requires us to prepay it in full upon a change of control. The note defines a change of control to occur when Clear Channel Communications ceases to control (i) directly or indirectly, more than 50% of the aggregate voting equity interests of us, our operating subsidiary or our respective successors or assigns, or (ii) the ability to elect a majority of the board of directors of us, our operating subsidiary or our respective successors or assigns. Upon our issuances of equity and incurrences of debt, subject to certain exceptions, we are also required to prepay the note in the amount of the net proceeds received by us from such events. Generally, the following constitute events of default under the $2.5 billion intercompany note: any principal or accrued interest on the principal remains unpaid when due on the stated maturity date (as defined in the note) or upon the occurrence of a mandatory prepayment event (as defined in the note); any accrued interest or accrued expenses remain unpaid three days after the interest payment date (as defined in the note); any provision in the note or any related security document that represents a right or remedy ceases to be binding on our operating subsidiary or available to us; any representation or warranty made in the note or any related security document is untrue or inaccurate in any material respect; breaches of covenants or agreements or the occurrence of an event of default in the note or any related security document; defaults by us in the payment of indebtedness in excess of $25.0 million, a final judgment or order in excess of $25.0 million

63


Table of Contents

against us or forfeiture of property by us having a value in excess of $25.0 million; or the declaration by us or against us of bankruptcy or insolvency.
      Certain of our international subsidiaries that are offshore borrowers may borrow up to $150.0 million for use in our international operations under a sub-limit of the approximately $1.8 billion revolving credit facility of Clear Channel Communications so long as Clear Channel Communications remains in compliance with its covenants under the facility and does not otherwise borrow against such capacity. The significant covenants contained in the credit facility relate to leverage and interest coverage (as defined in the credit facility). The leverage ratio covenant requires Clear Channel Communications to maintain a ratio of consolidated funded indebtedness to operating cash flow (as defined by the credit facility) of less than 5.25x. The interest coverage covenant requires Clear Channel Communications to maintain a minimum ratio of operating cash flow to interest expense (as defined by the credit facility) of 2.50x. Generally, the following constitute events of default under the $1.8 billion revolving credit facility: failure to pay borrowings and interest when they become due; failure to perform or observe covenants contained in the credit facility; failure to perform or observe any covenant contained in any other loan document; incorrect or misleading representations and warranties made in connection with the credit facility agreement; default on any other indebtedness greater than $200 million; the declaration by Clear Channel Communications or against Clear Channel Communications of bankruptcy or insolvency; failure to pay debts as they become due; a final judgment for the payment of money exceeding $250 million; invalidity of loan documents at any time after their execution and delivery; change of control; and failure to comply with the Communications Act or any rule or regulation promulgated by the Federal Communications Commission. A change of control occurs under the $1.8 billion credit facility generally when any person or group acquires more than 50% of the voting interest of Clear Channel Communications or when there has been a turnover of a majority of the board of directors of Clear Channel Communications during a 24 consecutive month period.
      There are no significant covenants or events of default contained in the $1.4 billion and $73.0 million intercompany notes, the cash management note issued by Clear Channel Communications to us or the cash management note issued by us to Clear Channel Communications.
Contractual and Other Obligations
Firm Commitments
      In addition to the scheduled maturities on our debt, we have future cash obligations under various types of contracts. We lease office space, certain equipment and the majority of the land occupied by our advertising structures under long-term operating leases. Some of our lease agreements contain renewal options and annual rental escalation clauses (generally tied to the consumer price index), as well as provisions for our payment of utilities and maintenance.
      We have minimum franchise payments associated with noncancelable contracts that enable us to display advertising on such media as buses, taxis, trains, bus shelters and terminals. The majority of these contracts contain rent provisions that are calculated as the greater of a percentage of the relevant advertising revenues or a specified guaranteed minimum annual payment.

64


Table of Contents

      The scheduled maturities of our credit facility, other long-term debt outstanding, future minimum rental commitments under noncancelable lease agreements, minimum payments under other noncancelable contracts, minimum annual guarantees and capital expenditures commitments as of December 31, 2004 are as follows:
                                         
    Payments Due by Period
     
        2010 and
    Total   2005   2006-2007   2008-2009   Thereafter
(In thousands)                    
Revolving credit facility
  $ 23,938     $     $     $ 23,938        
Debt with Clear Channel Communications
    1,463,000                       $ 1,463,000  
Other long-term debt
    152,442       146,268       4,569       832       773  
Minimum annual guarantees
    1,658,599       378,313       471,406       282,702       526,178  
Noncancelable operating leases
    1,254,014       177,567       290,827       218,027       567,593  
Capital expenditure commitments
    223,716       119,687       63,065       25,222       15,742  
Noncancelable contracts
    8,953       4,215       1,604       883       2,251  
                               
Total firm commitments and outstanding debt
  $ 4,784,662     $ 826,050     $ 831,471     $ 551,604     $ 2,575,537  
                               
      On a pro forma basis, after giving effect to the application of the proceeds of this offering, at an assumed initial public offering price of $           per share of Class A common stock, which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and the distribution of the $2.5 billion intercompany note, as if such transactions had occurred at January 1, 2004, our contractual obligations would have consisted of the following:
                                         
    Payments Due by Period
     
        2010 and
    Total   2005   2006-2007   2008-2009   Thereafter
(In thousands)                    
Revolving credit facility
  $ 23,938     $     $     $ 23,938        
Debt with Clear Channel Communications
    2,500,000                       $ 2,500,000  
Other long-term debt
    152,442       146,268       4,569       832       773  
Minimum annual guarantees
    1,658,599       378,313       471,406       282,702       526,178  
Noncancelable operating leases
    1,254,014       177,567       290,827       218,027       567,593  
Capital expenditure commitments
    223,716       119,687       63,065       25,222       15,742  
Noncancelable contracts
    8,953       4,215       1,604       883       2,251  
                               
Total firm commitments and outstanding debt
  $ 5,821,662     $ 826,050     $ 831,471     $ 551,604     $ 3,612,537  
                               
SEASONALITY
      Typically, both our domestic and international segments experience their lowest financial performance in the first quarter of the calendar year, with international typically experiencing a loss from operations in this period. Our domestic segment typically experiences consistent performance in the remainder of our calendar year. Our international segment typically experiences its strongest performance in the second and fourth quarters of our calendar year. We expect this trend to continue in the future. See “Risk Factors — We have incurred net losses and may experience future net losses which could adversely affect our stock price.”
MARKET RISK MANAGEMENT
      We are exposed to market risks arising from changes in market rates and prices, including movements in foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates.

65


Table of Contents

Foreign Currency Risk
      We have operations in countries throughout the world. The financial results of our international operations are measured in their local currencies, except in the hyperinflationary countries in which we operate. As a result, our financial results could be affected by factors such as changes in foreign currency exchange rates or weak economic conditions in the international markets in which we operate. We believe we mitigate a small portion of our exposure to international currency fluctuations with a natural hedge through borrowings in currencies other than the U.S. dollar. Our international operations reported a net loss of approximately $35.0 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2005. We estimate that a 10% change in the value of the U.S. dollar relative to foreign currencies would have changed our net income for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 by approximately $3.5 million.
      This analysis does not consider the implication such currency fluctuations could have on the overall economic activity that could exist in such an environment in the United States or the foreign countries or on the results of operations of these foreign entities.
Interest Rate Risk
      We had approximately $4.2 billion total debt outstanding as of September 30, 2005, of which $2.5 billion was variable rate debt.
      Based on the amount of our floating-rate debt as of September 30, 2005, each 50 basis point increase or decrease in interest rates would increase or decrease our annual interest expense and cash outlay by approximately $12.5 million. This potential increase or decrease is based on the simplified assumption that the level of floating-rate debt remains constant with an immediate across-the-board increase or decrease as of September 30, 2005 with no subsequent change in rates for the remainder of the period.
RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS
      In March 2005, the Financial Accounting Standards Board, or FASB, issued Interpretation No. 47, Accounting for Conditional Asset Retirement Obligations , or FIN 47. FIN 47 is an interpretation of FASB Statement 143, Asset Retirement Obligations , which was issued in June 2001. According to FIN 47, uncertainty about the timing or method of settlement because they are conditional on a future event that may or may not be within the control of the entity should be factored into the measurement of the asset retirement obligation when sufficient information exists. FIN 47 also clarifies when an entity would have sufficient information to reasonably estimate the fair value of an asset retirement obligation. FIN 47 is effective no later than the end of fiscal years ending after December 15, 2005. Retrospective application of interim financial information is permitted, but is not required. We adopted FIN 47 on January 1, 2005, which did not materially impact our financial position or results of operations.
      In March 2005, the SEC issued Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 107  Share-Based Payment , or SAB 107. SAB 107 expresses the SEC staff’s views regarding the interaction between Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123(R) Share-Based Payment , or Statement 123(R), and certain SEC rules and regulations and provides the staff’s views regarding the valuation of share-based payment arrangements for public companies. In particular, SAB 107 provides guidance related to share-based payment transactions with nonemployees, the transition from nonpublic to public entity status, valuation methods (including assumptions such as expected volatility and expected term), the accounting for certain redeemable financial instruments issued under share-based payment arrangements, the classification of compensation expense, non-GAAP financial measures, first time adoption of Statement 123(R) in an interim period, capitalization of compensation cost related to share-based payment arrangements, the accounting for income tax effects of share-based payment arrangements upon adoption of Statement 123(R) and the modification of employee share options prior to adoption of Statement 123(R). We are unable to quantify the impact of adopting SAB 107 and Statement 123(R) at this time because it will depend on levels of share-based payments granted in the future. Additionally, we are still evaluating the assumptions we will use upon adoption.

66


Table of Contents

      In April 2005, the SEC issued a press release announcing that it would provide for phased-in implementation guidance for Statement 123(R). The SEC would require that registrants that are not small business issuers adopt Statement 123(R)’s fair value method of accounting for share-based payments to employees no later than the beginning of the first fiscal year beginning after June 15, 2005. We intend to adopt Statement 123(R) on January 1, 2006.
      In June 2005, the Emerging Issues Task Force, or EITF, issued EITF 05-6, Determining the Amortization Period of Leasehold Improvements , or EITF 05-6. EITF 05-6 requires that assets recognized under capital leases generally be amortized in a manner consistent with the lessee’s normal depreciation policy except that the amortization period is limited to the lease term (which includes renewal periods that are reasonably assured). EITF 05-6 also addresses the determination of the amortization period for leasehold improvements that are purchased subsequent to the inception of the lease. Leasehold improvements acquired in a business combination or purchased subsequent to the inception of the lease should be amortized over the lesser of the useful life of the asset or the lease term that includes reasonably assured lease renewals as determined on the date of the acquisition of the leasehold improvement. We adopted EITF 05-6 on July 1, 2005, which did not materially impact our financial position or results of operations.
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES
      The preparation of our financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates, judgments and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amount of expenses during the reporting period. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates that are based on historical experience and on various other assumptions that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. The result of these evaluations forms the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities and the reported amount of expenses that are not readily apparent from other sources. Because future events and their effects cannot be determined with certainty, actual results could differ from our assumptions and estimates, and such difference could be material. Our significant accounting policies are discussed in Note A to our combined financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. Management believes that the following accounting estimates are the most critical to aid in fully understanding and evaluating our reported financial results, and they require management’s most difficult, subjective or complex judgments, resulting from the need to make estimates about the effect of matters that are inherently uncertain. The following narrative describes these critical accounting estimates, the judgments and assumptions and the effect if actual results differ from these assumptions.
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
      We evaluate the collectibility of our accounts receivable based on a combination of factors. In circumstances where we are aware of a specific client’s inability to meet its financial obligations, we record a specific reserve to reduce the amounts recorded to what we believe will be collected. For all other clients, we recognize reserves for bad debt based on historical experience of bad debts as a percentage of revenues for each business unit, adjusted for relative improvements or deteriorations in the agings and changes in current economic conditions.
      If our agings were to improve or deteriorate resulting in a 10% change in our allowance, it is estimated that our bad debt expense for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 would have changed by approximately $2.3 million and our net income for the same period would have changed by approximately $0.9 million.
Long-lived Assets
      Long-lived assets, such as property, plant and equipment are reviewed for impairment when events and circumstances indicate that depreciable and amortizable long-lived assets might be impaired and the

67


Table of Contents

undiscounted cash flows estimated to be generated by those assets are less than the carrying amount of those assets. When specific assets are determined to be unrecoverable, the cost basis of the asset is reduced to reflect the current fair market value.
      We use various assumptions in determining the current fair market value of these assets, including future expected cash flows and discount rates, as well as future salvage values. Our impairment loss calculations require management to apply judgment in estimating future cash flows, including forecasting useful lives of the assets and selecting the discount rate that reflects the risk inherent in future cash flows.
      If actual results are not consistent with our assumptions and judgments used in estimating future cash flows and asset fair values, we may be exposed to future impairment losses that could be material to our results of operations.
Goodwill
      Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of identifiable net assets acquired in business combinations. We review goodwill for potential impairment annually using the income approach to determine the fair value of our reporting units. The fair value of our reporting units is used to apply value to the net assets of each reporting unit. To the extent that the carrying amount of net assets would exceed the fair value, an impairment charge may be required to be recorded.
      The income approach we use for valuing goodwill involves estimating future cash flows expected to be generated from the related assets, discounted to their present value using a risk-adjusted discount rate. Terminal values are also estimated and discounted to their present value.
      As a result of adopting Statement 142 on January 1, 2002, we recorded a non-cash, net of tax, goodwill impairment charge of approximately $3.5 billion. As required by Statement 142, a subsequent impairment test was performed at October 1, 2002, which resulted in no additional impairment charge. The non-cash impairment of our goodwill was generally caused by unfavorable economic conditions, which persisted throughout 2001. This weakness contributed to our clients’ reducing the number of advertising dollars spent on our inventory. These conditions adversely impacted the cash flow projections used to determine the fair value of each reporting unit at January 1, 2002 which resulted in the non-cash impairment charge of a portion of our goodwill. We may incur impairment charges in future periods under Statement 142 to the extent we do not achieve our expected cash flow growth rates, and to the extent that market values decrease and long-term interest rates increase.
Indefinite-lived Assets
      Indefinite-lived assets such as our billboard permits are reviewed annually for possible impairment using the direct method. Our key assumptions using the direct method are market revenue growth rates, market share, profit margin, duration and profile of the build-up period, estimated start-up capital costs and losses incurred during the build-up period, the risk-adjusted discount rate and terminal values. This data is populated using industry normalized information representing an average permit within a market.
      The SEC staff issued Staff Announcement No. D-108, Use of the Residual Method to Value Acquired Assets Other Than Goodwill , at the September 2004 meeting of the Emerging Issues Task Force. D-108 states that the residual method should no longer be used to value intangible assets other than goodwill. Prior to the adoption of Staff Announcement No. D-108, we recorded our acquisition of permits at fair value using an industry accepted income approach and consequently applied the same approach for purposes of impairment testing. Our adoption of the direct method resulted in an aggregate fair value of our permits that was less than the carrying value determined under our prior method. As a result, we recorded a non-cash charge of $162.9 million, net of deferred taxes, as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle during the fourth quarter 2004.
      If actual results are not consistent with our assumptions and estimates, we may be exposed to impairment charges in the future. If our assumption on market revenue growth rate decreased 10%, our non-cash charge, net of tax, would increase approximately $25.1 million. Similarly, if our assumption on

68


Table of Contents

market revenue growth rate increased 10%, our non-cash charge, net of tax, would decrease approximately $30.0 million.
Asset Retirement Obligations
      Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 143, “ Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations ,” requires us to estimate our obligation upon the termination or nonrenewal of a lease, to dismantle and remove our billboard structures from the leased land and to reclaim the site to its original condition. We record the present value of obligations associated with the retirement of tangible long-lived assets in the period in which they are incurred. The liability is capitalized as part of the related long-lived asset’s carrying amount. Over time, accretion of the liability is recognized as an operating expense and the capitalized cost is depreciated over the expected useful life of the related asset.
      Due to the high rate of lease renewals over a long period of time, our calculation assumes that all related assets will be removed at some period over the next 50 years. An estimate of third-party cost information is used with respect to the dismantling of the structures and the reclamation of the site. The interest rate used to calculate the present value of such costs over the retirement period is based on an estimated risk-adjusted credit rate for the same period.

69


Table of Contents

INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
      This section includes industry data, forecasts and information that we have prepared based, in part, upon industry data, forecasts and information obtained from industry publications and surveys and internal company information. Media Dynamics Inc., Nielsen Media Research, Inc., Outdoor Advertising Association of America (OAAA), Zenith Optimedia and other industry reports and articles were the primary sources for third-party industry data, forecasts and information. These third-party industry publications and surveys and forecasts generally state that they believe the information contained therein was obtained from sources they believe to be reliable, but that they can give no assurance as to the accuracy or completeness of included information. We have not independently verified any of the data from third-party sources nor have we ascertained the underlying economic assumptions relied upon therein. Similarly, while we believe the industry forecasts and market research are reliable, we have not independently verified such forecasts and research.
      The global outdoor market has emerged as a leading advertising medium that serves as a core branding and marketing platform for companies, both domestically and internationally. Similar to other advertising media, the key competitive factors for outdoor advertising are pricing, location and availability of displays.
      The principal advantages of outdoor advertising include the following:
  •  Facilitates broad reach and high frequency. The outdoor advertising industry is characterized by broad reach and high frequency, as compared to other forms of advertising media. We believe that national and regional brands are increasing their use of outdoor advertising to maximize the coverage and impact of their advertising campaigns. These advertisers benefit from the branding effect and broad exposure that results from the sustained, repetitive viewing provided by outdoor advertising.
 
  •  Drives sustained mass advertising. Unlike other advertising media, such as television, consumers cannot interrupt or selectively avoid advertisements displayed on outdoor structures.
 
  •  Enables selective targeting. Outdoor advertising enables advertisers, such as restaurants, entertainment facilities, hotels and other roadside operations, to target motorists or pedestrians in close proximity to their businesses.
 
  •  Captures increasingly mobile audiences. Population growth and increasing commute times are key growth drivers for outdoor advertising due to its ability to capture a growing mobile audience base that spends an increasing amount of time out-of-home.
 
  •  Offers low cost platform. Outdoor advertising is a relatively low cost medium, as compared to other forms of advertising media. As a result, outdoor advertising is often used as a complementary marketing platform for companies implementing a multifaceted media plan across various media, including print, broadcasting, the Internet and direct marketing. Also, outdoor advertising is used by local businesses that cannot afford costlier alternatives.
Industry Metrics
      According to OAAA, outdoor advertising grew 10.2% in the second quarter of 2005. Based on industry data compiled by us in conjunction with our efforts to highlight for our customers the value of outdoor advertising relative to other media, we believe that this rate was higher than overall U.S. advertising growth in the second quarter of 2005, outpacing television, radio and publishing. Also, according to a study conducted by two researchers from the Louisiana State University Manship School of Mass Communications, the recall rate for outdoor advertising is greater than that of magazines, network television and cable television. Recall is determined by the ability to name an advertiser without prompting.
      According to OAAA, the top 10 industries using outdoor advertising, based on 2004 year-end outdoor expenditures, were: (1) local services and amusements, (2) media and advertising, (3) public

70


Table of Contents

transportation, hotels and resorts, (4) retail, (5) insurance and real estate, (6) financial, (7) automotive dealers and services, (8) restaurants, (9) automotive, auto access and equipment and (10) telecommunications. Also according to OAAA, the top 20 outdoor brands, based on 2004 year-end outdoor expenditures, were: (1) McDonald’s, (2) Warner movies, (3) Miller beers, (4) Verizon long distance, (5) Anheuser-Busch beers, (6) General Motors, (7) Verizon Wireless, (8) Cracker Barrel, (9) Chevrolet, (10) Walt Disney movies, (11) Nissan, (12) Bank of America, (13) Diageo, (14) Toyota, (15) Geico, (16) Coca-Cola, (17) Coors Light, (18) Allstate, (19) Dodge and (20) Dreamworks movies.
Pricing
      Outdoor advertising is a low cost, high impact medium for advertisers. The average cost per thousand impressions, or CPM, of outdoor advertising is approximately one fourth that of newspapers and prime time television and one half that of radio and newsweekly magazines. The average reach of outdoor advertising is approximately twice that of radio and newsweekly magazines, four and a half times that of newspapers and five times that of prime time television. The following table lists the average CPM for advertising media (according to calculations from data in TV Dimensions 2005© Media Dynamics, Inc.) and the number of persons reached for every $1,000 invested in those media in the United States:
                 
        Persons Reached
Advertising Medium   Average CPM   per $1,000 Invested
         
Outdoor
  $ 5.53       180,832  
Radio
    9.91       100,908  
Newsweekly magazines
    11.76       85,034  
Newspapers
    24.92       40,128  
Prime time network television
    26.44       37,821  
Ratings and Measurement
      Unlike for other forms of advertising media, including radio, television and print, no universally recognized methodology has emerged in the United States or internationally as the industry standard for audience ratings and measurement. A number of independent third parties are in the process of implementing new measurement systems designed to measure the demographics of people who pass U.S. billboards. Nielsen Outdoor has also piloted a new audience measurement methodology in Chicago that is currently being reviewed by the outdoor advertising industry. The Traffic Audit Bureau announced plans to develop its own ratings and measurement system from its traffic counts and demographic data supplied by third-party research companies. One of the goals of these efforts is to measure outdoor advertising using traditional advertising metrics used in other media, including print and broadcasting. Additionally, Arbitron has established an outdoor group to provide research services specialized for outdoor advertising.
      These next-generation ratings services may improve measurements within the industry, which may lead to an increase in outdoor advertising’s market share. The introduction of Postar, an outdoor advertising measurement service launched in the United Kingdom in the early 1990s, partly contributed to an increase in market share for outdoor advertising from 4.8% in 1996 to 6.4% in 2004, according to Zenith Optimedia. Other international markets in which we operate are at various stages of developing similar measurement technologies.
Regulation
Domestic
      The outdoor advertising industry is subject to federal, state and local regulation. For instance, The Highway Beautification Act of 1965 (HBA) regulates outdoor advertising on the 306,000 miles of Federal-Aid Primary, Interstate and National Highway Systems roads within the United States. The HBA regulates the location of billboards, mandates a state compliance program, requires the development of

71


Table of Contents

state standards, promotes the expeditious removal of illegal signs and requires just compensation for takings. Size, spacing and lighting of billboards are regulated by state and local municipalities. Periodically, certain state and local governments attempt to force the removal of billboards not governed by the HBA under various amortization theories. When challenged under such a theory, an outdoor advertising company is permitted to “recoup” its investment for a certain period of time, after which the signs in question must be removed. Other important advertising regulations include the Intermodal Surface Transportation Efficiency Act of 1991, the Bonus Act/ Bonus Program, the 1995 Scenic Byways Amendment and various increases or implementations of property taxes, billboard taxes and permit fees. While these regulations set certain limits on the placement or erection of new outdoor advertising displays, they have benefited established companies such as us by creating high barriers to entry and have protected the outdoor advertising industry against an oversupply of inventory.
International
      International regulation of the outdoor advertising industry varies by region and country, but generally limits the size, placement, nature and density of out-of-home displays. The significant international regulations include the Law of December 29, 1979 in France, the Town and Country Planning (Control of Advertisements) Regulations 1992 in the United Kingdom and Règlement Régional Urbain de l’agglomération bruxelloise in Belgium. These laws define issues such as the extent to which advertisements can be erected in rural areas, the hours during which illuminated signs may be lit and whether the consent of local authorities is required to place a sign in certain communities. Other regulations may limit the subject matter and language of out-of-home displays. For instance, the United States and France, among other nations, ban outdoor advertisements for tobacco products.
Competitive Landscape
      The outdoor industry has recently undergone major consolidation, as multiple acquisitions occurred throughout the 1990s. The top 10 U.S. outdoor advertising companies, based on 2004 U.S. revenues, according to OAAA, were: Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Viacom Outdoor, Lamar, Regency Outdoor Advertising, Van Wagner, JCDecaux, Adams Outdoor Advertising, Magic Media, Fairway and Reagan National. We believe that our main competitors in the international outdoor advertising industry are JCDecaux, Viacom Outdoor and a number of regional companies.
Digital
      Digital advertising is a small but rapidly growing niche within the outdoor industry. These units, supported by advanced LED, LCD and plasma technologies, offer unique benefits to advertisers. Unlike traditional outdoor advertising, in which advertisers may buy a display for a week or longer, advertisers can buy digital time slots for as short as a specified number of seconds within each minute, with the ability to change their message dynamically and in real time. While digital displays are capable of supporting full motion video, currently most state and local ordinances (excluding specially zoned areas like Times Square in New York City) allow only static messages, or advertising copy without motion, to be presented and changed on the displays.

72


Table of Contents

BUSINESS
Our Company
      Our principal business is to provide our clients with advertising opportunities through billboards, street furniture displays, transit displays and other out-of-home advertising displays that we own or operate in key markets worldwide. As of September 30, 2005, we owned or operated more than 870,000 advertising displays worldwide. For the year ended December 31, 2004, we generated revenues of approximately $2.4 billion, operating income of approximately $243.3 million and operating income before depreciation, amortization and non-cash compensation expense, or OIBDAN, of approximately $631.6 million. Our domestic reporting segment consists of our operations in the United States, Canada and Latin America, with approximately 95% of our 2004 revenues in this segment derived from the United States. Our international reporting segment consists of our operations in Europe, Australia, Asia and Africa, with approximately 52% of our 2004 revenues in this segment derived from France and the United Kingdom. Approximately 89% of our total 2004 operating income excluding corporate expenses was derived from our domestic segment and approximately 11% was derived from our international segment. Approximately 66% of our total 2004 OIBDAN excluding corporate expenses was derived from our domestic segment and approximately 34% was derived from our international segment. See “Prospectus Summary — Summary Historical and Pro Forma Combined Financial Data — Non-GAAP Financial Measure” for an explanation of OIBDAN and a reconciliation of OIBDAN to operating income (loss). Additionally, we own equity interests in various out-of-home advertising companies worldwide, which we account for under the equity method of accounting.
      Billboard displays are bulletin and poster advertising panels of various sizes that generally are mounted on structures we own. These structures typically are located on sites that we either lease or own or for which we have acquired permanent easements. Site lease terms generally range from one month to over 50 years. We believe that many of our billboards are strategically located to offer maximum visual impact to audiences. Larger billboards generally are located along major highways and freeways to target vehicular traffic. Smaller billboards generally are located on city streets to target both vehicular and pedestrian traffic. Our client contracts for billboards generally have terms ranging from one week to one year.
      Street furniture displays, marketed under our global Adshel tm brand, are advertising surfaces on bus shelters, information kiosks, public toilets, freestanding units and other public structures. Generally, we own the street furniture structures and are responsible for their construction and maintenance. Contracts for the right to place our street furniture structures in the public domain and sell advertising space on them are awarded by municipal and transit authorities in competitive bidding processes. Generally, these contracts have terms ranging from 10 to 20 years and involve revenue-sharing arrangements with the authorities, including payments by us of minimum guaranteed amounts. We believe that street furniture is growing in popularity with municipal and transit authorities, especially in international and larger U.S. markets. Our client contracts for street furniture displays typically have terms ranging from one week to one year.
      Transit displays are advertising surfaces on various types of vehicles or within transit systems, including on the interior and exterior sides of buses, trains, trams and taxis and within the common areas of rail stations and airports. Contracts for the right to place our displays on vehicles or within transit systems and sell advertising space on them are awarded by public transit authorities in competitive bidding processes or are negotiated with private transit operators. These contracts typically have terms ranging from three to ten years. Our client contracts for transit displays generally have terms ranging from two weeks to one year.
      We generate revenues worldwide from local, regional and national sales. Advertising rates generally are based on the “gross rating points,” or total number of impressions delivered expressed as a percentage of a market population, of a display or group of displays. The number of “impressions” delivered by a display is measured by the number of people passing the site during a defined period of time and, in some

73


Table of Contents

international markets, is weighted to account for such factors as illumination, proximity to other displays and the speed and viewing angle of approaching traffic. For all of our billboards in the United States, we use independent, third-party auditing companies to verify the number of impressions delivered by a display. While price and availability of displays are important competitive factors, we believe that providing quality customer service and establishing strong client relationships are also critical components of sales. For example, one service we provide our smaller clients is access to our creative personnel who can assist the clients in designing advertising copy.
Our History
      In 1997, Clear Channel Communications, which was founded in 1974, acquired Eller Media Company. In 1998, Clear Channel Communications acquired Universal Outdoor, giving Clear Channel Communications an outdoor presence in 33 major U.S. markets with over 88,000 displays. Also in 1998, Clear Channel Communications acquired More Group plc, a European-based company operating in 25 countries. Other significant outdoor acquisitions over the last five years include The Ackerley Group, Spectacolor, Donrey Outdoor, Taxi Tops and France Rail Publicité.
      In addition to this offering, Clear Channel Communications intends to spin off the entire operations of its entertainment division into an independent publicly traded company in which Clear Channel Communications will not hold any ownership interest. This new public company will consist of Clear Channel Communications’ worldwide entertainment operations.
Domestic Products
      Our domestic segment consists of our operations in the United States, Canada and Latin America, with approximately 95% of our 2004 revenues in this segment derived from the United States. Our domestic display inventory consists primarily of billboards, street furniture displays and transit displays, with billboards contributing approximately 75% of our 2004 domestic revenues. The margins on our billboard contracts also tend to be higher than those on contracts for other displays.
      The following table shows the approximate percentage of revenues derived from each category of our domestic advertising inventory:
                           
    Year Ended December 31,
     
    2004   2003   2002
             
Billboards:
                       
 
Bulletins(1)
    56%       56%       56%  
 
Posters
    19%       20%       21%  
Street furniture displays
    4%       3%       3%  
Transit displays
    11%       11%       10%  
Other displays(2)
    10%       10%       10%  
                   
 
Total
    100%       100%       100%  
                   
 
(1)  For our internal reporting purposes, wallscape revenues are combined with bulletin revenues. For a description of wallscapes, see “— Other Domestic Inventory.”
 
(2)  Includes spectaculars and mall displays.
      In the United States, our displays are located in all of the top 30 U.S. designated market area regions, or DMA® regions (DMA® is a registered trademark of Nielsen Media Research, Inc.), and in 46 of the top 50 DMA® regions, giving our clients the ability to reach a significant portion of the U.S. population. A DMA® region, a term developed by Nielsen Media Research, Inc., is used to designate a geographic area or media market. The significant expenses associated with our domestic operations include (i) direct production and installation expenses, (ii) site lease expenses for land under our displays and (iii) revenue-sharing or minimum guaranteed amounts payable under our street furniture and transit display contracts.

74


Table of Contents

Our direct production and installation expenses include costs for printing, transporting and changing the advertising copy displayed on our bulletins, and related labor and vinyl or paper costs. Vinyl and paper costs vary according to the complexity of the advertising copy and the quantity of displays. Our site lease expenses include lease payments for use of the land under our displays, as well as any revenue-sharing arrangements we may have with the landlords. The terms of our domestic site leases typically range from one month to over 50 years, and typically provide for renewal options.
Billboards
      Our domestic billboard inventory primarily includes bulletins and posters.
Bulletins
      Bulletins vary in size, with the most common size being 14 feet high by 48 feet wide. Almost all of the advertising copy displayed on bulletins is computer printed on vinyl and transported to the bulletin where it is secured to the display surface. Because of their greater size and impact, we typically receive our highest rates for bulletins. Bulletins generally are located along major expressways, primary commuting routes and main intersections that are highly visible and heavily trafficked. Our clients may contract for individual bulletins or a network of bulletins, meaning the clients’ advertisements are rotated among bulletins to increase the reach of the campaign. “Reach” is the percent of a target audience exposed to an advertising message at least once during a specified period of time, typically during a period of four weeks. Our client contracts for bulletins generally have terms ranging from one month to one year, or longer.
Posters
      Posters are available in two sizes, 30-sheet and eight-sheet displays. The 30-sheet posters are approximately 11 feet high by 23 feet wide, and the eight-sheet posters are approximately five feet high by 11 feet wide. Advertising copy for posters is printed using silk-screen or lithographic processes to transfer the designs onto paper that is then transported and secured to the poster surfaces. Posters generally are located in commercial areas on primary and secondary routes near point-of-purchase locations, facilitating advertising campaigns with greater demographic targeting than those displayed on bulletins. Our poster rates typically are less than our bulletin rates, and our client contracts for posters generally have terms ranging from four weeks to one year. Two types of posters are premiere panels and squares. Premiere displays are innovative hybrids between bulletins and posters that we developed to provide our clients with an alternative for their targeted marking campaigns. The premiere displays utilize one or more poster panels, but with vinyl advertising stretched over the panels similar to bulletins. Our intent is to combine the creative impact of bulletins with the additional reach and frequency of posters. “Frequency” is the average number of exposures an individual has to an advertising message during a specified period of time. Out-of-home frequency is typically measured over a four-week period.
Street Furniture Displays
      Our street furniture displays, marketed under our global Adshel tm brand, are advertising surfaces on bus shelters, information kiosks, public toilets, freestanding units and other public structures, and primarily are located in major metropolitan cities and along major commuting routes. Generally, we own the street furniture structures and are responsible for their construction and maintenance. Contracts for the right to place our street furniture in the public domain and sell advertising space on them are awarded by municipal and transit authorities in competitive bidding processes governed by local law. Generally, these contracts have terms ranging from 10 to 20 years. As compensation for the right to sell advertising space on our street furniture structures, we pay the municipality or transit authority a fee or revenue share that is either a fixed amount or a percentage of the revenues derived from the street furniture displays. Typically, these revenue sharing arrangements include payments by us of minimum guaranteed amounts. Client contracts for street furniture displays typically have terms ranging from four weeks to one year, or longer, and, similar to billboards, may be for network packages.

75


Table of Contents

Transit Displays
      Our transit displays are advertising surfaces on various types of vehicles or within transit systems, including on the interior and exterior sides of buses, trains, trams and taxis and within the common areas of rail stations and airports. Similar to street furniture, contracts for the right to place our displays on such vehicles or within such transit systems and sell advertising space on them generally are awarded by public transit authorities in competitive bidding processes or are negotiated with private transit operators. These contracts typically have terms of up to five years. Our client contracts for transit displays generally have terms ranging from four weeks to one year, or longer.
Other Domestic Inventory
      The balance of our domestic display inventory consists of spectaculars, mall displays and wallscapes. Spectaculars are customized display structures that often incorporate video, multidimensional lettering and figures, mechanical devices and moving parts and other embellishments to create special effects. The majority of our spectaculars are located in Dundas Square in Toronto, Times Square and Penn Plaza in New York City, Fashion Show in Las Vegas, Sunset Strip in Los Angeles and across from the Target Center in Minneapolis. Client contracts for spectaculars typically have terms of one year or longer. We also own displays located within the common areas of malls on which our clients run advertising campaigns for periods ranging from four weeks to one year. Contracts with mall operators grant us the exclusive right to place our displays within the common areas and sell advertising on those displays. Domestically, our contracts with mall operators generally have terms ranging from five to ten years. Client contracts for mall displays typically have terms ranging from six to eight weeks. A wallscape is a display that drapes over or is suspended from the sides of buildings or other structures. Generally, wallscapes are located in high-profile areas where other types of outdoor advertising displays are limited or unavailable. Clients typically contract for individual wallscapes for extended terms. Domestically, our inventory includes other small displays that are not counted as separate displays in this prospectus since their contribution to our revenues is not material.
International Products
      Our international segment consists of our advertising operations in Europe, Australia, Asia and Africa, with approximately 52% of our 2004 revenues in this segment derived from France and the United Kingdom. Our international display inventory consists primarily of billboards, street furniture displays and transit displays in approximately 50 countries worldwide, with billboards and street furniture displays collectively contributing approximately 77% of our 2004 international revenues.
      The following table shows the approximate percentage of revenues derived from each category of our international advertising inventory:
                           
    Year Ended December 31,
     
    2004   2003   2002
             
Billboards
    46%       47%       50%  
Street furniture displays
    31%       33%       30%  
Transit displays(1)
    10%       10%       10%  
Other displays(2)
    13%       10%       10%  
                   
 
Total
    100%       100%       100%  
                   
 
(1)  Includes small displays.
 
(2)  Includes spectaculars, mall displays and other small displays.
      The majority of our international clients are advertisers targeting national audiences whose business is placed with us through advertising agencies and outdoor buying services. The significant expenses associated with our international operations include (i) revenue-sharing or minimum guaranteed amounts

76


Table of Contents

payable under our billboard, street furniture and transit display contracts, (ii) site lease expenses and (iii) cleaning and maintenance expenses related to our street furniture. These expenses consist of costs similar to those associated with our domestic operations. Internationally, the terms of our site leases typically range from three to ten years, but may vary across our networks. Because revenue-sharing and minimum guaranteed payment arrangements are more prevalent in our international operations, the margins in our international operations typically are less than the margins in our domestic operations.
Billboards
      The size of our international billboards is not standardized. The billboards vary in both format and size across our networks, with the majority of our international billboards being similar in size to our domestic posters (30-sheet and eight-sheet displays). Our international billboards are sold to clients as network packages with contract terms typically ranging from one to two weeks. Long-term client contracts are also available and typically have terms of up to one year. We lease the majority of our international billboard sites from private landowners.
Street Furniture Displays
      Our international street furniture displays are substantially similar to their domestic counterparts, and include bus shelters, freestanding units, public toilets, various types of kiosks and benches. Internationally, contracts with municipal and transit authorities for the right to place our street furniture in the public domain and sell advertising on them typically range from 10 to 15 years. The major difference between our international and domestic street furniture businesses is in the nature of the municipal contracts. In the international segment, these contracts typically require us to provide the municipality with a broader range of urban amenities such as public wastebaskets and lampposts, as well as space for the municipality to display maps or other public information. In exchange for providing such urban amenities and display space, we are authorized to sell advertising space on certain sections of the structures we erect in the public domain. Client contracts for street furniture displays typically have terms ranging from one to two weeks, but are available for up to one year, and may be for network packages.
Transit Displays
      Our international transit display contracts are substantially similar to their domestic counterparts, and typically require us to make only a minimal initial investment and few ongoing maintenance expenditures. Contracts with public transit authorities or private transit operators typically have terms ranging from three to seven years. Our client contracts for transit displays generally have terms ranging from two weeks to one year, or longer.
Other International Inventory
      The balance of our international display inventory consists primarily of spectaculars and mall displays. DEFI, our international neon subsidiary, is a leading global provider of spectaculars with approximately 300 spectacular displays in 30 countries worldwide. Client contracts for international spectaculars typically have terms ranging from five to ten years. Internationally, our contracts with mall operators generally have terms ranging from five to ten years and client contracts for mall displays generally have terms ranging from one to two weeks, but are available for up to six months. Our international inventory includes other small displays that are counted as separate displays in this prospectus since they form a substantial part of our network and international revenues.
Marketing Resources
      We have several online tools and resources to help us sell our inventory. Our online rate card is a web-based application that allows users to view all of our markets and products for rates and gross rating point allotments. We also have an online inventory search that is designed to provide users access to photos and maps of all our U.S. bulletins, wallscapes, premiere squares and spectaculars. Our internal web-

77


Table of Contents

based system, FastPitch tm , delivers real-time rate and availability data for each of our U.S. markets, and our account executives use that data to create multi- or single-market advertising programs without having to contact individual markets for this data. FastPitch tm also contains maps, product sheets, market information, shipping information and product specifications. Inventory availability is updated daily directly from each market’s scheduling system.
      Additionally, our account executives use several research products to help sell our inventory. Our account executives assist advertisers in structuring advertising campaigns using computer databases and mapping software to analyze target audiences and consumer products and services. By examining demographic profiles, socioeconomic information and consumer buying power, our research allows us to create smart, effective purchases for our advertisers.
Production
Domestic
      In a majority of our markets, our local production staff performs the full range of activities required to create and install advertising copy. Production work includes creating the advertising copy design and layout, coordinating its printing and installing the copy on displays. We provide creative services to smaller advertisers and to advertisers that are not represented by advertising agencies. National advertisers often use preprinted designs that require only installation. Our creative and production personnel typically develop new designs or adopt copy from other media for use on our inventory. Our creative staff also can assist in the development of marketing presentations, demonstrations and strategies to attract new clients.
International
      The majority of our international clients are advertisers targeting national audiences whose business generally is placed with us through advertising agencies. These agencies often provide our international clients creative services to design and produce both the advertising copy and the physical printed advertisement. Advertising copy, both paper and vinyl, is shipped to centralized warehouses operated by us. The copy is then sorted and delivered to sites where it is installed on our displays.
Client Categories
      In 2004, the top five client categories in our domestic segment, based on domestic revenues derived from these categories, were entertainment and amusements, business and consumer services, automotive, retail and insurance and real estate. In 2004, the top five client categories in our international segment, based on international revenues derived from those categories, were automotive, food and drink, media and entertainment, retail and telecommunications.
Our Markets
      Approximately 95% of our 2004 domestic revenues were derived from the United States and approximately 52% of our 2004 international revenues were derived from France and the United Kingdom. The following table sets forth certain information regarding displays that we own or operate in domestic and international markets worldwide. As of September 30, 2005, we owned or operated approximately 164,000 domestic displays and approximately 709,000 international displays. Our domestic markets are listed in order of their DMA® region ranking and our international markets are listed in descending order according to revenues contribution.

78


Table of Contents

Our Domestic Displays
                                                         
DMA®       Billboards   Street            
Region           Furniture   Transit   Other   Total
Rank   Domestic Markets   Bulletins(1)   Posters   Displays   Displays   Displays(2)   Displays
                             
        United States                                                
  1     New York, NY                                   18,214  
  2     Los Angeles, CA                                   11,789  
  3     Chicago, IL                         (3)           11,673  
  4     Philadelphia, PA                                   6,525  
  5     San Francisco-Oakland-San Jose, CA                                   6,722  
  6     Boston, MA (Manchester, NH)                                     6,926  
  7     Dallas-Ft. Worth, TX                                     6,956  
  8     Washington, DC (Hagerstown, MD)                                   3,708  
  9     Atlanta, GA                                     3,313  
  10     Houston, TX                         (3)           4,742  
  11     Detroit, MI                                         547  
  12     Seattle-Tacoma, WA                                     3,312  
  13     Minneapolis-St. Paul, MN                                     1,977  
  14     Phoenix (Prescott), AZ                               (3)     1,464  
  15     Miami-Ft. Lauderdale, FL                             (3)     3,701  
  16     Tampa-St. Petersburg (Sarasota), FL                                       1,963  
  17     Cleveland-Akron (Canton), OH                                     2,448  
  18     Sacramento-Stockton-Modesto, CA                                     958  
  19     Denver, CO                                         685  
  20     Orlando-Daytona Beach-Melbourne, FL                                     3,465  
  21     St. Louis, MO                                         234  
  22     Pittsburgh, PA                           (3)           528  
  23     San Diego, CA                               (3)     1,334  
  24     Portland, OR                                       1,294  
  25     Baltimore, MD                                 (3)     2,025  
  26     Indianapolis, IN                                       1,981  
  27     Hartford-New Haven, CT                                           6  
  28     Charlotte, NC                                           12  
  29     Raleigh-Durham (Fayetteville), NC                                           10  
  30     Nashville, TN                                           21  
  31     Salt Lake City, UT                                         124  
  32     Kansas City, KS/ MO                             (3)              
  33     Milwaukee, WI                                       1,700  
  34     Cincinnati, OH                                           8  
  35     Columbus, OH                                       1,401  
  37     San Antonio, TX                         (3)     (3)     3,016  
  39     Norfolk-Portsmouth-Newport News, VA                                           8  
  40     West Palm Beach-Ft. Pierce, FL                                         372  
  42     New Orleans, LA                                           2,775  
  43     Memphis, TN                                     2,200  
  44     Harrisburg-Lancaster-Lebanon-York, PA                                           36  
  45     Albuquerque-Santa Fe, NM                                         1,097  
  47     Oklahoma City, OK                                           12  
  48     Buffalo, NY                                           240  
  49     Fresno-Visalia, CA                                           10  
  50     Las Vegas, NV                               (3)     11,295  
  52     Louisville, KY                                           16  
  53     Jacksonville, FL                                         866  
  54     Wilkes Barre-Scranton, PA                                           39  
  55     Austin, TX                             (3)           16  
  56     Hudson Valley, NY                                         376  
  57     Richmond-Petersburg, VA                                           12  
  62     Knoxville, TN                                           13  
  63     Charleston-Huntington, WV                                           9  
  67     Wichita-Hutchinson, KS                                         673  
  72     Tucson (Sierra Vista), AZ                                         1,550  
  73     Des Moines-Ames, IA                                 (3)     672  
  87     Chattanooga, TN                                       1,562  
  89     Northpark, MS                                     (3)     6  
  91     Cedar Rapids-Waterloo-Iowa City-Dubuque, IA                                           12  
  93     El Paso, TX (Las Cruces, NM)                                         1,305  
  94     Colorado Springs-Pueblo, CO                                           7  
  97     Johnstown-Altoona, PA                                           20  
  101     Youngstown, OH                                           8  
  104     Monterey-Salinas, CA                                           40  
  107     Ft. Smith-Fayetteville-Springdale-Rogers, AR                                       914  
  113     Reno, NV                                       574  
  114     Tallahassee, FL-Thomasville, GA                                           9  

79


Table of Contents

                                                         
DMA®       Billboards   Street            
Region           Furniture   Transit   Other   Total
Rank   Domestic Markets   Bulletins(1)   Posters   Displays   Displays   Displays(2)   Displays
                             
  115     Augusta, GA                                     (3)      
  117     Sioux Falls (Mitchell), SD                                           19  
  142     Sioux City, IA                                           8  
  145     Lubbock, TX                                           16  
  148     Palm Springs, CA                                           12  
  150     Salisbury, MD                         (3)           1,247  
  163     Ocala-Gainesville, FL                                         1,317  
  171     Billings, MT                                           8  
  176     Rapid City, SD                                           10  
  189     Great Falls, MT                                           14  
  190     Grand Junction-Aspen-Montrose, CO                                         51  
  n/a     Newport, RI                                           25  
  n/a     Wilmington, DE                             (3)     (3)      
        Domestic Non-U.S.                                                
  n/a     Brazil                                     8,243  
  n/a     Canada                                     2,669  
  n/a     Chile                                         1,272  
  n/a     Mexico                                         4,922  
  n/a     Peru                                   2,512  
                                           
Total Domestic Displays     163,871  
 
(1)  Includes wallscapes.
 
(2)  Includes spectaculars and mall displays.
 
(3)  We have access to additional displays through arrangements with local advertising and other companies.
Our International Displays
                                         
        Street            
        Furniture   Transit   Other   Total
International Markets   Billboards   Displays   Displays(1)   Displays(2)   Displays
                     
France
                            170,500  
United Kingdom
                            92,344  
Italy
                            50,918  
Spain
                            34,645  
China(3)
                            52,746  
Sweden
                            102,124  
Switzerland
                              16,892  
Belgium
                            22,407  
Australia
                                12,829  
Norway
                              20,544  
Denmark
                            28,836  
Ireland
                                5,947  
Russia
                              4,703  
Greece
                                1,193  
Finland
                            44,584  
Poland
                            12,596  
Singapore
                                10,626  
Holland
                              2,743  
Turkey
                            5,628  
New Zealand
                                2,979  
Baltic States
                                12,857  
Portugal
                                  18  
India
                              403  
Germany
                                  80  
Hungary
                                  25  
Czech Republic
                                  5  
Austria
                                  4  
Ukraine
                                  2  
Dubai
                                  1  
                                 
Total International Displays     709,179  
 
(1)  Includes small displays.
 
(2)  Includes spectaculars, mall displays and other small displays.
 
(3)  In July 2005 Clear Media became a consolidated subsidiary when we increased our investment to a majority controlling interest.

80


Table of Contents

Equity Investments
      In addition to the more than 870,000 displays we owned and operated worldwide as of September 30, 2005, we have made equity investments in various out-of-home advertising companies that operate in the following markets:
                                             
                Street        
        Equity       Furniture   Transit   Other
Market   Company   Investment(1)   Billboards   Displays   Displays   Displays(2)
                         
Outdoor Advertising Companies                                        
South Africa(3)
  Clear Channel Independent     50.0 %                          
Italy
  Alessi     35.0 %                          
Italy
  AD Moving SpA     17.5 %                            
Hong Kong
  Buspak     50.0 %                            
Thailand
  Master & More     32.5 %                              
Korea
  Ad Sky Korea     30.0 %                              
Belgium
  MTB     49.0 %                              
Belgium
  Streep     25.0 %                              
Denmark
  City Reklame     45.0 %                              
Other Media Companies                                        
Norway
  CAPA     50.0 %                                
Holland
  Kamasutra     49.0 %                                
 
(1)  As of September 30, 2005.
 
(2)  Includes spectaculars, mall displays and other small displays.
 
(3)  Clear Channel Independent is headquartered and has the majority of its operations in South Africa, but also operates in other African countries such as Angola, Botswana, Lesotho, Malawi, Mauritius, Mozambique, Namibia, Swaziland, Tanzania, Uganda and Zambia.
Construction and Operation
Domestic
      We typically own the physical structures on which our clients’ advertising copy is displayed. We build some of the structures at our billboard fabrication business in Illinois and erect them on sites we either lease or own or for which we have acquired permanent easements. The site lease terms are typically 10 to 20 years and often contain renewal provisions with rental payments escalating pursuant to various formulas. In addition to the site lease, we must obtain a permit to build the sign. Permits are typically issued in perpetuity by the state or local government and typically are transferable or renewable for a minimal, or no, fee. Bulletin and poster advertising copy is either printed with computer generated graphics on a single sheet of vinyl or placed on lithographed or silk-screened paper sheets supplied by the advertiser. These advertisements are then transported to the site and in the case of vinyl wrapped around the face, and in the case of paper pasted and applied like wallpaper. The operational process also includes conducting visual inspections of the inventory for display defects and taking the necessary corrective action within a reasonable period of time.
International
      The international manufacturing process largely consists of two elements: the manufacture and installation of advertising structures and the weekly preparation of advertising posters for distribution throughout our networks. Generally, we outsource the manufacturing of advertising structures to third parties and regularly seek competitive bids. We use a wide range of suppliers, located in each of our

81


Table of Contents

markets, none of whom represents more than 10% of our manufacturing budget in any one year. The design of street furniture structures (such as bus shelters, bicycle racks, kiosks and public toilets) is typically done in conjunction with a third-party design or architecture firm. These street furniture designs then form the basis of a competitive bidding process to select a manufacturer. Our street furniture sites are posted by our own employees or subcontractors who also clean and maintain the sites. The decision to use our own employees or subcontractors is made on a market-by-market basis taking into consideration the mix of products in the market and local labor costs.
Our Competitive Strengths
      We believe our key competitive strengths are as follows:
Leading positions in key markets
      We believe that our presence in key markets gives our clients the ability to reach a global audience through one advertising provider. As of September 30, 2005, we owned or operated more than 870,000 advertising displays worldwide. Our displays are located in all of the top 30 U.S. designated market area regions, or DMA® regions, and in 46 of the top 50 DMA® regions, giving our clients the ability to reach a significant portion of the U.S. population. In addition, as of September 30, 2005, we owned or operated displays in approximately 50 countries in North and South America, Europe, Australia, Asia and Africa, providing us with a global market presence.
Diversified and global client base
      We have long-standing relationships with a diversified group of local, regional and national advertising brands and agencies in the United States and worldwide. In 2004, the top five client categories in our domestic segment, based on domestic revenues derived from these categories, were entertainment and amusements, business and consumer services, automotive, retail, and insurance and real estate. In 2004, the top five client categories in our international segment, based on international revenues derived from those categories, were automotive, food and drink, media and entertainment, retail and telecommunications. No single advertiser accounted for more than 2% of our 2004 domestic or international revenues.
Business model with significant financial flexibility
      We have historically generated high levels of cash flow from operations due to consistent revenue growth with disciplined control of operating expenditures. Our cash flow from operations was approximately $492.5 million in 2004, $433.5 million in 2003 and $320.2 million in 2002. Operating cash flow through the first nine months of 2005 was $336.6 million and through the first nine months of 2004 was $329.9 million. Total revenue increased at a 9.1% compounded annual rate from 2000 to 2004. We believe that these high levels of cash flow from operations provide us with strategic and financial flexibility and, together with our ability to use our publicly traded common stock as acquisition currency, will position us to opportunistically pursue attractive acquisitions and investments.
Positioned to capitalize on new technologies
      We believe that we are well-positioned to take advantage of significant technological advances and the corresponding improvements in advertisers’ abilities to present engaging campaigns to their target audiences. In particular, we believe that we are prepared to capitalize on the growing trend of digital outdoor displays. We have a dedicated team tasked with determining the most effective deployment of networked digital sign technologies to enhance the revenue-generating capacity of our assets in existing and new markets worldwide. In July 2005, we launched our first networked digital trial on select bulletins in Cleveland, Ohio and plan to launch similar pilots in other U.S. and international markets. Of the seven billboards that we converted from a standard to digital format in Cleveland, we have experienced significant increases in revenues from those displays. We are evaluating the additional capital improvement costs relative to the increased revenue and the regulatory issues surrounding possible future conversions.

82


Table of Contents

We anticipate that these trials will provide us with significant experience in shaping our long-term digital strategy.
Experienced senior management team
      Our senior management team is led by Mark P. Mays, Paul J. Meyer and Randall T. Mays, each of whom has extensive experience in the outdoor advertising industry. The experience of our senior management team extends internationally with regionally based teams that oversee our respective international markets.
Positioned to capitalize on emerging international opportunities
      We believe that our financial strength and flexibility, our existing presence in key markets worldwide and our experienced senior management team position us well to capitalize on emerging international opportunities. Accordingly, we have engaged in acquisitions and investment opportunities in the global out-of-home advertising industry. For instance, in July 2005, we made an additional equity investment in Clear Media Limited, one of the largest outdoor advertising companies in China, that gave us a majority ownership interest in the company.
Our Strategy
      Our fundamental goal is to increase stockholder value by maximizing our cash flow from operations worldwide. Accomplishing this goal requires the successful implementation of the following strategies:
Capitalize on global network and diversified product mix
      We seek to capitalize on our global network and diversified product mix to maximize revenues and increase profits. We can increase our operating margins by spreading our fixed investment costs over our broad asset base. In addition, by sharing best practices both domestically and internationally, we can quickly and effectively replicate our successes throughout the markets in which we operate. We believe that our diversified product mix and long-standing presence in many of our existing markets provide us with the platform necessary to launch new products and test new initiatives in a reliable and cost-effective manner.
Highlight the value of outdoor advertising relative to other media
      We seek to enhance revenue opportunities by focusing on specific initiatives that highlight the value of outdoor advertising relative to other media. We have made significant investments in research tools that enable our clients to better understand how our displays can successfully reach their target audiences and promote their advertising campaigns. Also, we are working closely with clients, advertising agencies and other diversified media companies to develop more sophisticated systems that will provide improved demographic measurements of outdoor advertising. We believe that these measurement systems will further enhance the attractiveness of outdoor advertising for both existing clients and new advertisers.
Continue to focus on achieving operating efficiencies
      We continue to focus on achieving operating efficiencies throughout our global network. For example, in most of our U.S. markets, we have been transitioning our compensation programs in our operations departments from hourly-wage scales to productivity-based programs. We have decreased operating costs and capital needs by introducing energy-saving lighting systems and innovative processes for changing advertising copy on our displays. Additionally, in certain heavy storm areas we continue to convert large format billboards to sectionless panels that face less wind resistance, reducing our weather-related losses in such areas.

83


Table of Contents

Promote customer service
      We believe that customer service is critical, and we have made significant commitments to provide innovative services to our clients. For example, we provide our U.S. clients with online access to information about our inventory, including pictures, locations and other pertinent display data that is helpful in their buying decisions. Additionally, in the United States we recently introduced a service guaranty in which we have committed to specific monitoring and reporting services to provide greater accountability and enhance customer satisfaction. We also introduced a proprietary online proof-of-performance system that is an additional tool our clients may use to measure our accountability. This system provides our clients with information about the dates on which their advertising copy is installed or removed from any display in their advertising program.
Pursue attractive acquisitions and other investments worldwide
      Through acquisitions and investments, we intend to strengthen our presence in existing markets and selectively enter into new markets where the returns and growth potential of such expansion are consistent with our fundamental goal of increasing stockholder value. In particular, in recent years we have steadily added to our presence in Europe, Asia and Latin America. All three regions continue to offer additional growth opportunities.
Pursue new cost-effective technologies
      Advances in electronic displays, including flat screens, LCDs and LEDs, as well as corresponding reductions in costs, allow us to provide these technologies as alternatives to traditional methods of displaying our clients’ advertisements. These electronic displays may be linked through centralized computer systems to instantaneously and simultaneously change static advertisements on a large number of displays. We believe that these capabilities will allow us to transition from selling space on a display to a single advertiser to selling time on that display to multiple advertisers. We believe this transition will create new advertising opportunities for our existing clients and will attract new advertisers, such as certain retailers that desire to change advertisements frequently and on short notice. For example, these technologies will allow retailers to promote weekend sales with the flexibility during the sales to make multiple changes to the advertised products and prices.
Maintain an entrepreneurial culture
      We maintain an entrepreneurial and customer-oriented culture by empowering local market managers to operate their businesses as separate profit centers, subject to centralized oversight. A portion of our managers’ compensation is dependent upon the financial success of their individual business units. This culture motivates local market managers to maximize our cash flow from operations by providing high-quality service to our clients and seeking innovative ways to deploy capital to further grow their businesses. Our managers also have full access to our extensive centralized resources, including sales training, research tools, shared best practices, global procurement and financial and legal support.
Employees
      As of September 30, 2005, we had approximately 2,700 domestic employees and approximately 4,900 international employees, of which approximately 100 were employed in corporate activities. As of September 30, 2005, 273 of our U.S. employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. We believe that our relationship with our employees is good.
Properties and Facilities
      Our worldwide corporate headquarters are in San Antonio, Texas. The headquarters of our domestic advertising operations are in Phoenix, Arizona, and the headquarters of our international operations are in London, England. The types of properties required to support each of our advertising branches include offices, production facilities and structure sites. A branch and production facility is generally located in an industrial or warehouse district.
      We own or have acquired permanent easements for relatively few parcels of real property that serve as the sites for our outdoor displays. Our remaining outdoor display sites are leased. Our leases are for

84


Table of Contents

varying terms ranging from month-to-month to year-to-year and can be for terms of 10 years or longer, and many provide for renewal options. There is no significant concentration of displays under any one lease or subject to negotiation with any one landlord. We believe that an important part of our management activity is to negotiate suitable lease renewals and extensions.
Legal Proceedings
      From time to time, we are involved in legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. Under our agreements with Clear Channel Communications, we have assumed and will indemnify Clear Channel Communications for liabilities related to our business. Other than as described below, we do not believe there is any litigation pending that would have, individually or in the aggregate, a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash flow.
      We are the defendant in a lawsuit filed October 20, 1998 by Jorge Luis Cabrera, Sr., and Martha Serrano, as personal representatives of the Estate of Jorge Luis Cabrera, Jr., in the 11 th Judicial Circuit in and for Miami-Dade County, Florida. The plaintiff alleged that we negligently constructed, installed or maintained the electrical system in a bus shelter, which resulted in the death of Jorge Luis Cabrera, Jr. Martha Serrano settled her claims with us. On June 24, 2005, the jury rendered a verdict in favor of the plaintiff, and awarded the plaintiff $4.1 million in actual damages and $61.0 million in punitive damages. We have filed a motion to have the punitive damages award reduced. If our motion to reduce the punitive damages award is unsuccessful, we intend to vigorously seek to overturn or nullify the adverse verdict and damage award including, if necessary, pursuing appropriate appeals. We have insurance coverage for up to approximately $50 million in damages for this matter.

85


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT
Executive Officers, Directors, and Significant Employees
      Set forth below are the names and ages and current positions of our executive officers, current and proposed directors and significant employees. Immediately prior to this offering, we expect to appoint Martha McCombs Shields, Dale W. Tremblay and William D. Parker as additional directors to our board of directors. See “— Composition of the Board of Directors After This Offering” below.
                     
Name   Age   Position   Term as Director
             
L. Lowry Mays
    70     Chairman of the Board and Director     Expires 2007  
James M. Raines
    65     Director     Expires 2007  
William D. Parker
    43     Director     Expires 2009  
Marsha McCombs Shields
    51     Director     Expires 2008  
Dale W. Tremblay
    47     Director     Expires 2009  
Mark P. Mays
    42     Chief Executive Officer and Director     Expires 2009  
Randall T. Mays
    40     Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Director     Expires 2008  
Paul J. Meyer
    62     President and Chief Operating Officer        
Jonathan D. Bevan
    34     Chief Operating Officer — International        
Augusto Claux
    58     Regional President — Latin America        
Michael R. Deeds
    63     Executive Vice President — Domestic Operations        
Bo Rickard Hedlund
    40     Chief Executive Officer — Northern Europe        
Michael F. Hudes
    44     Global Director — Digital Media        
Eugene P. Leehan
    43     Regional President — Western United States        
Coline L. McConville
    41     Chief Executive Officer — Europe        
Franklin G. Sisson, Jr.
    53     Global Director — Sales and Marketing        
Timothy C. Stauning
    49     Regional President — Eastern United States        
Kurt A. Tingey
    40     Executive Vice President — Domestic Chief Financial Officer        
Laura C. Toncheff
    37     Executive Vice President — Domestic Real Estate, Public Affairs and Legal        
      L. Lowry Mays has served as a member of our board of directors since April 1997 and has been our Chairman of the Board since October 2005. Mr. Mays is Chairman of the board of directors of Clear Channel Communications, and prior to October 2004 he was the company’s Chief Executive Officer. Mr. Mays has been a member of Clear Channel Communications’ board of directors since its inception and has served on the board of directors of CCE Spinco, Inc. since August 2005. Mr. Mays is the father of Mark P. Mays and Randall T. Mays, both of whom are members of our board of directors and executive officers of us.
      James M. Raines has served as the President of James M. Raines & Co., an investment banking company, since 1988. Since 1998, Mr. Raines has served on the board of directors of Waddell & Reed Financial, Inc., a financial services corporation.
      William D. Parker has served as Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of America West Holdings Corporation and America West Airlines since September 2001. Since May 2000, Mr. Parker has served as

86


Table of Contents

President of America West Airlines. He assumed the position of Chief Operating Officer of America West Airlines in December 2000 in addition to his role as President of the company. From 1999 to 2000, Mr. Parker served as Executive Vice President, Corporate Group of America West Airlines.
      Marsha McCombs Shields has served as a director of Primera Insurance since March 1989. Since June 2002, Ms. McCombs has served as the President of the McCombs Foundation and as Dealer Principal for McCombs Automotive. She has served as Manager of McCombs Family Ltd. since January 2000.
      Dale W. Tremblay has served as President and Chief Executive Officer of C.H. Guenther & Son, Inc., a food marketing and manufacturing company, since July 2001. Prior to that, from May 1998 to July 2001, Mr. Tremblay served as the Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of C.H. Guenther & Son, Inc. Mr. Tremblay was a Financial Analyst for R.R. Donnelley & Sons from June 1980 to May 1982. He currently serves on the Advisory Board for the Michigan State University Financial Analysis Lab.
      Mark P. Mays has served as our Chief Executive Officer since August 2005 and Director since April 1997. Mr. Mays has served as Chief Executive Officer and President of Clear Channel Communications since October 2004. Prior thereto, he served as the interim Chief Executive Officer and President and Chief Operating Officer of Clear Channel Communications from May 2004 to October 2004 and as the President and Chief Operating Officer of Clear Channel Communications for the remainder of the relevant five-year period. Mr. Mays has served on the board of directors of Clear Channel Communications since May 1998, and has served on the board of CCE Spinco, Inc. since August 2005. Mr. Mays is the son of L. Lowry Mays, Clear Channel Communications’ Chairman and one of our board members, and is the brother of Randall T. Mays, our Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer and one of our board members.
      Randall T. Mays has served as our Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer since August 2005 and Director since April 1997. Mr. Mays has served as Chairman of the board of directors of CCE Spinco, Inc. since August 2005. He also has served as the Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Clear Channel Communications since 1996. He has served on the board of directors of Clear Channel Communications since April 1999. Mr. Mays is the son of L. Lowry Mays, Clear Channel Communications’ Chairman and one of our board members, and is the brother of Mark P. Mays, our Chief Executive Officer and one of our board members.
      Paul J. Meyer has served as our President and Chief Operating Officer since April 2005. Prior thereto, he served as President and Chief Executive Officer of our domestic segment from January 2002 to April 2005 and President/Chief Operating Officer of our domestic segment from March 1999 to December 2001. Mr. Meyer has also served as Vice President of Clear Channel Communications since March 1999.
      Jonathan D. Bevan has served as our Chief Operating Officer — International since December 2004. Mr. Bevan served as Senior Vice President/ Operations of our international segment from September 2002 to December 2004 and, prior thereto, as Director of Finance for the remainder of the relevant five-year period.
      Augusto Claux has served as our Regional President — Latin America since 1999.
      Michael R. Deeds has served as our Executive Vice President — Domestic Operations since 1999 and has been employed with us for 38 years.
      Bo Rickard Hedlund has served as the Chief Executive Officer — Northern Europe of our international segment since April 1, 2005. Prior thereto, Mr. Hedlund served as Executive Vice President — Nordic Region from October 2001 to March 2005 and Regional Director for all of our business units in Sweden, Norway, Denmark and Finland. From November 1997 to September 2001, Mr. Hedlund served as General Manager — Sweden. From 2003, Mr. Hedlund was responsible for our

87


Table of Contents

Baltics and Russia regions and was also responsible for our Dutch business unit and Clear Channel Hillenaar from 2004.
      Michael F. Hudes has served as our Global Director — Digital Media (previously Executive Vice President/ Corporate Development) since August 2005. Prior thereto, he served as our Executive Vice President/ Corporate Development since March 2004. From April 2002 to February 2004, he also served as President, Chief Operating Officer and a Director of AdSpace Networks, Inc., a digital media network builder. Prior thereto, Mr. Hudes was President, Chief Operating Officer and a Director of Organic, Inc., an internet professional services company from November 1995 to September 2001.
      Eugene P. Leehan has served as our Regional President — Western United States since January 2003. Prior thereto, Mr. Leehan has worked for us or our predecessor companies in various capacities since February 1986.
      Coline L. McConville has served as Chief Executive Officer — Europe of our international segment since January 2003. Prior thereto, she served as Chief Operating Officer for our international segment for the remainder of the relevant five-year period.
      Franklin G. Sisson, Jr. has served as our Global Director — Sales and Marketing since August 2005. Prior thereto, he served as Executive Vice President Sales and Marketing of the domestic segment since January 2001 and as President/ General Manager Orlando Division from August 1998 to December 2000.
      Timothy C. Stauning has served as our Regional President — Eastern United States since August 2004. Prior thereto, Mr. Stauning served as President of our New York Branch since August 1998.
      Kurt A. Tingey has served as our Executive Vice President and Domestic Chief Financial Officer since January 1, 2000. From March 1999 to January 2000, Mr. Tingey served as our Senior Vice President — Business Development.
      Laura C. Toncheff has served as our Executive Vice President — Domestic Real Estate, Public Affairs and Legal since January 2003. Prior thereto, Ms. Toncheff served as the Executive Vice President and General Counsel for our domestic operations from January 2000, and prior thereto she served as Senior Vice President.
Composition of the Board of Directors After This Offering
      Prior to the completion of this offering, we intend to restructure our board of directors. Our board of directors consists of three directors. We intend to appoint four additional directors, subject to the completion of this offering, each of whom has consented to so serve. We anticipate that James M. Raines, William D. Parker, Marsha McCombs Shields and Dale W. Tremblay will be independent as determined by our board of directors under the applicable securities law requirements and listing standards. Ms. Shields is, however, the daughter of one of the founders and one of the board members of Clear Channel Communications. For so long as Clear Channel Communications is the owner of such number of shares representing more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock, it will have the ability to direct the election of all the members of our board of directors, the composition of our board committees and the size of the board. See “Description of Capital Stock.”
      Concurrent with the completion of the offering, our directors will be divided into three classes serving staggered three-year terms. At each annual meeting of our stockholders, directors will be elected to succeed the class of directors whose terms have expired. Class I directors’ terms will expire at the 2007 annual meeting of our stockholders, Class II directors’ terms will expire at the 2008 annual meeting of our stockholders and Class III directors’ terms will expire at the 2009 annual meeting of our stockholders. L. Lowry Mays and James M. Raines initially will be our Class I directors, Randall T. Mays and Marsha McCombs Shields initially will be our Class II directors and Mark P. Mays, Dale W. Tremblay and William D. Parker initially will be our Class III directors. Our classified board of directors could have the effect of increasing the length of time necessary to change the composition of a majority of our board.

88


Table of Contents

Generally, at least two annual meetings of stockholders will be necessary for stockholders to effect a change in a majority of the members of the board of directors.
      We intend to avail ourselves of certain of the “controlled company” exemptions of the New York Stock Exchange corporate governance standards which free us from the obligation to comply with certain NYSE corporate governance requirements that would otherwise require (i) that the majority of the board of directors consists of independent directors, (ii) that we have a nominating and governance committee and that it be composed entirely of independent directors with a written charter addressing the committee’s purpose and responsibilities, (iii) that we have a compensation committee composed entirely of independent directors with a written charter addressing the committee’s purpose and responsibilities and (iv) an annual performance evaluation of the compensation committee. See “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Relationship with Clear Channel Communications” and “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us.”
Committees of the Board of Directors After This Offering
      The standing committees of our board of directors will be an audit committee and compensation committee, each of which is described below.
Audit Committee
      The three independent (as defined in the NYSE listing standards) audit committee members will be James M. Raines, who will serve as the chairman, Marsha McCombs Shields and William D. Parker. We anticipate that James M. Raines will be designated by our board of directors as the audit committee financial expert (as defined in the applicable regulations of the SEC). The audit committee will operate under a written charter adopted by the board of directors which reflects standards set forth in SEC regulations and NYSE rules. The composition and responsibilities of the audit committee and the attributes of its members, as reflected in the charter, are intended to be in accordance with applicable requirements for corporate audit committees. The charter will be reviewed, and amended if necessary, on an annual basis. The full text of the audit committee’s charter can be found on our website at www.clearchanneloutdoor.com or may be obtained upon request from our Secretary.
      As set forth in more detail in the charter, the audit committee’s purpose is to assist the board of directors in its general oversight of Clear Channel Outdoor’s financial reporting, internal control and audit functions. Clear Channel Communications’ internal audit department will document, test and evaluate our internal control over financial reporting in response to the requirements set forth in Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and related regulations. The responsibilities of the audit committee will include:
  •  recommending the hiring or termination of independent auditors and approving any non-audit work performed by such auditor;
 
  •  approving the overall scope of the audit;
 
  •  assisting our board of directors in monitoring the integrity of our financial statements, the independent accountant’s qualifications and independence, the performance of the independent accountants and our internal audit function, and our compliance with legal and regulatory requirements;
 
  •  annually reviewing our independent auditors’ report describing the auditing firms’ internal quality control procedures, any material issues raised by the most recent internal quality control review, or peer review, of the auditing firm;
 
  •  discussing the annual audited financial and quarterly statements with our management and the independent auditor;
 
  •  discussing earnings press releases, as well as financial information and earnings guidance provided to analysts and rating agencies;

89


Table of Contents

  •  discussing policies with respect to risk assessment and risk management;
 
  •  meeting separately, periodically, with management, internal auditors and the independent auditor;
 
  •  reviewing with the independent auditor any audit problems or difficulties and management’s response;
 
  •  setting clear hiring policies for employees or former employees of the independent auditors;
 
  •  annually reviewing the adequacy of the audit committee’s written charter;
 
  •  reviewing with management any legal matters that may have a material impact on us; and
 
  •  reporting regularly to our full board of directors.
Compensation Committee
      The compensation committee members will be Mark P. Mays, who will serve as chairman, Dale W. Tremblay and William D. Parker. The compensation committee will operate under a written charter adopted by the board of directors. The committee will be primarily responsible for administering Clear Channel Outdoor’s stock incentive plans, performance-based compensation plans and other incentive compensation plans. Also, the committee will determine compensation arrangements for all of our executive officers and will make recommendations to the board of directors concerning compensation policies for us and our subsidiaries.
Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation in Compensation Decisions
      Other than Mark P. Mays and Randall T. Mays, who each serve as an executive officer and member of the board of directors of Clear Channel Communications, none of our executive officers serves as a member of the compensation committee or as a member of the board of directors of any other company of which any member of our compensation committee or board of directors is an executive officer.
Code of Business Conduct and Ethics
      We adopted a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics applicable to all of our directors and employees, including our chief executive officer, chief financial officer and chief operating officer, which is a “code of ethics” as defined by applicable SEC rules. This code is publicly available on our website at www.clearchanneloutdoor.com or may be obtained upon request from our Secretary. If we make any amendments to this code, other than technical, administrative or other non-substantive amendments, or grant any waivers, including implicit waivers, from any provisions of this code that apply to our chief executive officer, chief financial officer or chief operating officer and relate to an element of the SEC’s “code of ethics” definition, we will disclose the nature of the amendment or waiver, its effective date and to whom it applies on our website or in a report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC.
Director Compensation
      We do not currently pay any compensation to any of our directors. In conjunction with this offering, we will be adding independent directors to our board of directors and plan to pay our non-employee directors an annual cash retainer of $25,000, an additional $1,500 for each board meeting attended and an additional $1,000 for each committee meeting attended. We may also grant stock options or other stock-based awards to our non-employee directors, and non-employee directors may elect to receive their fees in the form of shares of our Class A common stock. We plan to pay the chairperson of the audit committee and the chairperson of the compensation committee an additional annual cash retainer of approximately $10,000 and $5,000, respectively.

90


Table of Contents

Stock Ownership of Directors and Executive Officers
      All of the outstanding shares of our Class A common stock and Class B common stock are currently owned by Clear Channel Communications and its affiliates and thus none of our named executive officers (as defined below) or directors owns shares of our Class A common stock or Class B common stock.
      The following table sets forth the Clear Channel Communications common stock and options to purchase shares of Clear Channel Communications’ common stock held by our directors, the named executive officers and all of our directors and executive officers as a group, as of September 30, 2005. Except as otherwise noted, the individual director or named executive officer (including his or her family members) had sole voting and investment power with respect to the shares of Clear Channel Communications’ common stock.
         
    Amount and Nature of
Name   Beneficial Ownership
     
L. Lowry Mays
    31,242,193 (1)
James M. Raines
     
Mark P. Mays
    1,751,246 (2)
Randall T. Mays
    1,366,101 (3)
William D. Parker
     
Marsha McCombs Shields
    4,755,353 (4)
Dale W. Tremblay
     
Paul J. Meyer
    169,374 (5)
Franklin G. Sisson, Jr. 
    46,774 (6)
All Directors and Executive Officers as a Group (13 persons)
    39,394,537 (7)
 
(1)  Includes 2,750,000 shares subject to options held by Mr. L. Mays, 48,456 shares held by trusts of which Mr. L. Mays is the trustee, but not a beneficiary, 26,677,307 shares held by LLM Partners Ltd of which Mr. L. Mays shares control of the sole general partner, 1,577,120 shares held by the Mays Family Foundation and 102,874 shares held by the Clear Channel Foundation over which Mr. L. Mays has either sole or shared investment or voting authority.
 
(2)  Includes 300,000 shares subject to options held by Mr. M. Mays, 156,252 shares held by trusts of which Mr. M. Mays is the trustee, but not a beneficiary, and 1,022,293 shares held by MPM Partners, Ltd. Mr. M. Mays controls the sole general partner of MPM Partners, Ltd.
 
(3)  Includes 300,000 shares subject to options held by Mr. R. Mays, 168,228 shares held by trusts of which Mr. R. Mays is the trustee, but not a beneficiary, and 622,575 shares held by RTM Partners, Ltd. Mr. R. Mays controls the sole general partner of RTM Partners, Ltd.
 
(4)  Includes 2,674,780 shares held by a Foundation over which Ms. Shields has either sole or shared investment or voting authority.
 
(5)  Includes 147,500 shares subject to options held by Mr. Meyer.
 
(6)  Includes 46,200 shares subject to options held by Mr. Sisson.
 
(7)  Includes 3,643,800 shares subject to options held by such persons, 327,936 shares held by trusts of which such persons are trustees, but not beneficiaries, 26,677,307 shares held by LLM Partners Ltd, 1,022,293 shares held by MPM Partners, Ltd., 622,575 shares held by RTM Partners, Ltd, 4,354,774 shares held by Foundations over which such person has either sole or shared investment or voting authority.

91


Table of Contents

Executive Compensation
      The following table sets forth compensation information for our chief executive officer and our other four most highly compensated individuals, based on employment with Clear Channel Communications as determined by reference to total annual salary and bonus for the last completed fiscal year, who will become our executive officers. All of the information included in this table reflects compensation earned by the individuals for services with Clear Channel Communications. We refer to these individuals as our “named executive officers” in this prospectus.
Summary Compensation Table
                                                                 
                    Long-Term Compensation    
                         
        Annual Compensation   Awards   Payouts    
                     
            Other Annual   Restricted            
Name and           Compensation   Stock       LTIP   All Other
Principal Position   Year   Salary ($)   Bonus ($)   ($)(1)   Award(s) ($)   Options (#)   Payout ($)   Compensation ($)
                                 
Mark P. Mays(2)
    2004       688,469       1,700,000             1,113,250(3 )     150,000             5,125(4 )
Randall T. Mays
    2004       688,293       1,700,000             1,113,250(3 )     150,000             5,125(4 )
Paul J. Meyer
    2004       465,686       342,000                   65,000             5,125(4 )
Roger Parry*(5)
    2004       785,355       598,719                   35,000             214,502(6 )
Franklin G. Sisson, Jr. 
    2004       249,068       99,250                   15,000             4,048(4 )
 
Mr. Parry resigned his position as Chief Executive Officer of Clear Channel International and remains a non-executive level employee with us.
(1)  Perquisites that are less than $50,000 in the aggregate for any named executive officer are not disclosed in the table in accordance with SEC rules.
 
(2)  Mr. Mays was appointed as the President and Chief Executive Officer of Clear Channel Communications on October 20, 2004. Prior thereto, Mark Mays served as the interim Chief Executive Officer and President and Chief Operating Officer of Clear Channel Communications from May 2004 to October 2004 and as the President and Chief Operating Officer of Clear Channel Communications prior to May 2004.
 
(3)  Grants of 25,000 shares of restricted stock were awarded on February 19, 2004. The restricted stock had a fair market value of $837,250 as of December 31, 2004. The restriction will lapse and the shares will vest on February 19, 2009. The holder will receive all cash dividends declared and paid during the vesting period.
 
(4)  Represents the amount of matching contributions paid by Clear Channel Communications under its 401(k) Plan.
 
(5)  Mr. Parry is a citizen of the United Kingdom. The compensation amounts reported in this table have been converted from British pounds to U.S. dollars using the average exchange rate from each applicable year.
 
(6)  Includes $62,902 in contracted payments to Mr. Parry in lieu of a company automobile, $9,334 in contracted payments to Mr. Parry in lieu of medical benefit and $142,266 in contributions paid by Clear Channel Communications to Mr. Parry’s pension plan.

92


Table of Contents

Stock Options
      The following table sets forth certain information regarding stock options to acquire shares of Clear Channel Communications’ common stock granted to our named executive officers in 2004.
Stock Option Grant Table
                                         
    Number of   Percent of Total            
    Securities   Options Granted to           Grant Date
    Underlying Options   Employees in Fiscal   Exercise or Base       Present
Name   Granted (#)   Year   Price ($/share)   Expiration Date   Value ($)(1)
                     
Mark P. Mays
    150,000       3.19 %     44.53       2/19/09       2,265,000  
Randall T. Mays
    150,000       3.19 %     44.53       2/19/09       2,265,000  
Paul J. Meyer
    65,000       1.38 %     44.53       2/19/09       981,500  
Roger Parry*
    35,000       0.75 %     44.53       2/29/09       528,500  
Franklin G. Sisson, Jr. 
    15,000       0.32 %     44.53       2/19/09       226,500  
 
Mr. Parry resigned his position as Chief Executive Officer of Clear Channel International and remains a non-executive level employee with us.
 
(1)  Present value for this option was estimated at the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions: risk-free interest rate of 2.21%, a dividend yield of .90%, a volatility factor of the expected market price of Clear Channel Communications’ common stock of 50.0% and the expected life of three years. The present value of stock options granted is based on a theoretical option-pricing model. In actuality, because Clear Channel Communications’ employee stock options are not traded on an exchange, optionees can receive no value nor derive any benefit from holding stock options under these plans without an increase in the market price of Clear Channel Communications stock. Such an increase in stock price would benefit all shareholders commensurately.
Exercise of Stock Options
      The following table discloses information regarding the exercise of stock options to acquire shares of Clear Channel Communications’ common stock by our named executive officers in 2004 and the value of unexercised stock options held by the named executive officers.
Aggregated Option Exercises and Fiscal Year-End Option Value Table
                                 
            Number of Securities    
            Underlying Unexercised   Value of Unexercised
            Options at Fiscal Year   In-The-Money Options at
    Shares Acquired on       End (#)   Fiscal Year End ($)
Name   Exercise (#)   Value Realized ($)   Exercisable/Unexercisable   Exercisable/Unexercisable
                 
Mark P. Mays
    30,000       772,200       266,500/800,000       -0-/-0-  
Randall T. Mays
    30,000       772,200       266,500/800,000       -0-/-0-  
Paul J. Meyer
                103,750/131,250       -0-/-0-  
Roger Parry*
                85,224/147,507       -0-/-0-  
Franklin G. Sisson, Jr. 
                23,112/77,512       17,764/-0-  
 
Mr. Parry resigned his position as Chief Executive Officer of Clear Channel International and remains a non-executive level employee with us.
Employee Benefit Plans
      Our employees currently participate in various incentive, retirement savings, group welfare and other employee benefit plans sponsored by Clear Channel Communications. With certain exceptions, our

93


Table of Contents

employees will continue participating in the Clear Channel Communications plans after this offering, in accordance with the terms of the plans and past practice. We will be able to withdraw our participation in any Clear Channel Communications plan (subject to 90 days’ notice). Similarly, Clear Channel Communications may terminate our participation in its plans (subject to 90 days’ notice). Unless sooner terminated, it is likely that our participation in the Clear Channel Communications employee benefit plans will end if and at such time as Clear Channel Communications owns less than 80% of the total voting power of our common stock. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us — Employee Matters Agreement.” It is anticipated that our stock will be added to the listing of available investments under the Clear Channel Communications 401(k) plan, but there is no assurance that this will occur or continue.
      Some of our employees hold stock options and/or shares of Clear Channel Communications restricted stock under the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. 2001 Stock Incentive Plan and certain predecessor stock incentive plans. Some or all of the Clear Channel Communications stock options held by our employees prior to the offering may be converted into options for shares of our Class A common stock. See “— Clear Channel Communications Stock Plan Awards” below. Absent a plan amendment, as long as we remain a subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications, certain of our employees will continue to be eligible for stock awards under the Clear Channel Communications stock incentive plans. Prior to the completion of this offering, we will have in place our own stock incentive and annual incentive compensation plans for our eligible employees. See “— Our New Stock Incentive Plan” and “— Annual Incentive Plan.” We expect to make awards under our new stock incentive plan shortly after the completion of this offering. However, the number of shares covered by the initial awards and details relating to individual awards have not yet been determined.
      We will reimburse Clear Channel Communications for the costs and expenses incurred by it and its other affiliates in connection with the continuing coverage of our employees in the Clear Channel Communications employee benefit plans and in connection with its or their services relating to payroll administration and the administration of our own stock incentive and other plans. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us — Corporate Services Agreement” for information concerning our reimbursement obligations to Clear Channel Communications. We will continue to bear the cost of and retain responsibility for employment-related liabilities and obligations with respect to our employees, regardless of when incurred.
Clear Channel Communications Stock Plan Awards
      Before this offering, some of our employees received Clear Channel Communications stock options and restricted stock under the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. Stock Incentive Plans.
      It is anticipated that some or all of the outstanding Clear Channel Communications stock options held by our employees will be converted into adjusted options to purchase shares of our Class A common stock. The number of shares and the exercise price per share under each converted option will be adjusted such that the ratio of the per share exercise price to the per share value of our stock and the total intrinsic value of the option are the same after the conversion as they were prior to the conversion. Generally, the converted stock options will continue to be governed by their original vesting and other terms and conditions. We will be responsible for administering and honoring the converted Clear Channel Communications stock options held by our employees, and Clear Channel Communications will have no further liability with respect to those options.
      The restricted shares of Clear Channel Communications stock held by our employees will continue to be subject to the forfeiture conditions and transfer restrictions and the other terms and conditions of the original award relating to those shares and of the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. 2001 Stock Incentive Plan. In the event of the completion of the previously-announced spin-off of the entertainment business of Clear Channel Communications, our employees who hold restricted shares of Clear Channel Communications stock under the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. 2001 Stock Incentive Plan will

94


Table of Contents

receive fully vested shares of the newly created company’s stock in connection with the spin-off distribution, on the same basis as other stockholders of Clear Channel Communications generally.
Annual Incentive Plan
      For 2005, our executive officers and other key employees will generally be entitled to receive incentive compensation in accordance with the terms of the performance-based awards previously made to them under the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. 2005 Annual Incentive Plan. However, at least as to our named executive officers, we will be responsible for determining the amounts, if any, that are payable under those awards, subject to such adjustments as are deemed appropriate in light of the corporate restructuring by Clear Channel Communications, including the spin-off of the entertainment business of Clear Channel Communications and this offering.
      For 2006, our executive officers and other designated key employees will participate in our own 2006 Annual Incentive Plan, which has been adopted by our board of directors and approved by Clear Channel Communications, in its capacity as our sole stockholder. In general, the plan provides for the payment of annual bonuses tied to the achievement of pre-established performance objectives fixed by the committee. We intend that bonuses under our plan will qualify for the performance-based-compensation exemption from the executive compensation deduction limitations of section 162(m) of the Code. Toward that end, in order to satisfy regulations issued under section 162(m), we expect to submit our plan for approval at the annual meeting of our stockholders occurring after the first anniversary of this offering.
      Our annual incentive plan will be administered by the compensation committee of our board of directors. The committee will have the authority to select the executive officers and other key employees to whom awards will be made, to prescribe the performance objectives which must be satisfied pursuant to such awards, and to make the determinations necessary with respect to the administration and payment of such awards. The performance objectives that may be established for awards made under the plan may be based upon any one or more of the following business criteria: revenue growth, operating income before depreciation, amortization and non-cash compensation expense, or OIBDAN, OIBDAN growth, funds from operations, funds from operations per share and per share growth, operating income and operating income growth, net earnings, earnings per share and per share growth, return on equity, return on assets, share price performance on an absolute basis and relative to an index, improvements in attainment of expense levels, implementing or completion of critical projects, improvement in cash-flow (before or after tax). Performance objectives may be based upon the performance of such person or persons, as the committee may determine, including an individual or group of individuals, our company on a combined basis, one or more subsidiaries or other affiliates, and one or more divisions or business units. Performance objectives may be expressed in fixed or relative quantitative terms or in other ways, including, for example, targets relative to past performance, or targets compared to the performance of other companies, such as a published or special index or a group of companies selected by the committee for comparison. The committee may provide that the amount, if any, of a participant’s annual bonus will be higher or lower, depending upon the extent to which the applicable performance objective is achieved.
      Performance objectives applicable to a performance period must be established by the committee prior to, or reasonably soon after the beginning of a performance period, but no later than the 90 days from the beginning of the period or, if earlier, the date 25% of the period has elapsed.
      Upon certification of the achievement of performance objectives by the committee which entitle a participant to the payment of a performance award, subject to deferral arrangements that may be permitted or required by the committee, the award shall be settled in cash or other property. The maximum performance bonus that may be earned by any participant in any calendar year is limited to $15.0 million.
      The committee is authorized to reduce or eliminate the performance award of any participant, for any reason, including changes in the participant’s position or duties, whether due to termination of employment (including death, disability, retirement, voluntary termination or termination with or without cause) or otherwise. To the extent necessary to preserve the intended economic effects of the plan or an award under

95


Table of Contents

the plan, the committee is authorized to adjust pre-established performance objectives and/or performance awards to take into account certain material events, such as a change in corporate capitalization, a corporate transaction, a partial or complete liquidation of our company or any subsidiary, or certain changes in accounting rules; provided that no such adjustment may cause a performance award to be non-deductible under Section 162(m) of the Code.
      Our board of directors or the committee may, at any time, or from time to time, amend the plan. Any such amendment may be made without stockholder approval unless such approval is required to maintain the status of the plan under Section 162(m) of the Code. Our board of directors may terminate the plan at any time.
Our New Stock Incentive Plan
      Our board of directors adopted and our sole stockholder approved the Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. 2005 Stock Incentive Plan. The purpose of the plan is to help us attract, motivate and retain qualified executives and other key personnel. In furtherance of this purpose, the plan authorizes us to grant various forms of incentive awards, including stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, deferred stock awards and performance-based cash and stock awards. See “— Forms of Award” below.
      The plan and certain tax aspects of awards made under the plan are summarized below.
Administration
      The plan will be administered by the compensation committee of our board of directors; however, the full board of directors will have sole responsibility and authority for making and administering awards to any of our non-employee directors. Subject to the terms of the plan, the committee has broad authority to select the persons to whom awards will be made, fix the terms and conditions of each award, and construe, interpret and apply the provisions of the plan and of any award made under the plan. The committee may delegate any of its responsibilities and authority, subject to applicable law. Subject to certain limitations, we will indemnify the members of the committee against claims made and liabilities and expenses incurred in connection with their service under the plan.
Securities Covered by the Plan
      We can issue a total of            shares of our common stock under the plan. The following shares are not taken into account in applying these limitations: (i) shares covered by awards that expire or are forfeited, canceled or settled in cash, (ii) shares withheld by us for the payment of taxes associated with an award, (iii) shares withheld by us for the payment of the exercise price under an award and (iv) previously owned shares received by us in payment of the exercise price under an award.
Individual Award Limitations
      No participant may receive awards in any calendar year covering more than one million shares plus the amount of the participant’s unused annual limit as of the close of the preceding calendar year. No participant may receive performance-based cash awards under the plan in any calendar year covering more than $5.0 million plus the amount of the participant’s unused annual limit as of the close of the preceding calendar year.
Eligibility
      Awards may be made under the plan to any of our present or future directors, officers, employees, consultants or advisers. In connection with this offering and other related corporate restructurings, Clear Channel Communications stock options held by certain of our employees and other personnel will be converted into options or other awards for shares of our Class A common stock. The shares of our Class A common stock covered by such adjusted or converted Clear Channel Communications awards will not be taken into account in applying our plan’s share limitations. See “— Clear Channel Communications Stock Plan Awards” below.

96


Table of Contents

Forms of Award
      Stock Options and Stock Appreciation Rights. We may grant stock options that qualify as “incentive stock options” under Section 422 of the Code, or ISOs, as well as stock options that do not qualify as ISOs. ISOs may not be granted more than 10 years after the date the plan is adopted. We may also grant stock appreciation rights, or SARs. In general, an SAR gives the holder the right to receive the appreciation in value of the shares of company stock covered by the SAR from the date the SAR is granted to the date the SAR is exercised. The per share exercise price of a stock option and the per share base value of an SAR may not be less than the fair market value per share of common stock on the date the option or SAR is granted. The maximum term of a stock option is 10 years (different limitations apply to ISOs granted to 10% stockholders: the term may not be greater than five years and the exercise price may not be less than 110% of the value of our common stock on the date the option is granted). The committee may impose such exercise, forfeiture and other conditions and limitations as it deems appropriate with respect to stock options and SARs. The exercise price under a stock option may be paid in cash or in any other form or manner permitted by the committee, including, without limitation, payment of previously owned shares of stock, or payment pursuant to broker-assisted cashless exercise procedures. Methods of exercise and settlement and other terms of SARs will be determined by the committee.
      Restricted Stock and Deferred Stock Awards. The plan authorizes the committee to make restricted stock awards, pursuant to which shares of common stock are issued to designated participants subject to transfer restrictions and vesting conditions. In general, if the recipient of a restricted stock award terminates employment before the end of the specified vesting period or if the recipient fails to meet performance or other specified vesting conditions, the restricted shares will be forfeited by the recipient and will revert to us. Subject to such conditions as the committee may impose, the recipient of a restricted stock award may be given the rights to vote and receive dividends on shares covered by the award pending the vesting or forfeiture of the shares.
      Deferred stock awards generally consist of the right to receive shares of common stock in the future, subject to such conditions as the committee may impose, including, for example, continuing employment or service for a specified period of time or satisfaction of specified performance criteria. Deferred stock awards may be made in a number of different forms, including “stock units” and “restricted stock units.” Prior to settlement, deferred stock awards do not carry voting, dividend or other rights associated with stock ownership; however, dividend equivalents may be payable if the committee so determines.
      Other Stock-Based Awards. The plan gives the committee broad discretion to grant other types of equity-based awards, including, for example, dividend equivalent rights, phantom shares, and bonus shares, and to provide for settlement in cash and/or shares. The plan also allows non-employee directors to elect to receive their director fees in the form of Class A common stock, in lieu of cash.
      Performance-Based Awards. The committee may also grant performance awards under the plan. In general, performance awards would provide for the payment of cash and/or shares of Class A common stock upon the achievement of performance objectives established by the committee for a fiscal year or other designated performance period. Performance objectives may be based upon any one or more of the following business criteria: (i) earnings per share, (ii) share price or total shareholder return, (iii) pretax profits, (iv) net earnings, (v) return on equity or assets, (vi) revenues, (vii) operating income before depreciation, amortization and non-cash compensation expense, or OIBDAN, (viii) market share or market penetration, or (ix) any combination of the foregoing. Performance objectives may be based upon the performance of such person or persons, as the committee may determine, including an individual or group of individuals, our company on a combined basis, one or more subsidiaries or other affiliates, and one or more divisions or business units. Performance objectives may be expressed in fixed or relative quantitative terms or in other ways, including, for example, targets relative to past performance, or targets compared to the performance of other companies, such as a published or special index or a group of companies selected by the committee for comparison.

97


Table of Contents

Adjustments of Awards
      Capital Changes. In the event of material changes to our capital structure, including, for example, a recapitalization, stock split or spin-off, appropriate adjustments will be made to the maximum number of shares and the class of shares or other securities which may be issued under the plan, the maximum number and class of shares which may be covered by awards made to an individual in any calendar year, the number and class of shares or other securities subject to outstanding awards and, where applicable, the exercise price, base value or purchase price under outstanding awards.
      Merger and Other Transactions. If we enter into a merger or other transaction involving the sale of our company, outstanding options and SARs will either become fully vested and exercisable, or assumed by and converted into options or SARs for shares of the acquiring company. Our board of directors may make similar adjustments to other outstanding awards under the plan and may direct a cashout of any or all outstanding awards based upon the value of the consideration paid for our shares in the merger or other transaction giving rise to the adjustment of plan awards. Additional or different types of adjustments may be permitted or required under the terms of individual plan awards, as the committee may determine.
      No Repricing of Stock Options. Subject to the provisions of the plan regarding adjustments due to a change in capital structure, the committee will have no authority to reprice outstanding options, whether through amendment, cancellation or replacement grants, without approval of our stockholders.
Amendment and Termination of the Plan; Term
      Except as may otherwise be required by law or the requirements of any stock exchange or market upon which the common stock may then be listed, our board of directors, acting in its sole discretion and without further action on the part of our stockholders, may amend the plan at any time and from time to time and may terminate the plan at any time.
United States Income Tax Considerations
      The grant of a stock option or SAR under the plan is not a taxable event for federal income tax purposes. In general, ordinary income is realized upon the exercise of a stock option (other than an ISO) in an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value on the exercise date of the shares acquired pursuant to the exercise over the option exercise price paid for the shares. The amount of ordinary income realized upon the exercise of an SAR is equal to the excess of the fair market value of the shares covered by the exercise over the SAR base price. We are entitled to a deduction equal to the amount of ordinary income realized by a plan participant upon the exercise of an option or SAR. The tax basis of shares acquired upon the exercise of a stock option (other than an ISO) or SAR is equal to the value of the shares on the date of exercise. Upon a subsequent sale of the shares, capital gain or loss will be realized in an amount equal to the difference between the selling price and the basis of the shares.
      No income is realized upon the exercise of an ISO other than for purposes of the alternative minimum tax. Income or loss is realized upon a disposition of shares acquired pursuant to the exercise of an ISO. If the disposition occurs more than one year after the ISO exercise date and more than two years after the ISO grant date, then gain or loss on the disposition, measured by the difference between the selling price and the option exercise price for the shares, will be long-term capital gain or loss. If the disposition occurs within one year of the exercise date or within two years of the grant date, then the gain realized on the disposition will be taxable as ordinary income to the extent such gain is not more than the difference between the value of the shares on the date of exercise and the exercise price, and the balance of the gain, if any, will be capital gain. We are not entitled to a deduction with respect to the exercise of an ISO; however, we are entitled to a deduction corresponding to the ordinary income realized by a participant upon a disposition of shares acquired pursuant to the exercise of an ISO before the satisfaction of the applicable one- and two-year holding period requirements described above.
      In general, a participant will realize ordinary income with respect to common stock received pursuant to restricted stock, deferred stock and other non-stock option and non-SAR forms of award at the time the shares become vested in accordance with the terms of the award in an amount equal to the fair market value of the shares at the time they become vested, and we are entitled to a corresponding deduction. A

98


Table of Contents

participant may make an “early income election” with respect to the receipt of restricted shares of common stock, in which case the participant will realize ordinary income on the date the restricted shares are received equal to the difference between the value of the shares on that date and the amount, if any, paid for the shares. In such event, any appreciation in the value of the shares after the date of the award will be taxable as capital gain upon a subsequent disposition of the shares. Our deduction is limited to the amount of ordinary income realized by the participant as a result of the early income election.
      Compensation that qualifies as “performance-based” is exempt from the $1.0 million deductibility limitation imposed by Section 162(m) of the Code. It is contemplated that stock options and SARs granted under the plan with an exercise price or base price at least equal to 100% of fair market value of the underlying stock at the date of grant and certain other plan awards which are conditioned upon achievement of performance goals will be able to qualify for the “performance-based” compensation exemption, assuming the applicable requirements are satisfied. It is anticipated that the plan will be resubmitted for stockholder approval at or before the annual meeting of our stockholders next following the first anniversary of the initial public offering. Such approval would enable us to continue to qualify for an exception to the annual $1.0 million executive compensation deduction limitations of Section 162(m) of the Code with respect to certain awards made under the plan.
      The above summary pertains solely to certain U.S. federal income tax consequences associated with awards made under the plan. The summary does not address all federal income tax consequences and it does not address state, local and non-U.S. tax considerations.
Employment Agreements
      Mark P. Mays and Randall T. Mays each have employment agreements with Clear Channel Communications. Paul J. Meyer has an employment agreement with us. Set forth below are summaries of these agreements.
      On March 10, 2005, Clear Channel Communications entered into amended and restated employment agreements with Mark P. Mays and Randall T. Mays. These agreements amended and restated existing employment agreements dated October 1, 1999 between Clear Channel Communications and the executives. Each amended and restated agreement has a term of seven years with automatic daily extensions unless Clear Channel Communications or the executive elects not to extend the agreement. Each of these employment agreements provides for a minimum base salary, subject to review and annual increase by the compensation committee of Clear Channel Communications. In addition, each agreement provides for an annual bonus pursuant to Clear Channel Communications’ Annual Incentive Plan or as the executive performance subcommittee of the compensation committee of Clear Channel Communications determines. The employment agreements with Mark Mays and Randall Mays provide for base minimum salaries of $350,000 and $325,000, respectively, and for minimum option grants to acquire 50,000 shares of Clear Channel Communications common stock; provided, however, that the annual option grant will not be smaller than the option grant in the preceding year unless waived by the executive. Each option will be exercisable at fair market value at the date of grant for a 10-year period even if the executive is not employed by Clear Channel Communications. The compensation committee of Clear Channel Communications or the executive performance subcommittee of the compensation committee of Clear Channel Communications will determine the schedule upon which the options will vest and become exercisable.
      Each of these executive employment agreements provides for severance and change-in-control payments in the event that Clear Channel Communications terminates the executive’s employment without “Cause” or if the executive terminates for “Good Reason.” “Cause” is narrowly defined, and any determination of “Cause” is subject to a supermajority vote of Clear Channel Communications’ independent directors. “Good Reason” includes defined change-in-control transactions involving Clear Channel Communications, Clear Channel Communications’ election not to automatically extend the term of the employment agreement, a diminution in the executive’s pay, duties or title or, (i) in the case of Mark Mays, at any time that the office of Chairman is held by someone other than himself, L. Lowry Mays or Randall Mays; or (ii) in the case of Randall Mays, at any time that either of the offices of Chairman or President and Chief Executive Officer is held by someone other than himself, L. Lowry Mays or Mark Mays. If either executive is terminated by Clear Channel Communications without

99


Table of Contents

“Cause” or the executive resigns for “Good Reason” then that executive will receive a lump-sum cash payment equal to the base salary and bonus that otherwise would have been paid for the remainder of the term of the agreement (using the highest bonus paid to the executive in the three years preceding the termination but not less than $1,000,000), continuation of benefits, immediate vesting on the date of termination of all stock options held by the executive on the date of termination, and either: (i) an option to acquire 1,000,000 shares of Clear Channel Communications’ common stock at fair market value as of the date of termination that is fully vested and exercisable for a period of 10 years, or (ii) a grant of a number of shares of Clear Channel Communications’ common stock equal to: (a) 1,000,000, divided by (b) the number computed by dividing: (x) the last reported sale price of Clear Channel Communications’ common stock on the New York Stock Exchange at the close of the trading day immediately preceding the date of termination of executive’s employment, by (y) the value of the stock option described in clause (i) above as determined by Clear Channel Communications in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Certain tax gross up payments would also be due on such amounts. In the event the executive’s employment is terminated without “Cause” or for “Good Reason,” the employment agreements also restrict the executive’s business activities that compete with the business of Clear Channel Communications for a period of two years following such termination.
      On August 5, 2005, we entered into an employment agreement with Paul J. Meyer. The initial term of the agreement ends on the third anniversary of the date of the agreement; the term automatically extends one day at a time beginning on the second anniversary of the date of the agreement, unless one party gives the other one year’s notice of expiration at or prior to the second anniversary of the date of the agreement. The contract calls for Mr. Meyer to be our President and Chief Operating Officer for a base salary of $600,000 in the first year of the agreement; $625,000 in the second year of the agreement; and $650,000 in the third year of the agreement, subject to additional annual raises thereafter in accordance with company policies. Mr. Meyer is also eligible to receive a performance bonus as decided at the sole discretion of our board of directors and the compensation committee.
      Mr. Meyer may terminate his employment at any time after the second anniversary of the date of the agreement upon one year’s written notice. We may terminate Mr. Meyer without “Cause” after the second anniversary of the date of the agreement upon one year’s written notice. “Cause” is narrowly defined in the agreement. If Mr. Meyer is terminated without “Cause,” he is entitled to receive a lump sum payment of accrued and unpaid base salary and prorated bonus, if any, and any payments to which he may be entitled under any applicable employee benefit plan. Mr. Meyer is prohibited by his employment agreement from activities that compete with us for one year after he leaves us and he is prohibited from soliciting our employees for employment for 12 months after termination regardless of the reason for termination of employment.
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions
      Each of Mark P. Mays, Randall T. Mays and L. Lowry Mays, our current directors, is an executive officer of Clear Channel Communications. We currently have issued three intercompany notes to Clear Channel Communications in the aggregate principal amount of approximately $4.0 billion, which represents in excess of five percent of our total consolidated assets at December 31, 2004 and September 30, 2005. In connection with this offering, approximately $1.5 billion of such indebtedness will be repaid or otherwise extinguished. Marsha McCombs Shields, one of our prospective directors, is the daughter of one of the founders and one of the board members of Clear Channel Communications.

100


Table of Contents

ARRANGEMENTS BETWEEN CLEAR CHANNEL COMMUNICATIONS AND US
      We have provided below a summary description of the Master Agreement between Clear Channel Communications and us and the other key agreements that relate to our separation from and post-separation relationship with Clear Channel Communications. This description, which summarizes the material terms of these agreements, is not complete. You should read the full text of these agreements, which have been included as exhibits to the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part.
Relationship with Clear Channel Communications
      Immediately prior to this offering, Clear Channel Communications through its wholly owned subsidiary, Clear Channel Holdings, Inc., is our only stockholder. After this offering, Clear Channel Communications will own all of our outstanding shares of Class B common stock, representing approximately           % of the outstanding shares of our common stock and approximately           % of the total voting power of our common stock. For as long as Clear Channel Communications continues to own shares of common stock representing more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock, Clear Channel Communications will be able to direct the election of all the members of our board of directors and exercise a controlling influence over our business and affairs, including any determinations with respect to mergers or other business combinations involving us, our acquisition or disposition of assets, our incurrence of indebtedness, the issuance of any additional common stock or other equity securities, the repurchase or redemption of common stock or preferred stock and the payment of dividends. Similarly, Clear Channel Communications will have the power to determine or significantly influence the outcome of matters submitted to a vote of our stockholders, will have the power to prevent a change in control of us and could take other actions that might be favorable to Clear Channel Communications. See “Description of Capital Stock.”
      Prior to the completion of this offering, we will enter into a Master Agreement and a number of other agreements with Clear Channel Communications setting forth various matters governing our separation from Clear Channel Communications and our relationship with Clear Channel Communications while it remains a significant stockholder in us. These agreements will govern our relationship with Clear Channel Communications after this offering and will provide for, among other things, the allocation of employee benefit, tax and other liabilities and obligations attributable to our operations.
      Set forth below are descriptions of certain agreements, relationships and transactions we will have with Clear Channel Communications. The following descriptions and summaries of each of the agreements with Clear Channel Communications are qualified in their entirety by reference to the complete texts of the agreements, which are incorporated by reference into this prospectus and are attached as an exhibit to the registration statement in which this prospectus is included. We encourage you to read each of the agreements in its entirety for a more complete description of the terms and conditions of each agreement.
Master Agreement
      We will enter into a master agreement with Clear Channel Communications prior to the completion of this offering. In this prospectus, we refer to this agreement as the Master Agreement. The Master Agreement will set forth our agreements with Clear Channel Communications regarding the principal transactions required to effect the transfer of assets and the assumption of liabilities necessary to complete the separation of our company from Clear Channel Communications. It also will set forth other agreements governing our relationship after the separation.
The Transfers
      To effect the separation, Clear Channel Communications will, and will cause its affiliates to, transfer to us the assets related to our businesses not currently owned by us, as described in this prospectus. We or our subsidiaries will assume and agree to perform, discharge and fulfill the liabilities related to our businesses for which Clear Channel Communications or its affiliates are presently obligated (which, in the case of tax liabilities, will be governed by the Tax Matters Agreement described below). If any governmental approval or other consent required to transfer any assets to us or for us to assume any liabilities is not obtained prior to the completion of this offering, we will agree with Clear Channel

101


Table of Contents

Communications that such transfer or assumption will be deferred until the necessary approvals or consents are obtained. Clear Channel Communications will continue to hold the assets and be responsible for the liabilities for our benefit and at our expense until the necessary approvals or consents are obtained.
      Similarly, we will, and will cause our subsidiaries to, transfer to Clear Channel Communications the assets related to its business currently owned by us. Clear Channel Communications will assume from us and agree to perform, discharge and fulfill the liabilities related to its business for which we are presently obligated.
      Except as expressly set forth in the Master Agreement or in any other transaction document, neither we nor Clear Channel Communications will make any representation or warranty as to:
  •  the assets, businesses or liabilities contributed, transferred or assumed as part of the separation;
 
  •  any consents or approvals required in connection with the transfers;
 
  •  the value, or freedom from any security interests, of, or any other matter concerning, any assets transferred;
 
  •  the absence of any defenses or right of set-off or freedom from counterclaim with respect to any claim or other assets of either us or Clear Channel Communications; or
 
  •  the legal sufficiency of any document or instrument delivered to convey title to any asset transferred.
      Except as expressly set forth in any transaction document, all assets will be transferred on an “as is,” “where is” basis, and we and our subsidiaries will agree to bear the economic and legal risks that any conveyance was insufficient to vest in us good title, free and clear of any security interest, and that any necessary consents or approvals are not obtained or that any requirements of laws or judgments are not complied with.
Auditors and Audits; Annual Financial Statements and Accounting
      We have agreed that, for so long as Clear Channel Communications is required to consolidate our results of operations and financial position or account for its investment in our company under the equity method of accounting, we will maintain a fiscal year end and accounting periods the same as Clear Channel Communications, conform our financial presentation with that of Clear Channel Communications and we will not change our independent auditors without Clear Channel Communications’ prior written consent (which will not be unreasonably withheld), and we will use commercially reasonable efforts to enable our independent auditors to complete their audit of our financial statements in a timely manner so as to permit timely filing of Clear Channel Communications’ financial statements. We have also agreed to provide to Clear Channel Communications all information required for Clear Channel Communications to meet its schedule for the filing and distribution of its financial statements and to make available to Clear Channel Communications and its independent auditors all documents necessary for the annual audit of our company as well as access to the responsible personnel so that Clear Channel Communications and its independent auditors may conduct their audits relating to our financial statements. We will provide Clear Channel Communications with financial reports, financial statements, budgets, projections, press releases and other financial data and information with respect to our business, properties and financial positions. We have also agreed to adhere to certain specified disclosure controls and procedures and Clear Channel Communications accounting policies and to notify and consult with Clear Channel Communications regarding any changes to our accounting principles and estimates used in the preparation of our financial statements, and any deficiencies in, or violations of law in connection with, our internal control over financial reporting and certain fraudulent conduct and other violations of law.
Exchange of Other Information
      The Master Agreement will also provide for other arrangements with respect to the mutual sharing of information between Clear Channel Communications and us in order to comply with reporting, filing, audit or tax requirements, for use in judicial proceedings, and in order to comply with our respective obligations

102


Table of Contents

after the separation. We will also agree to provide mutual access to historical records relating to the other’s businesses that may be in our possession.
Releases and Indemnification
      Except for each party’s obligations under the Master Agreement, the other transaction documents and certain other specified liabilities, we and Clear Channel Communications will release and discharge each other and each of our affiliates, and their directors, officers, agents and employees from all liabilities existing or arising between us on or before the separation, including in connection with the separation and this offering. The releases will not extend to obligations or liabilities under any agreements between Clear Channel Communications and us that remain in effect following the separation.
      We will indemnify, hold harmless and defend Clear Channel Communications, each of its affiliates and each of their respective directors, officers and employees, on an after-tax basis, from and against all liabilities relating to, arising out of or resulting from:
  •  the failure by us or any of our affiliates or any other person or entity to pay, perform or otherwise promptly discharge any liabilities or contractual obligations associated with our businesses, whether arising before or after the separation;
 
  •  the operations, liabilities and contractual obligations of our business whether arising before or after the separation;
 
  •  any guarantee, indemnification obligation, surety bond or other credit support arrangement by Clear Channel Communications or any of its affiliates for our benefit;
 
  •  any breach by us or any of our affiliates of the Master Agreement, the other transaction documents or our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or bylaws;
 
  •  any untrue statement of, or omission to state, a material fact in Clear Channel Communications’ public filings to the extent the statement or omission was as a result of information that we furnished to Clear Channel Communications or that Clear Channel Communications incorporated by reference from our public filings, if the statement or omission was made or occurred after the separation; and
 
  •  any untrue statement of, or omission to state, a material fact in any registration statement or prospectus related to this offering, except to the extent the statement was made or omitted in reliance upon information provided to us by Clear Channel Communications expressly for use in any such registration statement or prospectus or information relating to and provided by any underwriter expressly for use in any such registration statement or prospectus.
      Clear Channel Communications will indemnify, hold harmless and defend us, each of our affiliates and each of our and their respective directors, officers and employees, on an after-tax basis, from and against all liabilities relating to, arising out of or resulting from:
  •  the failure of Clear Channel Communications or any of its affiliates or any other person or entity to pay, perform or otherwise promptly discharge any liabilities of Clear Channel Communications or its affiliates, other than liabilities associated with our businesses, whether arising before or after the separation;
 
  •  the liabilities of Clear Channel Communications and its affiliates’ businesses, other than liabilities associated with our businesses;
 
  •  any breach by Clear Channel Communications or any of its affiliates of the Master Agreement or the other transaction documents;
 
  •  any untrue statement of, or omission to state, a material fact in our public filings to the extent the statement or omission was as a result of information that Clear Channel Communications furnished to us or that we incorporated by reference from Clear Channel Communications’ public filings, if the statement or omission was made or occurred after the separation; and

103


Table of Contents

  •  any untrue statement of, or omission to state, a material fact contained in any registration statement or prospectus related to this offering, but only to the extent the statement or omission was made or omitted in reliance upon information provided by Clear Channel Communications expressly for use in any such registration statement or prospectus.
      The Master Agreement will also specify procedures with respect to claims subject to indemnification and related matters and will provide for contribution in the event that indemnification is not available to an indemnified party.
      Expenses of the Separation and Our Initial Public Offering. Clear Channel Communications will pay or reimburse us for all out-of-pocket fees, costs and expenses (including all legal, accounting and printing expenses) incurred prior to the completion of this offering in connection with our separation from Clear Channel Communications, except that we shall be responsible for fees and expenses attributable to this offering.
Dispute Resolution Procedures
      We will agree with Clear Channel Communications that neither party will commence any court action to resolve any dispute or claim arising out of or relating to the Master Agreement, subject to certain exceptions. Instead, any dispute that is not resolved in the normal course of business will be submitted to senior executives of each business entity involved in the dispute for resolution. If the dispute is not resolved by negotiation within 45 days after submission to the executives, either party may submit the dispute to mediation. If the dispute is not resolved by mediation within 30 days after the selection of a mediator, either party may submit the dispute to binding arbitration before a panel of three arbitrators. The arbitrators will determine the dispute in accordance with Texas law. Most of the other agreements between Clear Channel Communications and us have similar dispute resolution provisions.
Other Provisions
      The Master Agreement also will contain covenants between Clear Channel Communications and us with respect to other matters, including the following:
  •  our agreement (subject to certain limited exceptions) not to repurchase shares of our outstanding Class A common stock or any other securities convertible into or exercisable for our Class A common stock, without first obtaining the prior written consent or affirmative vote of Clear Channel Communications, for so long as Clear Channel Communications owns more than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock;
 
  •  confidentiality of our and Clear Channel Communications’ information;
 
  •  our right to continue coverage under Clear Channel Communications’ insurance policies for so long as Clear Channel Communications owns more than 50% of our outstanding common stock;
 
  •  restrictions on our ability to take any action or enter into any agreement that would cause Clear Channel Communications to violate any law, organizational document, agreement or judgment;
 
  •  restrictions on our ability to take any action that limits Clear Channel Communications’ ability to freely sell, transfer, pledge or otherwise dispose of our stock;
 
  •  our obligation to comply with Clear Channel Communications’ policies applicable to its subsidiaries for so long as Clear Channel Communications owns more than 50% of the total voting power of our outstanding common stock, except (i) to the extent such policies conflict with our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or bylaws or any of the agreements between Clear Channel Communications and us, or (ii) as otherwise agreed with Clear Channel Communications or superseded by any policies adopted by our board of directors; and
 
  •  restrictions on our ability to enter into any agreement that binds or purports to bind Clear Channel Communications.

104


Table of Contents

Approval Rights of Clear Channel Communications on Certain of our Activities
      Until the first date on which Clear Channel Communications owns less than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock, the prior affirmative vote or written consent of Clear Channel Communications is required for the following actions (subject in each case to certain agreed exceptions):
  •  a merger involving us or any of our subsidiaries (other than mergers involving our subsidiaries or to effect acquisitions permitted under our amended and restated certificate of incorporation);
 
  •  acquisitions by us or our subsidiaries of the stock or assets of another business for a price (including assumed debt) in excess of $5 million;
 
  •  dispositions by us or our subsidiaries of assets in a single transaction or a series of related transactions for a price (including assumed debt) in excess of $5 million;
 
  •  incurrence or guarantee of debt by us or our subsidiaries in excess of $400.0 million outstanding at any one time or that could reasonably be expected to result in a negative change in any of our credit ratings, excluding our debt with Clear Channel Communications described in this prospectus, intercompany debt (within our company and its subsidiaries), and debt determined to constitute operating leverage by a nationally recognized statistical rating organization;
 
  •  issuance by us or our subsidiaries of capital stock or other securities convertible into capital stock;
 
  •  enter into any agreement restricting our ability or the ability of any of our subsidiaries to pay dividends, borrow money, repay indebtedness, make loans or transfer assets, in any such case to our company or Clear Channel Communications;
 
  •  dissolution, liquidation or winding up of our company or any of our subsidiaries;
 
  •  adoption of a rights agreement; and
 
  •  alteration, amendment, termination or repeal of, or adoption of any provision inconsistent with, the provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or our bylaws relating to our authorized capital stock, the rights granted to the holders of the Class B common stock, amendments to our bylaws, stockholder action by written consent, stockholder proposals and meetings, limitation of liability of and indemnification of our officers and directors, the size or classes of our board of directors, corporate opportunities and conflicts of interest between our company and Clear Channel Communications, and Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law.
Corporate Services Agreement
      We will enter into a corporate services agreement with Clear Channel Communications or one of its affiliates prior to the completion of this offering to provide us certain administrative and support services and other assistance in the United States consistent with the services provided to us before the offering. In this prospectus, we refer to this agreement as the Corporate Services Agreement. The services Clear Channel Communications will provide us, as qualified in the agreement, include, without limitation, the following:
  •  treasury, payroll and other financial related services;
 
  •  executive officer services;
 
  •  human resources and employee benefits;
 
  •  legal and related services;
 
  •  information systems, network and related services;
 
  •  investment services;
 
  •  corporate services; and
 
  •  procurement and sourcing support.

105


Table of Contents

      The charges for the corporate services generally are intended to allow Clear Channel Communications to fully recover the allocated direct costs of providing the services, plus all out-of-pocket costs and expenses, generally without profit. The allocation of cost will be based on various measures depending on the service provided, which measures will include relative revenue, employee headcount or number of users of a service.
      Under the Corporate Services Agreement, we and Clear Channel Communications will each have the right to purchase goods or services, use intellectual property licensed from third parties and realize other benefits and rights under the other party’s agreements with third-party vendors to the extent allowed by such vendor agreements. The agreement also will provide for the lease or sublease of certain facilities used in the operation of our respective businesses and for access to each other’s computing and telecommunications systems to the extent necessary to perform or receive the corporate services.
      The Corporate Services Agreement will require Clear Channel Communications to continue to make available to us the range of services provided by Clear Channel Communications prior to this offering, as qualified by such agreement, and will require us to utilize such services in the conduct of our business until such time as Clear Channel Communications owns less than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock. The Corporate Services Agreement may be terminated by mutual agreement of Clear Channel Communications and us at any time, or upon no less than six months prior notice after such time as Clear Channel Communications owns less than 50% of the total voting power of our common stock. However, the Corporate Services Agreement will require Clear Channel Communications to provide, and us to continue to use, certain specified services, generally related to information technology, for a period of time specified in the agreement after the expiration of the six month notice period. Our participation in the Clear Channel Communications employee benefit plans may be terminated by us or by Clear Channel Communications on 90 days’ notice and, unless otherwise agreed, will terminate if and when Clear Channel Communications owns less than 80% of the total combined voting power of our common stock. See “— Employee Matters Agreement” below. Under the terms of the Corporate Services Agreement, Clear Channel Communications will not be liable to us for or in connection with any services rendered pursuant to the agreement or for any actions or inactions taken by Clear Channel Communications in connection with the provision of services. However, Clear Channel Communications will be liable for, and will indemnify a receiving party for, liabilities resulting from its gross negligence, willful misconduct, improper use or disclosure of client information or violations of law, subject to a cap on Clear Channel Communications’ liability of the amount received by Clear Channel Communications under the Corporate Services Agreement during the immediately preceding 12-month period. Additionally, we will indemnify Clear Channel Communications for any losses arising from the provision of services, except to the extent the liabilities are caused by Clear Channel Communications’ gross negligence or material breach of the Corporate Services Agreement.
      The Corporate Services Agreement provides that, with respect to executive services, after this offering Clear Channel Communications will make available to us, and we will be obligated to utilize, the services of the chief executive officer of Clear Channel Communications, currently Mark P. Mays, to serve as our Chief Executive Officer, and the chief financial officer of Clear Channel Communications, currently Randall T. Mays, to serve as our Chief Financial Officer. Our obligation to utilize the services of each of the chief executive officer and chief financial officer of Clear Channel Communications in these capacities will continue until Clear Channel Communications owns less than 50% of the voting power of our common stock or we provide Clear Channel Communications with six months prior written notice of termination. Clear Channel Communications will charge an allocable portion of the compensation and benefits costs of such persons based on the ratio of our OIBDAN to the total Clear Channel Communications OIBDAN using the previous year’s fiscal results. The compensation and benefits costs allocated to us will include such executives’ salary, bonus and other standard employee benefits, but will exclude equity based compensation. Because bonus is a major component of the allocable part of such executives’ compensation and increase in OIBDAN is a major element in calculating such bonus, OIBDAN was used as the basis for making the allocation of overall compensation expense between Clear Channel Communications and us.

106


Table of Contents

      Each of Mark and Randall Mays will be employed by Clear Channel Communications, and will spend a substantial part of his professional time and effort on behalf of Clear Channel Communications. In addition, both Mark and Randall Mays will serve as directors of the entertainment business of Clear Channel Communications, which is being spun off by Clear Channel Communications to its stockholders. We have not established any minimum time requirements for such officers. In addition, Mark and Randall Mays will continue to participate in Clear Channel Communications’ stock incentive and other benefits plans and will continue to hold a substantial number of shares of and/or options to purchase shares of common stock of Clear Channel Communications. These substantial interests in Clear Channel Communications’ equity present these officers with incentives different from those of our stockholders, and may create conflicts of interest described under “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Relationship with Clear Channel Communications.”
Registration Rights Agreement
      We will enter into a registration rights agreement with Clear Channel Communications prior to the completion of this offering to provide Clear Channel Communications with registration rights relating to shares of our outstanding common stock held by Clear Channel Communications after this offering. In this prospectus, we refer to this agreement as the Registration Rights Agreement.
      Clear Channel Communications may assign its rights under the Registration Rights Agreement to any person that acquires shares of our outstanding common stock subject to the agreement and agrees to be bound by the terms of the agreement. Subject to certain limitations, Clear Channel Communications and its permitted transferees may require us to register under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, all or any portion of these shares, a so-called “demand request.” We are not obligated to effect the following:
  •  a demand registration within 60 days after the effective date of a previous demand registration, other than a shelf registration pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act;
 
  •  a demand registration within 180 days after the effective date of the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part;
 
  •  a demand registration, unless the demand request is for a number of shares of common stock with a market value that is equal to at least $150.0 million; and
 
  •  more than two demand registrations during the first 12 months after this offering or more than three demand registrations during any 12-month period thereafter.
      We may defer the filing of a registration statement for a period of up to 90 days after a demand request has been made if (i) at the time of such request we are engaged in confidential business activities, which would be required to be disclosed in the registration statement, and our board of directors determines that such disclosure would be materially detrimental to us and our stockholders, or (ii) prior to receiving such request, our board of directors had determined to effect a registered underwritten public offering of our securities for our account and we have taken substantial steps to effect such offering. However, with respect to two demand requests only, if Clear Channel Communications or any of its affiliates makes a demand request during the two-year period after this offering, we will not have the right to defer such demand registration or to not file such registration statement during that period.
      Additionally, Clear Channel Communications and its permitted transferees have so-called “piggyback” registration rights, which means that Clear Channel Communications and its permitted transferees may include their respective shares in any future registrations of our equity securities, whether or not that registration relates to a primary offering by us or a secondary offering by or on behalf of any of our stockholders. The demand registration rights and piggyback registrations are each subject to market cutback exceptions.
      We will pay all costs and expenses in connection with any “demand” registration and any “piggyback” registration, except in each case underwriting discounts, commissions or fees attributable to the shares of common stock sold by Clear Channel Communications. The Registration Rights Agreement will set forth customary registration procedures, including an agreement by us to make our management available for road show presentations in connection with any underwritten offerings. We will also agree to indemnify

107


Table of Contents

Clear Channel Communications and its permitted transferees with respect to liabilities resulting from untrue statements or omissions in any registration statement used in any such registration, other than untrue statements or omissions resulting from information furnished to us for use in the registration statement by Clear Channel Communications or any permitted transferee.
      The rights of Clear Channel Communications and its permitted transferees under the Registration Rights Agreement will remain in effect with respect to the shares of common stock covered by the agreement until those shares:
  •  have been sold pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act;
 
  •  have been sold to the public pursuant to Rule 144 under the Securities Act;
 
  •  have been transferred in a transaction where subsequent public distribution of the shares would not require registration under the Securities Act; or
 
  •  are no longer outstanding.
      Additionally, the registration rights under the agreement will cease to apply to a holder other than Clear Channel Communications or its affiliates when such holder holds less than 3% of economic value of the then-outstanding shares of common stock covered by the agreement and such shares are eligible for sale pursuant to Rule 144(k) under the Securities Act.
Tax Matters Agreement
      After this offering, we and certain of our eligible corporate subsidiaries will continue to be included in the affiliated group of corporations that files a consolidated return for U.S. federal income tax purposes of which Clear Channel Communications is the common parent corporation, and in certain cases, we or one or more of our subsidiaries may be included in the combined, consolidated or unitary group of Clear Channel Communications or one or more of its subsidiaries for certain foreign, state and local income tax purposes. Prior to the completion of this offering, we and Clear Channel Communications will enter into a tax matters agreement to allocate the responsibility of Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries, on the one hand, and we and our subsidiaries, on the other, for the payment of taxes resulting from filing tax returns on a combined, consolidated or unitary basis. In this prospectus, we refer to this agreement as the Tax Matters Agreement.
      With respect to tax returns for any taxable period in which we or any of our subsidiaries is included in the federal consolidated group or a state consolidated group of Clear Channel Communications or any of its subsidiaries, we will make payments to Clear Channel Communications pursuant to the Tax Matters Agreement equal to the amount of taxes that would be paid if we and each of our subsidiaries included in the consolidated group filed a separate tax return. We will also pay Clear Channel Communications the amount of any taxes with respect to tax returns that include only us or any of our subsidiaries, which returns, as described below, will be prepared and filed by Clear Channel Communications.
      With respect to certain tax items, such as foreign tax credits, alternative minimum tax credits, net operating losses and net capital losses, that are generated by us or our subsidiaries, but are used by Clear Channel Communications or its subsidiaries when the tax return for the consolidated group is filed, we will be reimbursed by Clear Channel Communications as such tax items are used.
      Under the Tax Matters Agreement, Clear Channel Communications is appointed the sole and exclusive agent for us and our subsidiaries in any and all matters relating to taxes, will have sole and exclusive responsibility for the preparation and filing of all tax returns (or amended returns) and will have the power, in its sole discretion, to contest or compromise any asserted tax adjustment or deficiency and to file, litigate or compromise any claim for refund on behalf of us or any of our subsidiaries. Additionally, Clear Channel Communications will determine the amount of our liability to (or entitlement to payment from) Clear Channel Communications under the Tax Matters Agreement. This arrangement may result in conflicts of interest between Clear Channel Communications and us. For example, under the Tax Matters Agreement, Clear Channel Communications will be able to choose to contest, compromise or settle any adjustment or deficiency proposed by the relevant taxing authority in a manner that may be beneficial to Clear Channel Communications and detrimental to us.

108


Table of Contents

      For U.S. federal income tax purposes, each member of an affiliated group of corporations that files a consolidated return is jointly and severally liable for the U.S. federal income tax liability of the entire group. Similar principles may apply with respect to members of a group that file a tax return on a combined, consolidated or unitary group basis for foreign, state and local tax purposes. Accordingly, although the Tax Matters Agreement will allocate tax liabilities between Clear Channel Communications and us during the period in which we or any of our subsidiaries is included in the consolidated group of Clear Channel Communications or any of its subsidiaries, we and our subsidiaries included in such consolidated group could be liable for the tax liability of the entire consolidated group in the event any such tax liability is incurred and not discharged by Clear Channel Communications. The Tax Matters Agreement will provide, however, that Clear Channel Communications will indemnify us and our subsidiaries to the extent that, as a result of us or any of our subsidiaries being a member of a consolidated group, we or our subsidiaries becomes liable for the tax liability of the entire consolidated group (other than the portion of such liability for which we and our subsidiaries are liable under the Tax Matters Agreement).
      Under Section 482 of the Code, the Internal Revenue Service has the authority in certain instances to redistribute, reapportion or reallocate gross income, deductions, credits or allowances between Clear Channel Communications and us. Other taxing authorities may have similar authority under comparable provisions of foreign, state and local law. The Tax Matters Agreement provides that we or Clear Channel Communications will indemnify the other to the extent that, as a result of the Internal Revenue Service exercising its authority (or any other taxing authority exercising a similar authority), the tax liability of one group is reduced while the tax liability of the other group is increased.
      If Clear Channel Communications spins off our Class B common stock to its stockholders in a distribution that is intended to be tax-free under Section 355 of the Code, we have agreed in the Tax Matters Agreement to indemnify Clear Channel Communications and its affiliates against any and all tax-related liabilities if such a spin-off fails to qualify as a tax-free distribution (including as a result of Section 355(e) of the Code) due to actions, events or transactions relating to our stock, assets or business, or a breach of the relevant representations or covenants made by us in the Tax Matters Agreement. If neither we nor Clear Channel Communications is responsible under the Tax Matters Agreement for any such spin-off not being tax-free under Section 355 of the Code, we and Clear Channel Communications have agreed that we will each be responsible for 50% of the tax related liabilities arising from the failure of such a spin-off to so qualify.
Employee Matters Agreement
      We have entered into an employee matters agreement with Clear Channel Communications covering certain compensation and employee benefit issues. In this prospectus, we refer to this agreement as the Employee Matters Agreement. In general, with certain exceptions, our employees will continue to participate in the Clear Channel Communications employee plans and arrangements along with the employees of other Clear Channel Communications subsidiaries, on terms and conditions consistent with past practice. We will also continue to have our payroll administered by Clear Channel Communications, also on terms and conditions consistent with past practice.
      We and Clear Channel Communications reserve the right to withdraw from or terminate our participation, as the case may be, in any of the Clear Channel Communications employee plans and arrangements at any time and for any reason, subject to at least 90 days’ notice. Unless sooner terminated, it is likely that our participation in Clear Channel Communications employee plans and arrangements will end if and at such time as we are no longer a subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications, which, for this purpose, means Clear Channel Communications owns less than 80% of the total combined voting power of all classes of our capital stock entitled to vote. We will, however, continue to bear the cost of and retain responsibility for all employment-related liabilities and obligations associated with our employees (and their covered dependents and beneficiaries), regardless of when incurred.
      We will have our own stock incentive and annual incentive plans in place for our employees. These plans are described in “Management — Employee Benefits Plans.” Our employees who participate in the

109


Table of Contents

Clear Channel Communications Annual Incentive Compensation Plan will continue their participation for the balance of 2005, pursuant to the performance-based awards previously made to them. We will make the performance-related evaluations and determinations of 2005 bonus amounts earned by our executive officers under the Clear Channel Communications plan. For 2006, our executive officers and other designated key employees will be covered by our plan.
      Some or all of the Clear Channel Communications stock options granted to our employees before this offering may be converted into options to purchase shares of our Class A common stock, subject generally to the same vesting and other terms and conditions applicable to the original Clear Channel Communications options. See “Management — Clear Channel Communications Stock Plan Awards.”
Trademarks
      Prior to the completion of this offering, we will amend and restate a trademark license agreement that entitles us to use (i) on a nonexclusive basis, the “Clear Channel” trademark and the Clear Channel Communications “outdoor” trademark logo with respect to day-to-day operations of our business; and (ii) certain other Clear Channel Communications marks in connection with our business. In this prospectus, we refer to this agreement as the Trademark License Agreement. Our use of the marks will be subject to Clear Channel Communications’ approval. Clear Channel Communications may terminate our use of the marks in certain circumstances, including (i) a breach by us of a term or condition of the Master Agreement, the Corporate Services Agreement, the Tax Matters Agreement or the Employee Matters Agreement and (ii) at any time after Clear Channel Communications ceases to own at least 50% of the total voting power of our common stock. For our use of these trademarks and other marks, we pay Clear Channel Communications a royalty fee which is approximately 1.5% of gross receipts (or outdoor advertising revenues earned by users of the marks) less an annual management fee of $21,600. For the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003, we recorded $15.8 million and $14.1 million of royalty fees, respectively.
Clear Channel Communications Agreements with Third Parties
      Historically, we have received services provided by third parties pursuant to various agreements that Clear Channel Communications has entered into for the benefit of its affiliates. We pay the third parties directly for the services they provide to us or reimburse Clear Channel Communications for our share of the actual costs incurred under the agreements. After this offering, we intend to continue to procure certain of these third-party services, including services related to insurance, vehicle leases, information technology and software, through contracts entered into by Clear Channel Communications, to the extent we are permitted (and elect to) or required to do so.
Products and Services Provided between Clear Channel Communications and Us
      We and Clear Channel Communications engage in transactions in the ordinary course of our respective businesses. These transactions include our providing billboard and other advertising space to Clear Channel Communications at rates we believe would be charged to a third party in an arm’s length transaction.
      Our branch managers have historically followed a corporate policy allowing Clear Channel Communications to use, without charge, domestic displays that they or their staff believe would otherwise be unsold. Our sales personnel receive partial revenue credit for that usage for compensation purposes. This partial revenue credit is not included in our reported revenues. Clear Channel Communications bears the cost of producing the advertising and we bear the costs of installing and removing this advertising. In 2004, we estimated that these discounted revenues would have been less than 3% of our domestic revenues. Under the Master Agreement, this policy will continue.
Intercompany Notes
      We currently have issued three intercompany notes to Clear Channel Communications in the total original principal amount of approximately $4.0 billion. See “Use of Proceeds” and “Description of Indebtedness.”

110


Table of Contents

PRINCIPAL STOCKHOLDER
      We are an indirect, wholly owned subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications. All of our common stock is held by Clear Channel Holdings, Inc., another wholly owned subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications. After this offering, Clear Channel Communications will own all of our outstanding shares of Class B common stock, representing approximately           % of the outstanding shares of our common stock and approximately           % of the total voting power of our common stock, or approximately           % and           %, respectively, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock. Clear Channel Communications will not own any of our outstanding shares of Class A common stock. Each share of our Class B common stock is convertible while owned by Clear Channel Communications or any of its affiliates (excluding us and our subsidiaries) at the option of the holder thereof into one share of Class A common stock. Clear Channel Communications has advised us that its current intent is to continue to hold all of our Class B common stock owned by it after this offering and thereby retain its controlling interest in us. However, Clear Channel Communications is not subject to any contractual obligation that would prohibit it from selling, spinning off, splitting off or otherwise disposing of any shares of our common stock, except that Clear Channel Communications has agreed not to sell, spin off, split off or otherwise dispose of any shares of our common stock for a period of                    days after the date of this prospectus without the prior written consent of the underwriters, subject to certain limitations and limited exceptions. See “Underwriting.”

111


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
      Below we have provided a summary description of our capital stock. This description is not complete. You should read the full text of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws, which will be included as exhibits to the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part, as well as the provisions of applicable Delaware law.
General
      After this offering, we will be authorized to issue                     shares of our Class A common stock, $0.01 par value per share,                      shares or our Class B common stock, $0.01 par value per share, and                     shares of preferred stock, $0.01 par value per share.
Common Stock
      The rights of the Class A common stock and Class B common stock are substantially similar, except with respect to voting, conversion and transferability.
Voting Rights
      Each share of Class A common stock entitles its holder to one vote and each share of Class B common stock entitles its holder to 20 votes. Our Class A common stock and Class B common stock vote as a single class on all matters on which stockholders are entitled to vote, except as otherwise provided in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or as required by law. Generally, all matters to be voted on by stockholders must be approved by a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the holders of Class A common stock and Class B common stock present in person or represented by proxy, voting as a single class, subject to any voting rights granted to holders of any preferred stock. Except as otherwise provided by law or in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or in our bylaws, and subject to any voting rights granted to holders of any outstanding preferred stock and the powers of our board of directors to amend our bylaws, amendments to our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws must be approved by a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the holders of our common stock, voting as a single class. Our Class A common stock and Class B common stock are not entitled to cumulate their votes in the election of directors.
Dividends
      Holders of Class A common stock and Class B common stock will share equally, on a per share basis, in any cash dividend declared by our board of directors, subject to any preferential rights of any outstanding shares of preferred stock. Dividends payable in shares of common stock may be paid only as follows: (i) shares of Class A common stock may be paid only to holders of Class A common stock, and shares of Class B common stock may be paid only to holders of Class B common stock, and (ii) the number of shares so paid will be equal, on a per share basis, with respect to each outstanding share of Class A common stock and Class B common stock.
      We may not reclassify, subdivide or combine shares of either class of common stock without at the same time proportionally reclassifying, subdividing or combining shares of the other class.
Conversion
      While owned by Clear Channel Communications or any of its affiliates (excluding us), each share of our Class B common stock is convertible at the option of the holder thereof into one share of Class A common stock. In addition, any shares of Class B common stock transferred to a person other than Clear Channel Communications will convert into shares of Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis upon any such transfer, except for transfers to any of Clear Channel Communications’ affiliates (excluding us) or its stockholders pursuant to a tax-free transaction under Section 355 of the Code, or any corresponding provision of any successor statute, which we refer to as a tax-free spin-off.

112


Table of Contents

Conversion After a Tax-Free Spin-Off
      Following any distribution of Class B common stock to Clear Channel Communications’ common stockholders in a transaction (including any distribution in exchange for Clear Channel Communications shares or securities) intended to qualify as a tax-free spin-off, each share of our Class B common stock will be convertible at the option of the holder thereof into one share of Class A common stock. In addition, each share of our Class B common stock will convert into one share of our Class A common stock upon any transfer thereof subsequent to such tax-free spin-off.
      Clear Channel Communications may determine, in its sole discretion, in accordance with our amended and restated certificate of incorporation that our Class B common stock will not be convertible into shares of our Class A common stock after a tax-free spin-off and, in such case, we would seek to list the Class B common stock on the NYSE. Such Class B common stock would be transferable after the tax-free spin-off, subject to applicable laws.
      Although Clear Channel Communications has no current plans with respect to a tax-free spin-off of us, it will have the flexibility to effect a tax-free spin-off of us in the future.
Other Rights
      Unless approved by a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the holders of each class of common stock, voting separately as a class, in the event of any reorganization or consolidation of our company with one or more corporations or a merger of our company with another corporation in which shares of common stock are converted into or exchangeable for shares of stock, other securities or property (including cash), all holders of common stock, regardless of class, will be entitled to receive the same kind and amount of shares of stock and other securities and property (including cash).
      On liquidation, dissolution or winding up of our company, after payment in full of the amounts required to be paid to holders of preferred stock, if any, all holders of common stock, regardless of class, are entitled to receive the same amount per share with respect to any distribution of assets to holders of shares of common stock.
      No shares of either class of common stock are subject to redemption or have preemptive rights to purchase additional shares of common stock or other securities of our company.
      Upon completion of this offering, all the outstanding shares of Class A common stock and Class B common stock will be validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.
Preferred Stock
      Our board of directors has the authority, without action by our stockholders, to designate and issue our preferred stock in one or more series and to designate the rights, preferences and privileges of each series, which may be greater than the rights of our common stock. It is not possible to state the actual effect of the issuance of any shares of our preferred stock upon the rights of holders of our common stock until our board of directors determines the specific rights of the holders of our preferred stock. However, the effects might include, among other things:
  •  restricting dividends on our common stock;
 
  •  diluting the voting power of our common stock;
 
  •  impairing the liquidation rights of our common stock; or
 
  •  delaying or preventing a change in control of our company without further action by our stockholders.
      At the completion of this offering, no shares of our preferred stock will be outstanding and we have no present plans to issue any shares of our preferred stock.

113


Table of Contents

Provisions of Our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation Relating to Related-Party Transactions and Corporate Opportunities
      In order to address potential conflicts of interest between Clear Channel Communications and us, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation contains provisions regulating and defining the conduct of our affairs as they may involve Clear Channel Communications and its officers and directors, and our powers, rights, duties and liabilities and those of our officers, directors and stockholders in connection with our relationship with Clear Channel Communications. In general, these provisions recognize that we and Clear Channel Communications may engage in the same or similar business activities and lines of business, have an interest in the same areas of corporate opportunities and will continue to have contractual and business relations with each other, including officers and directors or both of Clear Channel Communications serving as our officers or directors or both.
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that, subject to any written agreement to the contrary, Clear Channel Communications will have no duty to refrain from engaging in the same or similar business activities or lines of business as us or doing business with any of our clients, customers or vendors or employing or otherwise engaging or soliciting any of our officers, directors or employees.
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that if Clear Channel Communications acquires knowledge of a potential transaction or matter which may be a corporate opportunity for both Clear Channel Communications and us, we will have renounced our interest in such corporate opportunity. Clear Channel Communications will, to the fullest extent permitted by law, have satisfied its fiduciary duty with respect to such a corporate opportunity and will not be liable to us or our stockholders for breach of any fiduciary duty as our stockholder by reason of the fact that it acquires or seeks the corporate opportunity for itself, directs that corporate opportunity to another person or does not present that corporate opportunity to us.
      If one of our directors or officers who is also a director or officer of Clear Channel Communications learns of a potential transaction or matter that may be a corporate opportunity for both Clear Channel Communications and us, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that we will have renounced our interest in the corporate opportunity unless that opportunity is expressly offered to that person in writing solely in his or her capacity as our director or officer.
      If one of our officers or directors, who also serves as a director or officer of Clear Channel Communications, learns of a potential transaction or matter that may be a corporate opportunity for both Clear Channel Communications and us, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that the director or officer will have no duty to communicate or present that corporate opportunity to us and will not be liable to us or our stockholders for breach of fiduciary duty by reason of Clear Channel Communications’ actions with respect to that corporate opportunity.
      For purposes of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, “corporate opportunities” include, but are not limited to, business opportunities that (i) we are financially able to undertake, (ii) are, from their nature, in our line of business, (iii) are of practical advantage to us and (iv) are ones in which we would have an interest or a reasonable expectancy.
      The corporate opportunity provisions in the restated certificate will expire on the date that Clear Channel Communications ceases to own shares of our common stock representing at least 20% of the total voting power and no person who is a director or officer of us is also a director or officer of Clear Channel Communications.
      By becoming a stockholder in our company, you will be deemed to have notice of and have consented to the provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation related to corporate opportunities that are described above.

114


Table of Contents

Anti-Takeover Effects of Our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws and Delaware Law
      Some provisions of Delaware law and our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws could make the following more difficult, although they have little significance while we are controlled by Clear Channel Communications:
  •  acquisition of us by means of a tender offer or merger;
 
  •  acquisition of us by means of a proxy contest or otherwise; or
 
  •  removal of our incumbent officers and directors.
      These provisions, summarized below, are expected to discourage coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids. These provisions also are designed to encourage persons seeking to acquire control of us to first negotiate with our board of directors. We believe that the benefits of the potential ability to negotiate with the proponent of an unfriendly or unsolicited proposal to acquire or restructure our company outweigh the disadvantages of discouraging those proposals because negotiation of them could result in an improvement of their terms.
Election and Removal of Directors
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that our board of directors is divided into three classes. The term of the first class of directors expires at our 2007 annual meeting of stockholders, the term of the second class of directors expires at our 2008 annual meeting of stockholders and the term of the third class of directors expires at our 2009 annual meeting of stockholders. At each of our annual meetings of stockholders, the successors of the class of directors whose term expires at that meeting of stockholders will be elected for a three-year term, one class being elected each year by our stockholders. This system of electing and removing directors may discourage a third party from making a tender offer or otherwise attempting to obtain control of us if Clear Channel Communications no longer controls us because it generally makes it more difficult for stockholders to replace a majority of our directors.
      Directors may be removed, with or without cause, by the affirmative vote of shares representing a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors as long as Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) owns shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors. Once Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) cease to own shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation requires that directors may only be removed for cause and only by the affirmative vote of not less than 80% of votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors.
Size of Board and Vacancies
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that the number of directors on our board of directors will be fixed exclusively by our board of directors. Newly created directorships resulting from any increase in our authorized number of directors will be filled solely by the vote of our remaining directors in office. Any vacancies in our board of directors resulting from death, resignation, retirement, disqualification, removal from office or other cause will be filled solely by the vote of our remaining directors in office; provided, however, that as long as Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) continue to beneficially own shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors and such vacancy was caused by the action of stockholders, then such vacancy may only be filled by the affirmative vote of shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding common stock in the election of our board of directors.

115


Table of Contents

Stockholder Action by Written Consent
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation permits our stockholders to act by written consent without a meeting as long as Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) continue to beneficially own shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors. Once Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) cease to beneficially own at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation eliminates the right of our stockholders to act by written consent.
Amendment of Our Bylaws
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws provide that the provisions of our bylaws relating to the calling of meetings of stockholders, notice of meetings of stockholders, required quorum at meetings of stockholders, conduct of meetings of stockholders, stockholder action by written consent, advance notice of stockholder business or director nominations, the authorized number of directors, the classified board structure, the filling of director vacancies or the removal of directors and indemnification of officers and directors (and any provision relating to the amendment of any of these provisions) may only be amended by the vote of a majority of our entire board of directors or, as long as Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) owns shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors, by the vote of holders of a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors. Once Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) cease to own shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws provide that these provisions may only be amended by the vote of a majority of our entire board of directors or by the vote of holders of at least 80% of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors.
Amendment of Certain Provisions of Our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation
      The amendment of any of the above provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation requires approval by holders of shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors, as long as Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) owns shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors. Once Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) cease to own shares representing at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and applicable provisions of Delaware law provide that these provisions may only be amended by the vote of a majority of our entire board of directors followed by the vote of holders of at least 80% of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors.
Stockholder Meetings
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws provide that a special meeting of our stockholders may be called only by (i) Clear Channel Communications, so long as Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries (excluding our company and our subsidiaries) beneficially own at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors or (ii) the Chairman of our board of directors or our board of directors.

116


Table of Contents

Requirements for Advance Notification of Stockholder Nominations and Proposals
      Our bylaws establish advance notice procedures with respect to stockholder proposals and nomination of candidates for election as directors other than nominations made by or at the direction of our board of directors or a committee of our board of directors.
      In general, for nominations or other business to be properly brought before an annual meeting by a stockholder, the stockholder must give notice in writing to our secretary 90 to 120 days before the first anniversary of the preceding year’s annual meeting, and the business must be a proper matter for stockholder action. The stockholder’s notice must include for each proposed nominee and business, as applicable, (i) all required information under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, (ii) the proposed nominee’s written consent to serve as a director if elected, (iii) a brief description of the proposed business, (iv) the reasons for conducting the business at the meeting, (v) the stockholder’s material interest in the business, (vi) the stockholder’s name and address and (vii) the class and number of our shares which the stockholder owns.
      In general, only such business shall be conducted at a special meeting of stockholders as shall have been brought before the meeting pursuant to our notice of meeting. At a special meeting of stockholders at which directors are to be elected pursuant to our notice of meeting, a stockholder who is a stockholder of record at the time of giving notice, who is entitled to vote at the meeting and who complies with the notice procedures, may nominate proposed nominees. In the event we call a special meeting of stockholders to elect one or more directors, a stockholder may nominate a person or persons if the stockholder’s notice is delivered to our secretary 90 to 120 days before the such special meeting.
      Only such persons who are nominated in accordance with the procedures set forth in our bylaws shall be eligible to serve as directors and only such business shall be conducted at a meeting of stockholders as shall have been brought before the meeting in accordance with the procedures set forth in our bylaws. The chairman of the meeting shall have the power and duty to determine whether a nomination or any business proposed to be brought before the meeting was made or proposed in accordance with the procedures set forth in or bylaws and, if any proposed nomination or business is not in compliance with our bylaws, to declare that such defective proposal or nomination shall be disregarded.
      Clear Channel Communications shall be entitled to nominate persons for election to the board of directors and propose business to be considered by stockholders at any meeting of stockholders without compliance with the foregoing advance notice requirements, so long as Clear Channel Communications owns at least 50% of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding capital stock in the election of our board of directors.
Delaware Anti-Takeover Law
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law, an anti-takeover law, does not apply to us until Clear Channel Communications owns less than 15% of the total voting power of our common stock, at which date Section 203 shall apply prospectively.
      In general, Section 203 prohibits a publicly held Delaware corporation from engaging in a business combination with an interested stockholder for a period of three years following the date the person became an interested stockholder, unless the business combination or the transaction in which the person became an interested stockholder is approved in a prescribed manner. Generally, a “business combination” includes a merger, asset or stock sale, or other transaction resulting in a financial benefit to the interested stockholder. Generally, an “interested stockholder” is a person that, together with affiliates and associates, owns, or within three years prior to the determination of interested stockholder status, did own 15% or more of a corporation’s voting stock. This may have an anti-takeover effect with respect to transactions not approved in advance by our board of directors, including discouraging attempts that might result in a premium over the market price for the shares of our common stock.

117


Table of Contents

No Cumulative Voting
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws do not provide for cumulative voting in the election of our board of directors.
Pre-Offering Transactions with Clear Channel Communications
      Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that neither any agreement nor any transaction entered into between us or any of our affiliated companies and Clear Channel Communications and any of its affiliated companies prior to this offering nor the subsequent performance of any such agreement will be considered void or voidable or unfair to us because Clear Channel Communications or any of its affiliated companies is a party or because directors or officers of Clear Channel Communications were on our board of directors when those agreements or transactions were approved. In addition, those agreements and transactions and their performance will not be contrary to any fiduciary duty of any directors or officers of our company or any affiliated company.
Transfer Agent and Registrar
      The transfer agent and registrar for our Class A common stock is Bank of New York.
New York Stock Exchange Listing
      We expect the shares of our Class A common stock to be approved for listing on the NYSE under the symbol “CCO.”

118


Table of Contents

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
      Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our Class A common stock. The sale of a substantial amount of our common stock in the public market after this offering, or the perception that such sales may occur, could adversely affect the prevailing market price of our Class A common stock. Furthermore, because some of our shares will not be available for sale shortly after this offering due to the contractual and legal restrictions on resale described below, the sale of a substantial amount of common stock in the public market after these restrictions lapse could adversely affect the prevailing market price of our Class A common stock and our ability to raise equity capital in the future.
      Upon the completion of this offering, we will have                     shares of common stock outstanding (assuming the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock is not exercised in full), which includes the approximately                     shares of Class A common stock sold by us in this offering and approximately                     shares of Class B common stock outstanding (including                      shares of Class B common stock issued by us in exchange for a portion of the balance of the intercompany notes because the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares is not exercised in full).
      Of those shares, all of the shares of our Class A common stock sold in this offering will be freely tradable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act, unless the shares are purchased by “affiliates” as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act. Any shares purchased by an affiliate may not be resold except in compliance with Rule 144 volume limitations, manner of sale and notice requirements, pursuant to another applicable exemption from registration or pursuant to an effective registration statement. The shares of our Class B common stock held by Clear Channel Communications are “restricted securities” as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act. These restricted securities may be sold in the public market by Clear Channel Communications only if they are registered or if they qualify for an exemption from registration under Rule 144 or Rule 144(k) under the Securities Act. These rules are summarized below.
Rule 144
      In general, under Rule 144 as currently in effect, beginning 90 days after the date of this prospectus, a person or persons whose shares are aggregated, who have beneficially owned restricted shares for at least one year, including persons who may be deemed to be our “affiliates,” would be entitled to sell within any three-month period a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of (i) 1% of the number of shares of common stock then outstanding, which will equal approximately                      shares immediately after this offering, or (ii) the average weekly trading volume of our Class A common stock on the New York Stock Exchange during the four calendar weeks before a notice of the sale on SEC Form 144 is filed.
      Sales under Rule 144 are also subject to certain manner of sale provisions and notice requirements and to the availability of certain public information about us.
Rule 144(k)
      Under Rule 144(k), a person who is not deemed to have been one of our “affiliates” at any time during the 90 days preceding a sale, and who has beneficially owned the shares proposed to be sold for at least two years, including the holding period of any prior owner other than an “affiliate,” is entitled to sell these shares without complying with the manner of sale, public information, volume limitation or notice provisions of Rule 144.
Stock Issued Under Employee Plans
      We intend to file registration statements on Form S-8 under the Securities Act to register approximately                     shares of Class A common stock issuable with respect to options and restricted stock units to be granted under our employee plans. Currently, there are no outstanding options to purchase shares of our Class A common stock or restricted stock units. These registration statements are expected to be filed following the effective date of the registration statement of which this prospectus is a

119


Table of Contents

part and will be effective upon filing. Shares issued upon the exercise of stock options or restricted stock units after the effective date of the Form S-8 registration statements will be eligible for resale in the public market without restriction, subject to Rule 144 limitations applicable to affiliates.
Lock-up Agreements
      Notwithstanding the foregoing, our company, our directors and officers and Clear Channel Communications have agreed with the underwriters not to dispose of or hedge any of our common stock or securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of common stock owned by them during the period from the date of this prospectus continuing through the date                     days after the date of this prospectus, except with the prior written consent of the underwriters, subject to certain limitations and limited exceptions. See “Underwriting.”
Registration Rights
      As described in “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us — Registration Rights Agreement,” we will enter into a registration rights agreement with Clear Channel Communications. We do not have any other contractual obligations to register our stock.

120


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF INDEBTEDNESS
      On August 2, 2005, one of our wholly owned subsidiaries issued to us an intercompany note in the original principal amount of $2.5 billion, which we subsequently distributed to our parent, Clear Channel Holdings, Inc., as a dividend on our common stock and in turn Clear Channel Holdings, Inc. distributed the note to its and our ultimate parent, Clear Channel Communications, as a dividend on its common stock. This note matures on August 2, 2010, may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, and accrues interest at a variable per annum rate equal to the weighted average cost of debt for Clear Channel Communications, as determined by Clear Channel Communications from time to time. At September 30, 2005, the interest rate on the $2.5 billion intercompany note was 5.7%.
      Upon a change of control of us, the entire outstanding principal amount of, and all accrued interest on, this note, and all accrued related costs and expenses are mandatorily payable.
      Until all our obligations evidenced by and provided for in the $2.5 billion intercompany note are fully paid, we and our subsidiaries are subject to certain negative covenants contained in the note, including limitations on the following:
  •  becoming liable for consolidated funded indebtedness (as defined in the note), excluding certain intercompany indebtedness or guarantees of indebtedness incurred by Clear Channel Communications or certain of its subsidiaries, in a principal amount in excess of $400.0 million at any one time outstanding;
 
  •  creating liens;
 
  •  making investments;
 
  •  sale and leaseback transactions (as defined in the note), which when aggregated with consolidated funded indebtedness secured by liens, will not exceed an amount equal to 10% of our total consolidated shareholder’s equity (as defined in the note) as shown on our most recently reported annual audited consolidated financial statements;
 
  •  disposing of all or substantially all of our assets;
 
  •  mergers and consolidations;
 
  •  declaring or paying dividends or other distributions;
 
  •  repurchasing our equity; and
 
  •  limitations on entering into transactions with our affiliates.
      In addition, upon our issuances of equity and incurrences of debt, subject to certain exceptions, we are required to prepay the note in the amount of net proceeds received from such events. The note contains customary events that permit its maturity to be accelerated prior to its stated maturity date including our failure to comply with any of its negative covenants. See “Arrangements Between Clear Channel Communications and Us.”
      We believe that the size of the $2.5 billion intercompany note, combined with our additional existing third party indebtedness, sets a leverage level for us that is appropriate for a company with our asset mix and is generally in line with our peer companies. Furthermore, we believe that future cash flow from operations will be sufficient to fund the interest on our indebtedness obligations for a period of at least 18 months.
      For additional information regarding our other indebtedness, see “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Business,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Financial Condition and Liquidity — Liquidity,” “Use of Proceeds” and Note F to the notes to our combined financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.

121


Table of Contents

MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL TAX CONSIDERATIONS FOR NON-U.S. HOLDERS
OF COMMON STOCK
      The following discussion summarizes the material U.S. federal income and estate tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and disposition of our Class A common stock by certain non-U.S. holders (as defined below). This discussion only applies to non-U.S. holders who purchase and hold our Class A common stock as a capital asset for U.S. federal income tax purposes (generally property held for investment). This discussion does not describe all of the tax consequences that may be relevant to a non-U.S. holder in light of its particular circumstances.
      A “non-U.S. holder,” for the purposes of this discussion, means a person (other than a partnership) that is not for U.S. federal income tax purposes any of the following:
  •  an individual citizen or resident of the United States (including certain former citizens and former long-term residents);
 
  •  a corporation (or any other entity treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes) created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the District of Columbia;
 
  •  an estate the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source; or
 
  •  a trust if it (a) is subject to the primary supervision of a court within the United States and one or more United States persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust or (b) has a valid election in effect under applicable United States Treasury regulations to be treated as a United States person.
      This discussion is based upon provisions of the Code and regulations, rulings and judicial decisions as of the date hereof. These authorities may be changed, perhaps retroactively, so as to result in U.S. federal income and estate tax consequences different from those summarized below. This discussion does not address all aspects of U.S. federal income and estate taxes and does not describe any foreign, state, local or other tax considerations that may be relevant to non-U.S. holders in light of their particular circumstances. In addition, this discussion does not describe the U.S. federal income and estate tax consequences applicable to you if you are subject to special treatment under the U.S. federal income tax laws (including if you are a United States expatriate, “controlled foreign corporation,” “passive foreign investment company,” corporation that accumulates earnings to avoid U.S. federal income tax, pass-through entity or an investor in a pass-through entity). We cannot assure you that a change in law will not alter significantly the tax considerations that we describe in this discussion.
      If a partnership (or any other entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes) holds our Class A common stock, the U.S. federal income tax treatment of a partner of that partnership will generally depend upon the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. If you are a partner of a partnership holding our Class A common stock, you should consult your tax advisors.
      This discussion is provided for general information only and does not constitute legal advice to any prospective purchaser of our Class A common stock. Additionally, this discussion cannot be used by any holder for the purpose of avoiding tax penalties that may be imposed on such holder. If you are considering the purchase of our Class A common stock, you should consult your own tax advisors concerning the U.S. federal income and estate tax consequences of purchasing, owning and disposing of our Class A common stock in light of your particular circumstances and any consequences arising under the laws of applicable state, local or foreign taxing jurisdictions. You should also consult with your tax advisors concerning any possible enactment of legislation that would affect your investment in our Class A common stock in your particular circumstances.
Dividends
      Dividends paid to a non-U.S. holder of our Class A common stock generally will be subject to withholding of U.S. federal income tax at a 30% rate or such lower rate as may be specified by an

122


Table of Contents

applicable income tax treaty. However, dividends that are effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business by the non-U.S. holder within the United States (and, where a tax treaty applies, are attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment of the non-U.S. holder) are not subject to the withholding tax, provided certain certification and disclosure requirements are satisfied. Instead, such dividends are subject to U.S. federal income tax on a net income basis in the same manner as if the non-U.S. holder were a United States person as defined under the Code, unless an applicable income tax treaty provides otherwise. Any such effectively connected dividends received by a foreign corporation may be subject to an additional “branch profits tax” at a 30% rate or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty.
      A non-U.S. holder of our Class A common stock who wishes to claim the benefit of an applicable treaty rate and avoid backup withholding, as discussed below, for dividends will be required to either:
  •  complete Internal Revenue Service Form W-8BEN (or other applicable form) and certify under penalty of perjury that such holder is not a United States person as defined under the Code and is eligible for treaty benefits; or
 
  •  if our Class A common stock is held through certain foreign intermediaries, satisfy the relevant certification requirements of applicable United States Treasury regulations.
      Special certification and other requirements apply to certain non-U.S. holders that are pass-through entities rather than corporations or individuals.
      A non-U.S. holder of our Class A common stock eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. withholding tax pursuant to an income tax treaty may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld by filing an appropriate claim for refund with the Internal Revenue Service.
Gain on Disposition of Class A Common Stock
      Any gain realized by a non-U.S. holder on the disposition of our Class A common stock generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax unless:
  •  the gain is effectively connected with a trade or business of the non-U.S. holder in the United States (and, if required by an applicable income tax treaty, is attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment of the non-U.S. holder);
 
  •  the non-U.S. holder is an individual who is present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of that disposition, and certain other conditions are met; or
 
  •  we are or have been a “United States real property holding corporation” for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
      An individual non-U.S. holder described in the first bullet point immediately above will be subject to tax on the net gain derived from the sale under regular graduated U.S. federal income tax rates. An individual non-U.S. holder described in the second bullet point immediately above will be subject to a flat 30% tax on the gain derived from the sale, which may be offset by U.S. source capital losses, even though the individual is not considered a resident of the United States. If a non-U.S. holder that is a foreign corporation falls under the first bullet point immediately above, it will be subject to tax on its net gain in the same manner as if it were a United States person as defined under the Code and, in addition, may be subject to the branch profits tax equal to 30% of its effectively connected earnings and profits or at such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty.
      We believe we are not and do not anticipate becoming a “United States real property holding corporation” for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

123


Table of Contents

Federal Estate Tax
      Class A common stock held by an individual non-U.S. holder at the time of death will be included in such non-U.S. holder’s gross estate for U.S. federal estate tax purposes, unless an applicable estate tax treaty provides otherwise.
Information Reporting and Backup Withholding
      We must report annually to the Internal Revenue Service and to each non-U.S. holder the amount of dividends paid to such non-U.S. holder and the tax withheld with respect to such dividends, regardless of whether withholding was required. Copies of the information returns reporting such dividends and withholding may also be made available to the tax authorities in the country in which the non-U.S. holder resides under the provisions of an applicable income tax treaty.
      A non-U.S. holder will be subject to backup withholding for dividends paid to such non-U.S. holder unless such non-U.S. holder certifies under penalty of perjury that it is a non-U.S. holder (and the payor does not have actual knowledge or reason to know that such non-U.S. holder is a United States person as defined under the Code), and such non-U.S. holder otherwise establishes an exemption.
      Information reporting and, depending on the circumstances, backup withholding will apply to the proceeds of a sale of our Class A common stock within the United States or conducted through certain United States-related financial intermediaries, unless the beneficial owner certifies under penalty of perjury that it is a non-U.S. holder (and the payor does not have actual knowledge or reason to know that the beneficial owner is a United States person as defined under the Code), and such owner otherwise establishes an exemption.
      Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules may be allowed as a refund or a credit against a non-U.S. holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability provided the required information is furnished to the Internal Revenue Service.

124


Table of Contents

UNDERWRITING
      We and the underwriters named below have entered into an underwriting agreement with respect to the shares being offered. Subject to certain conditions, each underwriter has severally agreed to purchase the number of shares indicated in the following table. Goldman, Sachs & Co. will act as global coordinator and senior book-running manager for the offering.                     and                     will act as the joint book-running managers of the underwriters listed below:
         
Underwriters   Number of Shares
     
Goldman, Sachs & Co. 
       
Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. 
       
J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. 
       
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated 
       
UBS Securities LLC
       
Banc of America Securities LLC
       
Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. 
       
Credit Suisse First Boston
       
Allen & Company LLC
       
Barrington Research Associates, Inc. 
       
Harris Nesbitt Corp. 
       
SunTrust Capital Markets, Inc. 
       
Wachovia Capital Markets, LLC
       
       
Total
       
       
      The underwriters are committed to take and pay for all of the shares being offered, if any are taken, other than the shares covered by the option described below unless and until this option is exercised.
      If the underwriters sell more shares than the total number set forth in the table above, the underwriters have an option to buy up to an additional                     shares to cover such sales. They may exercise that option for 30 days. If any shares are purchased pursuant to this option, the underwriters will severally purchase shares in approximately the same proportion as set forth in the table above.
      The following tables show the per share and total underwriting discounts and commissions to be paid to the underwriters by us. Such amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares.
                 
Paid by the Company   No Exercise   Full Exercise
         
Per Share
               
Total
               
      Shares sold by the underwriters to the public will initially be offered at an initial public offering price of $           per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus. Any shares sold by the underwriters to securities dealers may be sold at a discount of up to $           per share from the initial public offering price. Any such securities dealers may resell any shares purchased from the underwriters to certain other brokers or dealers at a discount of up to $           per share from the initial public offering price. If all the shares are not sold at the initial public offering price, the representatives may change the offering price and the other selling terms.
      We and our directors, executive officers and certain other employees,                     (to the extent of any remaining interest) and Clear Channel Communications have agreed with the underwriters, subject to certain exceptions, not to dispose of or hedge any of their common stock or securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of common stock during the period from the date of this prospectus and

125


Table of Contents

continuing to and including the date                     days after the date of this prospectus, except with the prior written consent of the underwriters, subject to certain limitations and limited exceptions. However, in the event that either (1) during the last 17 days of the “lock-up” period, we release earnings results or material news or a material event relating to us occurs or (2) prior to the expiration of the “lock-up” period, we announce that we will release earnings results during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the “lock-up” period, then in either case the expiration of the “lock-up” will be extended until the expiration of the 18-day period beginning on the date of the release of the earnings results or the occurrence of the material news or material event, as applicable, unless the representatives waive, in writing, such an extension. We have been advised by the underwriters that they may at their discretion waive the lock-up agreements; however, they have no current intention of releasing any shares subject to a lock-up agreement. The release of any lock-up would be considered on a case-by-case basis. In considering any request to release shares covered by a lock-up agreement, the representatives would consider, among other factors, the particular circumstances surrounding the request, including but not limited to the number of shares requested to be released, market conditions, the possible impact on the market for our Class A common stock, the trading price of our Class A common stock, historical trading volumes of our Class A common stock, the reasons for the request and whether the person seeking the release is one of our officers or directors. No agreement has been made between the representatives and us or any of our stockholders pursuant to which the representatives will waive the lock-up restrictions.
      Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the shares of Class A common stock. The initial public offering price will be negotiated among us and the representatives. Among the factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price of the shares of Class A common stock, in addition to prevailing market conditions, will be our historical performance, estimates of our business potential and earnings prospects, an assessment of our management and the consideration of the above factors in relation to market valuation of companies in related businesses.
      We intend to have the Class A common stock listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “CCO.” In order to meet one of the requirements for listing on the NYSE, the underwriters have undertaken to sell lots of 100 or more shares of Class A common stock to a minimum of 2,000 beneficial holders.
      In connection with the offering, the underwriters may purchase and sell shares of common stock in the open market. These transactions may include short sales, stabilizing transactions and purchases to cover positions created by short sales. Short sales involve the sale by the underwriters of a greater number of shares than they are required to purchase in the offering. “Covered” short sales are sales made in an amount not greater than the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares from us in the offering. The underwriters may close out any covered short position by either exercising their option to purchase additional shares or purchasing shares in the open market. In determining the source of shares to close out the covered short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of shares available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase additional shares pursuant to the option granted to them. “Naked” short sales are any sales in excess of such option. The underwriters must close out any naked short position by purchasing shares in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the common stock in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in the offering. Stabilizing transactions consist of various bids for or purchases of common stock made by the underwriters in the open market prior to the completion of the offering.
      The underwriters may also impose a penalty bid. This occurs when a particular underwriter repays to the underwriters a portion of the underwriting discount received by it because the representatives have repurchased shares sold by or for the account of such underwriter in stabilizing or short covering transactions.
      Purchases to cover a short position and stabilizing transactions may have the effect of preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of our stock, and together with the imposition of the penalty bid, may stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the market price of the common stock. As a result, the price of

126


Table of Contents

the common stock may be higher than the price that otherwise might exist in the open market. If these activities are commenced, they may be discontinued at any time. These transactions may be effected on the NYSE, the Nasdaq Stock Market, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise.
      Each of the underwriters has represented and agreed that:
        (a) it has not made or will not make an offer of shares to the public in the United Kingdom within the meaning of section 102B of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (as amended) (FSMA) except to legal entities which are authorised or regulated to operate in the financial markets or, if not so authorised or regulated, whose corporate purpose is solely to invest in securities or otherwise in circumstances which do not require the publication by the company of a prospectus pursuant to the Prospectus Rules of the Financial Services Authority (FSA);
 
        (b) it has only communicated or caused to be communicated and will only communicate or cause to be communicated an invitation or inducement to engage in investment activity (within the meaning of section 21 of FSMA) to persons who have professional experience in matters relating to investments falling within Article 19(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Financial Promotion) Order 2005 or in circumstances in which section 21 of FSMA would not, if the company were not an authorised person, apply to the company; and
 
        (c) it has complied with, and will comply with all applicable provisions of FSMA with respect to anything done by it in relation to the shares in, from or otherwise involving the United Kingdom.
      In relation to each Member State of the European Economic Area which has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a Relevant Member State), each Underwriter has represented and agreed that with effect from and including the date on which the Prospectus Directive is implemented in that Relevant Member State (the Relevant Implementation Date) it has not made and will not make an offer of Shares to the public in that Relevant Member State prior to the publication of a prospectus in relation to the Shares which has been approved by the competent authority in that Relevant Member State or, where appropriate, approved in another Relevant Member State and notified to the competent authority in that Relevant Member State, all in accordance with the Prospectus Directive, except that it may, with effect from and including the Relevant Implementation Date, make an offer of Shares to the public in that Relevant Member State at any time:
        (a) to legal entities which are authorised or regulated to operate in the financial markets or, if not so authorised or regulated, whose corporate purpose is solely to invest in securities;
 
        (b) to any legal entity which has two or more of (1) an average of at least 250 employees during the last financial year; (2) a total balance sheet of more than  43,000,000 and (3) an annual net turnover of more than  50,000,000, as shown in its last annual or consolidated accounts; or
 
        (c) in any other circumstances which do not require the publication by the Issuer of a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive.
      For the purposes of this provision, the expression an “offer of Shares to the public” in relation to any Shares in any Relevant Member State means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and the Shares to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe the Shares, as the same may be varied in that Relevant Member State by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that Relevant Member State and the expression Prospectus Directive means Directive 2003/71/EC and includes any relevant implementing measure in each Relevant Member State.
      The shares may not be offered or sold by means of any document other than to persons whose ordinary business is to buy or sell shares or debentures, whether as principal or agent, or in circumstances which do not constitute an offer to the public within the meaning of the Companies Ordinance (Cap. 32) of Hong Kong, and no advertisement, invitation or document relating to the shares may be issued, whether in Hong Kong or elsewhere, which is directed at, or the contents of which are likely to be accessed or read by, the public in Hong Kong (except if permitted to do so under the securities laws of

127


Table of Contents

Hong Kong) other than with respect to shares which are or are intended to be disposed of only to persons outside Hong Kong or only to “professional investors” within the meaning of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571) of Hong Kong and any rules made thereunder.
      This prospectus has not been registered as a prospectus with the Monetary Authority of Singapore. Accordingly, this prospectus and any other document or material in connection with the offer or sale, or invitation or subscription or purchase, of the securities may not be circulated or distributed, nor may the securities be offered or sold, or be made the subject of an invitation for subscription or purchase, whether directly or indirectly, to persons in Singapore other than under circumstances in which such offer, sale or invitation does not constitute an offer or sale, or invitation for subscription or purchase, of the securities to the public in Singapore.
      The securities have not been and will not be registered under the Securities and Exchange Law of Japan (the Securities and Exchange Law) and each underwriter has agreed that it will not offer or sell any securities, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to, or for the benefit of, any resident of Japan (which term as used herein means any person resident in Japan, including any corporation or other entity organized under the laws of Japan), or to others for re-offering or resale, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to a resident of Japan, except pursuant to an exemption from the registration requirements of, and otherwise in compliance with, the Securities and Exchange Law and any other applicable laws, regulations and ministerial guidelines of Japan.
      The underwriters do not expect sales in discretionary accounts to exceed           % of the total number of shares offered.
      We estimate that our share of the total expenses of the offering, excluding underwriting discounts and commissions, will be approximately $          .
      We have agreed to indemnify the several underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.
      Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates have, from time to time, performed, and may in the future perform, various financial advisory and investment banking services for us or our affiliates, for which they have received or will receive customary fees and expenses. In July 2005, Goldman, Sachs & Co. entered into an engagement letter with Clear Channel Communications to assist Clear Channel Communications as financial advisor in the exploration of certain strategic and financial alternatives. In addition, Goldman, Sachs & Co. owns approximately 3% of Clear Channel Communications’ capital stock. In July 2004, Clear Channel Communications and certain of our international subsidiaries entered into a credit agreement with Bank of America, N.A. and J.P. Morgan Chase Bank. Under this agreement, Bank of America, N.A., J.P. Morgan Chase Bank, Barclays Bank Plc, Citibank, N.A., Credit Suisse First Boston, Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., Deutsche Sumitomo Mitsui Banking Corp., UBS Loan Finance LLC, Wachovia Bank, National Association, Harris Nesbitt Financing, Inc., BNP Paribas, Societe Generale, UFJ Bank Limited, Union Bank of California, N.A. and US Bank National Association may extend loans to Clear Channel Communications in an aggregate amount of up to $1.75 billion.

128


Table of Contents

LEGAL MATTERS
      The validity of the issuance of the shares of Class A common stock to be sold in this offering will be passed upon for us by Fulbright & Jaworski L.L.P., San Antonio, Texas. Cravath, Swaine & Moore LLP, New York, New York will act as counsel to the underwriters.
EXPERTS
      The combined financial statements of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. as of December 31, 2004 and 2003 and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2004 appearing in this prospectus and registration statement have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such reports given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.
      With respect to the unaudited combined interim financial information of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. for the nine-month periods ended September 30, 2004 and 2005, included in this prospectus, Ernst & Young LLP reported that they have applied limited procedures in accordance with professional standards for a review of such information. However, their separate report dated October 20, 2005, included herein, states that they did not audit and they do not express an opinion on that interim financial information. Accordingly, the degree of reliance on their report on such information should be restricted in light of the limited nature of the review procedures applied. Ernst & Young LLP is not subject to the liability provisions of Section 11 of the Securities Act of 1933 for their report on the unaudited interim financial information because that report is not a “report” or a “part” of the registration statement prepared or certified by Ernst & Young LLP within the meaning of Sections 7 and 11 of the Securities Act of 1933.
AVAILABLE INFORMATION
      We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form S-1 under the Securities Act with respect to the issuance of shares of our common stock being offered hereby. This prospectus, which forms a part of the registration statement, does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement. For further information with respect to us and the shares of our common stock, reference is made to the registration statement. Statements contained in this prospectus as to the contents of any contract or other document are not necessarily complete. We are not currently subject to the informational requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or Exchange Act. As a result of the offering of the shares of our common stock, we will become subject to the informational requirements of the Exchange Act and, in accordance therewith, will file reports and other information with the SEC. The registration statement, such reports and other information can be inspected and copied at the Public Reference Room of the SEC located at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington D.C. 20549. Copies of such materials, including copies of all or any portion of the registration statement, can be obtained from the Public Reference Room of the SEC at prescribed rates. You can call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 to obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room. Such materials may also be accessed electronically by means of the SEC’s home page on the Internet (http://www.sec.gov).

129


INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
           
    F-2  
Audited Financial Statements:
       
      F-3  
      F-4  
      F-5  
      F-6  
      F-7  
Unaudited Interim Financial Statements:
       
      F-29  
      F-30  
      F-31  
      F-32  
      F-33  
      F-34  
    F-42  
    F-43  
  Form of Specimen Class A Common Stock certificate
  Form of Specimen Class B Common Stock certificate
  Form of Corporate Services Agreement
  Form of Trademark License Agreement
  Letter regarding unaudited interim financial information
  Form of Consent of Auditor
  Consent of Prospective Director of James McPike Raines

F-1


Table of Contents

      The following report is in the form that will be signed upon the completion of the transaction described in Basis of Presentation of Note A to the financial statements.
  /s/ Ernst & Young LLP
San Antonio, Texas
August 9, 2005
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
BOARD OF DIRECTORS
CLEAR CHANNEL COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
      We have audited the accompanying combined balance sheets of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and subsidiaries (the Company) as of December 31, 2004 and 2003, and the related combined statements of operations, changes in owner’s equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2004. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
      We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
      In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the combined financial position of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and subsidiaries at December 31, 2004 and 2003, and the combined results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2004, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
      As discussed in Note B to the combined financial statements, in 2004 the Company changed its method of accounting for indefinite lived intangibles and in 2002 the Company changed its method for accounting for goodwill.
San Antonio, Texas
August 4, 2005, except as to Basis of Presentation of Note A, as to which date is                      , 2005.

F-2


Table of Contents

COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS
                   
    December 31,
     
    2004   2003
         
    (In thousands)
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS
               
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 37,948     $ 34,105  
Accounts receivable, less allowance of $19,487 in 2004 and $15,713 in 2003
    661,244       630,758  
Due from Clear Channel Communications
    302,634       154,446  
Prepaid expenses
    59,601       58,133  
Other current assets
    45,813       81,227  
             
 
Total Current Assets
    1,107,240       958,669  
PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
               
Land, buildings and improvements
    318,478       304,492  
Structures
    3,110,233       2,888,834  
Furniture and other equipment
    238,973       203,998  
Construction in progress
    54,021       68,481  
             
      3,721,705       3,465,805  
Less accumulated depreciation
    1,525,720       1,201,699  
             
      2,195,985       2,264,106  
INTANGIBLE ASSETS
               
Definite-lived intangibles, net
    334,284       384,567  
Indefinite-lived intangibles — permits
    211,690       424,640  
Goodwill
    787,006       700,797  
OTHER ASSETS
               
Notes receivable
    5,872       6,286  
Investments in, and advances to, nonconsolidated affiliates
    175,057       155,646  
Deferred tax asset
    231,056       155,193  
Other assets
    189,513       166,435  
Other investments
    3,230       16,481  
             
 
Total Assets
  $ 5,240,933     $ 5,232,820  
             
LIABILITIES AND OWNER’S EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES
               
Accounts payable
  $ 243,542     $ 274,951  
Accrued expenses
    264,567       226,497  
Accrued interest
    558       220  
Deferred income
    94,120       97,771  
Current portion of long-term debt
    146,268       136,763  
             
 
Total Current Liabilities
    749,055       736,202  
Long-term debt
    30,112       70,254  
Debt with Clear Channel Communications
    1,463,000       1,463,000  
Other long-term liabilities
    205,811       148,560  
Minority interest
    63,302       54,640  
Commitment and contingent liabilities (Note G)
               
OWNER’S EQUITY
               
Owner’s net investment
    6,679,664       6,679,664  
Retained deficit
    (4,250,222 )     (4,094,842 )
Accumulated other comprehensive income
    300,211       175,342  
             
 
Total Owner’s Equity
    2,729,653       2,760,164  
             
 
Total Liabilities and Owner’s Equity
  $ 5,240,933     $ 5,232,820  
             
See Notes to Combined Financial Statements

F-3


Table of Contents

COMBINED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                           
    Year Ended December 31,
     
    2004   2003   2002
             
    (In thousands)
Revenue
  $ 2,447,040     $ 2,174,597     $ 1,859,641  
Operating expenses:
                       
 
Direct operating expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    1,262,317       1,133,386       957,830  
 
Selling, general and administrative expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    499,457       456,893       392,803  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    388,217       379,640       336,895  
 
Corporate expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    53,770       54,233       52,218  
                   
Operating income
    243,279       150,445       119,895  
Interest expense
    14,177       14,201       11,623  
Intercompany interest expense
    145,653       145,648       227,402  
Equity in earnings (loss) of nonconsolidated affiliates
    (76 )     (5,142 )     3,620  
Other income (expense) — net
    (13,341 )     (8,595 )     9,164  
                   
Income (loss) before income taxes and cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    70,032       (23,141 )     (106,346 )
Income tax (expense) benefit:
                       
Current
    (23,422 )     12,092       72,008  
Deferred
    (39,132 )     (23,944 )     (21,370 )
                   
Income (loss) before cumulative effect of change in accounting principle
    7,478       (34,993 )     (55,708 )
Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle, net of tax of, $113,173 in 2004 and $504,927 in 2002
    (162,858 )           (3,527,198 )
                   
Net loss
    (155,380 )     (34,993 )     (3,582,906 )
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:
                       
 
Foreign currency translation adjustments
    124,869       216,214       135,612  
                   
Comprehensive income (loss)
  $ (30,511 )   $ 181,221     $ (3,447,294 )
                   
See Notes to Combined Financial Statements

F-4


Table of Contents

COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN OWNER’S EQUITY
                                 
            Accumulated Other    
    Owner’s Net   Retained   Comprehensive    
    Investment   Deficit   Income   Total
                 
    (In thousands)
Balances at December 31, 2001
  $ 6,066,825     $ (476,943 )   $ (176,484 )   $ 5,413,398  
Net loss
          (3,582,906 )           (3,582,906 )
Net transfers from Clear Channel Communications
    612,839                   612,839  
Currency translation adjustment
                135,612       135,612  
                         
Balances at December 31, 2002
    6,679,664       (4,059,849 )     (40,872 )     2,578,943  
Net loss
          (34,993 )           (34,993 )
Currency translation adjustment
                216,214       216,214  
                         
Balances at December 31, 2003
    6,679,664       (4,094,842 )     175,342       2,760,164  
Net loss
          (155,380 )           (155,380 )
Currency translation adjustment
                124,869       124,869  
                         
Balances at December 31, 2004
  $ 6,679,664     $ (4,250,222 )   $ 300,211     $ 2,729,653  
                         
See Notes to Combined Financial Statements

F-5


Table of Contents

COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                           
    Year Ended December 31,
     
    2004   2003   2002
             
    (In thousands)
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES
                       
Net loss
  $ (155,380 )   $ (34,993 )   $ (3,582,906 )
Reconciling items:
                       
 
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax
    162,858             3,527,198  
 
Depreciation
    321,071       312,692       271,683  
 
Amortization of intangibles
    67,146       66,948       65,212  
 
Deferred taxes
    39,132       23,944       21,370  
 
(Gain) loss on sale of operating and fixed assets
    (11,718 )     (11,047 )     (7,118 )
 
(Gain) loss on sale of other investments
          (81 )      
 
Equity in earnings (loss) of nonconsolidated affiliates
    76       5,142       (3,620 )
 
Increase (decrease) other, net
    5,024       2,888       (16,603 )
Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of effects of acquisitions:
                       
 
Decrease (increase) in accounts receivable
    (21,149 )     (84,197 )     (28,870 )
 
Decrease (increase) in prepaid expenses
    (1,468 )     (5,478 )     4,598  
 
Decrease (increase) in other current assets
    4,262       2,589       11,377  
 
Increase (decrease) in accounts payable, accrued expenses and other liabilities
    51,535       99,583       57,821  
 
Increase (decrease) in accrued interest
    343       (692 )     41  
 
Increase (decrease) in deferred income
    (2,537 )     10,587       17,220  
 
Increase (decrease) in accrued income taxes
    33,300       45,574       (17,168 )
                   
Net cash provided by operating activities
    492,495       433,459       320,235  
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES
                       
Decrease (increase) in notes receivable, net
    414       (202 )     98  
Decrease (increase) in investments in, and advances to nonconsolidated affiliates — net
    (6,986 )     (619 )     (6,068 )
Purchase of other investments
    (961 )            
Proceeds from sale of other investment
    12,076              
Purchases of property, plant and equipment
    (176,140 )     (205,145 )     (290,187 )
Proceeds from disposal of assets
    8,354       48,806       45,991  
Acquisition of operating assets
    (94,878 )     (44,137 )     (154,685 )
Decrease (increase) in other — net
    (52,537 )     (28,865 )     (25,993 )
                   
Net cash used in investing activities
    (310,658 )     (230,162 )     (430,844 )
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
                       
Draws on credit facilities
    71,389       122,032       192,418  
Payments on credit facilities
    (104,945 )     (190,077 )     (175,646 )
Proceeds from issuance of debt with Clear Channel Communications
                154,685  
Net transfers (to) from Clear Channel Communications
    (148,188 )     (154,446 )     1,736  
Payments on long-term debt
    (262 )            
                   
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    (182,006 )     (222,491 )     173,193  
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash
    4,012       7,558       (16,843 )
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
    3,843       (11,636 )     45,741  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
    34,105       45,741        
                   
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
  $ 37,948     $ 34,105     $ 45,741  
                   
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE
                       
 
Cash paid during the year for interest
  $ 175,395     $ 198,296     $ 267,972  
 
Cash paid during the year for taxes
  $ 22,195     $ 18,043     $ 12,996  
See Notes to Combined Financial Statements

F-6


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTE A — SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Basis of Presentation
      Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. (“the Company”) is currently a wholly-owned subsidiary of Clear Channel Communications Inc. (“Clear Channel Communications”), a diversified media company with operations in radio broadcasting, outdoor advertising, and live entertainment. On April 29, 2005, Clear Channel Communications announced a plan to separate its outdoor advertising business into a separate company. As part of the plan, Clear Channel Communications intends on completing an initial public offering (“IPO”) of 10% of the Company’s common stock. Clear Channel Communications and its subsidiaries will contribute and transfer to the Company all of the assets and liabilities of the outdoor advertising businesses not currently held by the Company prior to the completion of the IPO.
Nature of Business
      The Company operates in the outdoor advertising industry by selling advertising on billboards, street furniture and other transit advertising displays. The Company has two principal business segments: domestic and international. The domestic segment includes operations in North and South America; and the international segment includes operations in Europe, Asia, Africa and Australia.
Principles of Combination
      The combined financial statements include assets and liabilities of Clear Channel Communications not currently owned by the Company that will be transferred prior to or concurrent with the IPO transaction. The combined financial statements are comprised of businesses included in the consolidated financial statements and accounting records of Clear Channel Communications using the historical results of operations, and historical basis of assets and liabilities of the outdoor business. Significant intercompany accounts among the combined businesses have been eliminated in consolidation. Investments in nonconsolidated affiliates are accounted for using the equity method of accounting.
Cash and Cash Equivalents
      Cash and cash equivalents include all highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less.
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
      The Company evaluates the collectibility of its accounts receivable based on a combination of factors. In circumstances where it is aware of a specific customer’s inability to meet its financial obligations, it records a specific reserve to reduce the amounts recorded to what it believes will be collected. For all other customers, it recognizes reserves for bad debt based on historical experience of bad debts as a percent of revenues for each business unit, adjusted for relative improvements or deteriorations in the agings and changes in current economic conditions.
Prepaid Expenses
      Most of the Company’s prepaid expenses relate to lease payments on advertising structures that are located on leased land. Domestic land rents are typically paid in advance for periods ranging from one to twelve months. International land rents are paid both in advance and in arrears, for periods ranging from one to twelve months. Most international street furniture advertising display faces are licensed through municipalities for up to 20 years. The street furniture licenses often include a percent of revenue to be paid along with a base rent payment. Prepaid land leases are recorded as an asset and expensed ratably over the related rental term and license and rent payments in arrears are recorded as an accrued liability.

F-7


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Purchase Accounting
      The Company accounts for its business acquisitions under the purchase method of accounting. The total cost of acquisitions is allocated to the underlying identifiable net assets, including any related indefinite-lived permit intangible assets, based on their respective estimated fair values. The excess of the purchase price over the estimated fair values of the net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. Determining the fair value of assets acquired and liabilities assumed requires management’s judgment and often involves the use of significant estimates and assumptions, including assumptions with respect to future cash inflows and outflows, discount rates, asset lives and market multiples, among other items. In addition, reserves have been established on the Company’s balance sheet related to acquired liabilities and qualifying restructuring costs and contingencies based on assumptions made at the time of acquisition. The Company evaluates these reserves on a regular basis to determine the adequacies of the amounts.
Asset Retirement Obligation
      On January 1, 2003, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 143, Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations. The Company’s asset retirement obligation is reported in “Other long-term liabilities” and relates primarily to the Company’s obligation upon the termination or non-renewal of a lease to dismantle and remove its advertising structures from the leased land and to reclaim the site to its original condition. The Company records the present value of obligations associated with the retirement of its advertising structures in the period in which the obligation is incurred. The liability is capitalized as part of the related advertising structures carrying amount. Over time, accretion of the liability is recognized as an operating expense and the capitalized cost is depreciated over the expected useful life of the related asset.
Property, Plant and Equipment
      Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost. Depreciation is computed using the straight-line method at rates that, in the opinion of management, are adequate to allocate the cost of such assets over their estimated useful lives, which are as follows:
  Buildings and improvements — 10 to 39 years
  Structures — 5 to 40 years
  Furniture and other equipment — 3 to 20 years
  Leasehold improvements — shorter of economic life or lease term assuming renewal periods, if appropriate
      For assets associated with a lease or contract, the assets are depreciated at the shorter of the economic life or the lease or contract term, assuming renewal periods, if appropriate. Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are charged to operations as incurred, whereas expenditures for renewal and betterments are capitalized.
      The Company tests for possible impairment of property, plant, and equipment whenever events or changes in circumstances, such as a reduction in operating cash flow or a dramatic change in the manner that the asset is intended to be used indicate that the carrying amount of the asset may not be recoverable. If indicators exist, the Company compares the estimated undiscounted future cash flows related to the asset to the carrying value of the asset. If the carrying value is greater than the estimated undiscounted future cash flow amount, an impairment charge is recorded in depreciation and amortization expense in the statement of operations for amounts necessary to reduce the carrying value of the asset to fair value. The impairment loss calculations require management to apply judgment in estimating future cash flows and the discount rates that reflects the risk inherent in future cash flows.

F-8


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Intangible Assets
      The Company classifies intangible assets as definite-lived or indefinite-lived intangible assets, as well as goodwill. Definite-lived intangibles include primarily transit and street furniture contracts, which are amortized over the respective lives of the agreements, typically five to fifteen years. The Company periodically reviews the appropriateness of the amortization periods related to its definite-lived assets. These assets are stated at cost. Indefinite-lived intangibles include billboard permits. The excess cost over fair value of net assets acquired is classified as goodwill. The indefinite-lived intangibles and goodwill are not subject to amortization, but are tested for impairment at least annually.
      The Company tests for possible impairment of definite-lived intangible assets whenever events or changes in circumstances, such as a reduction in operating cash flow or a dramatic change in the manner that the asset is intended to be used indicate that the carrying amount of the asset may not be recoverable. If indicators exist, the Company compares the estimated undiscounted future cash flows related to the asset to the carrying value of the asset. If the carrying value is greater than the estimated undiscounted future cash flow amount, an impairment charge is recorded in depreciation and amortization expense in the statement of operations for amounts necessary to reduce the carrying value of the asset to fair value.
      The Company performed its 2004 annual impairment test for its permits using a direct valuation technique as prescribed by the Emerging Issues Task Force (“EITF”) Topic D-108, Use of the Residual Method to Value Acquired Assets Other Than Goodwill (“D-108”), which the Company adopted in the fourth quarter of 2004. Certain assumptions are used under the Company’s direct valuation technique, including market penetration leading to revenue potential, profit margin, duration and profile of the build-up period, estimated start-up cost and losses incurred during the build-up period, the risk adjusted discount rate and terminal values. The Company considered fair values derived by a third-party valuation firm to assist it in performing its impairment test. Impairment charges, other than the charge taken under the transitional rules of Financial Accounting Standards No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets (“Statement 142”) and D-108, are recorded in depreciation and amortization expense on the statement of operations.
      At least annually, the Company performs its impairment test for each reporting unit’s goodwill using a discounted cash flow model to determine if the carrying value of the reporting unit, including goodwill, is less than the fair value of the reporting unit. Certain assumptions are used in determining the fair value, including assumptions about cash flow rates, discount rates, and terminal values. If the fair value of the Company’s reporting unit is less than the carrying value of the reporting unit, the Company reduces the carrying amount of goodwill. Impairment charges, other than the charge taken under the transitional rules of Statement 142 are recorded in amortization expense on the statement of operations.
Nonconsolidated Affiliates
      In general, investments in which the Company owns 20 percent to 50 percent of the common stock or otherwise exercises significant influence over the company are accounted for under the equity method. The Company does not recognize gains or losses upon the issuance of securities by any of its equity method investees. The Company reviews the value of equity method investments and records impairment charges in the statement of operations for any decline in value that is determined to be other-than-temporary.
Financial Instruments
      Due to their short maturity, the carrying amounts of accounts and notes receivable, accounts payable, accrued liabilities and short-term borrowings approximated their fair values at December 31, 2004 and 2003. Additionally, as none of the Company’s debt is publicly traded, the carrying amounts of long-term debt approximated their fair value at December 31, 2004 and 2003.

F-9


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Income Taxes
      The Company accounts for income taxes using the liability method. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on differences between financial reporting bases and tax bases of assets and liabilities and are measured using the enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the periods in which the deferred tax asset or liability is expected to be realized or settled. Deferred tax assets are reduced by valuation allowances if the Company believes it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the asset will not be realized. As all earnings from the Company’s foreign operations are permanently reinvested and not distributed, the Company’s income tax provision does not include additional U.S. taxes on foreign operations. It is not practical to determine the amount of federal income taxes, if any, that might become due in the event that the earnings were distributed.
      The operations of the Company are included in a consolidated federal income tax return filed by Clear Channel Communications, Inc. However, for financial reporting purposes, the Company’s provision for income taxes has been computed on the basis that the Company files separate consolidated income tax returns with its subsidiaries.
Revenue Recognition
      The Company provides services under the terms of contracts covering periods up to three years, which are generally billed monthly. Revenue for advertising space rental is recognized ratably over the term of the contract. Advertising revenue is reported net of agency commissions. Agency commissions are calculated based on a stated percentage applied to gross billing revenue for the Company’s operations. Clients remit the gross billing amount to the agency and the agency remits gross billings less their commission to the Company. Payments received in advance of being earned are recorded as deferred income.
      The Company believes that the credit risk with respect to trade receivables is limited due to the large number and the geographic diversification of its customers.
Foreign Currency
      Results of operations for foreign subsidiaries and foreign equity investees are translated into U.S. dollars using the average exchange rates during the year. The assets and liabilities of those subsidiaries and investees, other than those of operations in highly inflationary countries, are translated into U.S. dollars using the exchange rates at the balance sheet date. The related translation adjustments are recorded in a separate component of owner’s equity, “Accumulated other comprehensive income.” Foreign currency transaction gains and losses, as well as gains and losses from translation of financial statements of subsidiaries and investees in highly inflationary countries, are included in operations.
Use of Estimates
      The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates, judgments, and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes including, but not limited to, legal, tax and insurance accruals. The Company bases its estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
New Accounting Pronouncements
      The Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) staff issued D-108 at the September 2004 meeting of the EITF. D-108 states that the residual method should no longer be used to value intangible assets other than goodwill. Rather, a direct method should be used to determine the fair value of all intangible assets required to be recognized under Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 141,

F-10


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Business Combinations. Registrants who have applied the residual method to the valuation of intangible assets for purposes of impairment testing under Statement 142 shall perform an impairment test using a direct value method on all intangible assets that were previously valued using the residual method by no later than the beginning of their first fiscal year beginning after December 15, 2004. The Company adopted D-108 for its fiscal year ended December 31, 2004. As a result of adoption, the Company recorded a non-cash charge of $162.9 million, net of deferred taxes of $113.2 million, as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle during the fourth quarter of 2004. See Note B for more disclosure.
      In December 2004, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Financial Accounting Standard No. 153, Exchanges of Nonmonetary Assets, an amendment of APB Opinion No. 29 (“Statement 153”). Statement 153 eliminates the APB 29 exception for nonmonetary exchanges of similar productive assets and replaces it with an exception for exchanges of nonmonetary assets that do not have commercial substance. Statement 153 is effective for financial statements for fiscal years beginning after June 15, 2005. Earlier application is permitted for nonmonetary asset exchanges occurring in fiscal periods beginning after the date of issuance. The provisions of Statement 153 should be applied prospectively. The Company expects to adopt Statement 153 for its fiscal year beginning January 1, 2006 and management does not believe that adoption will materially impact the Company’s financial position or results of operations.
      In December 2004, the FASB issued Staff Position 109-2 , Accounting and Disclosure Guidance for the Foreign Repatriation Provision within the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004 (“FSP 109-2”). FSP 109-2 allows an enterprise additional time beyond the financial reporting period in which the Act was enacted to evaluate the effects of the Act on its plans for repatriation of unremitted earnings for purposes of applying Financial Accounting Standard No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes, (“Statement 109”). FSP 109-2 clarifies that an enterprise is required to apply the provisions of Statement 109 in the period, or periods, it decides on its plan(s) for reinvestment or repatriation of its unremitted foreign earnings. FSP 109-2 requires disclosure if an enterprise is unable to reasonably estimate, at the time of issuance of its financial statements, the related range of income tax effects for the potential range of foreign earnings that it may repatriate and requires an enterprise to recognize income tax expense (benefit) if an enterprise decides to repatriate a portion of unremitted earnings under the repatriation provision while it is continuing to evaluate the effects of the repatriation provision for the remaining portion of the unremitted foreign earnings. FSP 109-2 is effective upon issuance. The Company currently has the ability and intent to reinvest any undistributed earnings of its foreign subsidiaries. Any impact from this legislation has not been reflected in the amounts shown since the Company is reinvested for the foreseeable future.
      On December 16, 2004, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 (revised 2004), Share-Based Payment, (“Statement 123(R)”) which is a revision of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation (“Statement 123”). Statement 123(R) supersedes Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees (“APB 25”), and amends Statement No. 95, Statement of Cash Flows. Generally, the approach in Statement 123(R) is similar to the approach described in Statement 123. However, Statement 123(R) requires all share-based payments to employees, including grants of employee stock options, to be recognized in the income statement based on their fair values. Pro forma disclosure is no longer an alternative. Statement 123(R) is effective for financial statements for the first interim or annual period beginning after June 15, 2005. Early adoption is permitted in periods in which financial statements have not yet been issued. In April 2005, the SEC issued a press release announcing that it would provide for phased-in implementation guidance for Statement 123(R). The SEC would require that registrants that are not small business issuers adopt Statement 123(R)’s fair value method of accounting for share-based payments to employees no later than the beginning of the first fiscal year beginning after June 15, 2005. The Company intends to adopt Statement 123(R) on January 1, 2006.

F-11


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
      As permitted by Statement 123, the Company currently accounts for share-based payments to employees using the APB 25 intrinsic value method and, as such, generally recognizes no compensation cost for employee stock options. Accordingly, the adoption of Statement 123(R)’s fair value method could have a significant impact on the Company’s result of operations, although it will have no impact on its overall financial position. The Company is unable to quantify the impact of adoption of Statement 123(R) at this time because it will depend on levels of share-based payments granted in the future. However, had the Company adopted Statement 123(R) in prior periods, the impact of that standard would have approximated the impact of Statement 123 as described in the disclosure of pro forma net income and earnings per share below. Statement 123(R) also requires the benefits of tax deductions in excess of recognized compensation cost to be reported as a financing cash flow. This requirement will increase net financing cash flows in periods after adoption. The Company cannot estimate what those amounts will be in the future because they depend on, among other things, when employees exercise stock options.
Stock Based Compensation
      The Company does not have any compensation plans under which it grants stock awards to employees. On behalf of the Company, Clear Channel Communications grants the Company’s officers and other key employees stock options to purchase shares of Clear Channel Communications common stock. Clear Channel Communications accounts for its stock-based award plans in accordance with APB 25, and related interpretations, under which compensation expense is recorded to the extent that the current market price of the underlying stock exceeds the exercise price. Clear Channel Communications calculates the pro forma stock compensation expense as if the stock-based awards had been accounted for using the provisions of Statement 123. The stock compensation expense is then allocated to the Company based on the percentage of options outstanding to employees of the Company. The required pro forma disclosures, based on this allocated expense are as follows:
                           
    2004   2003   2002
             
    (In thousands)
Income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle:
                       
 
Reported
  $ 7,478     $ (34,993 )   $ (55,708 )
 
Pro forma stock compensation expense, net of tax
    (6,474 )     (3,701 )     (4,447 )
                   
 
Pro Forma
  $ 1,004     $ (38,694 )   $ (60,155 )
                   

F-12


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
NOTE B — INTANGIBLE ASSETS AND GOODWILL
Definite-lived Intangibles
      The Company has definite-lived intangible assets which consist primarily of transit and street furniture contracts and other contractual rights, all of which are amortized over the respective lives of the agreements. Other definite-lived intangible assets are amortized over the period of time the assets are expected to contribute directly or indirectly to the Company’s future cash flows. The following table presents the gross carrying amount and accumulated amortization for each major class of definite-lived intangible assets at December 31, 2004 and 2003:
                                   
    2004   2003
         
    Gross Carrying   Accumulated   Gross Carrying   Accumulated
    Amount   Amortization   Amount   Amortization
                 
    (In thousands)
Transit, street furniture, and other contractual rights
  $ 688,373     $ 364,939     $ 655,775     $ 289,821  
Other
    57,093       46,243       56,301       37,688  
                         
 
Total
  $ 745,466     $ 411,182     $ 712,076     $ 327,509  
                         
      Total amortization expense from definite-lived intangible assets for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002 was $67.1 million, $66.9 million and $65.2 million, respectively. The following table presents the Company’s estimate of amortization expense for each of the five succeeding fiscal years for definite-lived intangible assets that exist at December 31, 2004:
         
    (In thousands)
2005
  $ 83,251  
2006
    73,072  
2007
    47,875  
2008
    20,049  
2009
    17,502  
      As acquisitions and dispositions occur in the future and as purchase price allocations are finalized, amortization expense may vary.
Indefinite-lived Intangibles
      On January 1, 2002, the Company adopted Statement 142, which addresses financial accounting and reporting for acquired goodwill and other intangible assets and supersedes APB Opinion No. 17, Intangible Assets. Statement 142 established new accounting for goodwill and other intangible assets recorded in business combinations. The Company performed the initial impairment test of its billboard permits at January 1, 2002 and subsequent impairment tests were performed at October 1, 2002, 2003 and 2004, all of which resulted in no impairment charge.
      Upon the adoption of Statement 142 on January 1, 2002, the Company began to separately identify billboard permits as an indefinite-lived intangible asset. The Company’s billboard permits are issued in perpetuity by state and local governments and are transferable or renewable at little or no cost. Permits typically include the location for which the permit allows the Company the right to operate an advertising structure. The Company’s permits are located on either owned or leased land. In cases where the Company’s permits are located on leased land, the leases are typically from 10 to 30 years and renew indefinitely, with rental payments generally escalating at an inflation based index. If the Company loses its lease, the Company will typically obtain permission to relocate the permit or bank it with the municipality for future use.

F-13


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
      The Company does not amortize its billboard permits. The Company tests these indefinite-lived intangible assets for impairment at least annually. The carrying amount for billboard permits at December 31, 2004 and 2003 were $211.7 million and $424.6 million, respectively.
      The SEC staff issued D-108 at the September 2004 meeting of the EITF. D-108 states that the residual method should no longer be used to value intangible assets other than goodwill. Rather, D-108 requires that a direct method be used to value intangible assets other than goodwill. Prior to adoption of D-108, the Company recorded its acquisition at fair value using an industry accepted income approach. The value calculated using the income approach was allocated to the indefinite-lived intangibles after deducting the value of tangible and intangible assets, as well as estimated costs of establishing a business at the market level. The Company used a similar approach in its annual impairment test prior to its adoption of D-108.
      D-108 requires that an impairment test be performed upon adoption using a direct method for valuing intangible assets other than goodwill. Under the direct method, it is assumed that rather than acquiring indefinite-lived intangible assets as a part of a going concern business, the buyer hypothetically obtains indefinite-lived intangible assets and builds a new operation with similar attributes from scratch. Thus, the buyer incurs start-up costs during the build-up phase which are normally associated with going concern value. Initial capital costs are deducted from the discounted cash flows model, which results in value that is directly attributable to the indefinite-lived intangible assets.
      Under the direct method, the Company continues to aggregate its indefinite-lived intangible assets at the market level for purposes of impairment testing as prescribed by EITF 02-07 Unit of Accounting for Testing Impairment of Indefinite-Lived Intangible Assets. The Company’s key assumptions using the direct method are market revenue growth rates, market share, profit margin, duration and profile of the build-up period, estimated start-up capital costs and losses incurred during the build-up period, the risk-adjusted discount rate and terminal values. This data is populated using industry normalized information representing an average station within a market.
      The Company’s adoption of the direct method resulted in an aggregate fair value of its indefinite-lived intangible assets that were less than the carrying value determined under its prior method. As a result of the adoption of D-108, the Company recorded a non-cash charge of $162.9 million, net of deferred taxes of $113.2 million as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle during the fourth quarter of 2004.

F-14


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Goodwill
      The Company tests goodwill for impairment using a two-step process. The first step, used to screen for potential impairment, compares the fair value of the reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. The second step, used to measure the amount of the impairment loss, compares the implied fair value of the reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. The following table presents the changes in the carrying amount of goodwill in each of the Company’s reportable segments for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003:
                           
    Domestic   International   Total
             
    (In thousands)
Balance as of December 31, 2002
  $ 346,837     $ 294,129     $ 640,966  
 
Acquisitions
    2,371       13,611       15,982  
 
Dispositions
    (894 )           (894 )
 
Foreign currency translation
          48,392       48,392  
 
Adjustments
    (2,978 )     (671 )     (3,649 )
                   
Balance as of December 31, 2003
    345,336       355,461       700,797  
 
Acquisitions
    53,719       3,066       56,785  
 
Foreign currency translation
          29,401       29,401  
 
Adjustments
    (1,678 )     1,701       23  
                   
Balance as of December 31, 2004
  $ 397,377     $ 389,629     $ 787,006  
                   
      Upon adopting Statement 142, the Company completed the two-step impairment test during the first quarter of 2002. As a result of this test, the Company recognized impairment of approximately $3.5 billion, net of deferred taxes of $504.9 million related to tax deductible goodwill, as a component of the cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle during the first quarter of 2002.
NOTE C — BUSINESS ACQUISITIONS
2004 Acquisitions:
Medallion Merger
      In September 2004, the Company acquired Medallion Taxi Media, Inc. (“Medallion”) for $31.6 million. Medallion’s operations include advertising displays placed on the top of taxi cabs. The Company began consolidating the results of operations in September 2004.
      In addition to the above, during 2004 the Company acquired display faces for $60.8 million in cash and acquired equity interests in international outdoor companies for $2.5 million in cash. Also, the Company exchanged advertising assets, valued at $23.7 million for other advertising assets valued at $32.3 million. As a result of this exchange, the Company recorded a gain of $8.6 million in “Other income (expense) — net.”
2003 Acquisitions:
      During 2003 the Company acquired domestic display faces for $28.3 million in cash. The Company also acquired investments in nonconsolidated affiliates for $10.7 million in cash and acquired an additional 10% interest in a subsidiary for $5.1 million in cash.

F-15


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
2002 Acquisitions:
Ackerley Merger
      In June 2002 the Company acquired The Ackerley Group, Inc. (“Ackerley”). Ackerley operated approximately 6,000 outdoor displays in the Boston, Seattle and Portland, Oregon metropolitan markets, which are now operated by the Company. The transaction was funded by $26.3 million of the Company’s operating cash and a non-cash capital contribution from Clear Channel Communications of $612.8 million. This transaction resulted in the recognition of approximately $358.8 million of goodwill, $42.8 million of which was tax deductible.
      The results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2002 include the operations of Ackerley from June 2002. Unaudited pro forma combined results of operations, assuming the Ackerley acquisition had occurred on January 1, 2002 would have been as follows:
         
    (In thousands)
Revenue
  $ 1,887,051  
Income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
  $ (38,871 )
Net loss
  $ (3,566,069 )
      The pro forma information above is presented in response to applicable accounting rules relating to business acquisitions and is not necessarily indicative of the actual results that would have been achieved had the merger occurred at the beginning of 2002, nor is it indicative of future results of operations.
Other
      In addition to the acquisition discussed above, during 2002 the Company acquired domestic display faces for $126.3 million in cash and acquired investments in nonconsolidated affiliates for $2.1 million in cash.
Acquisition Summary
      The following is a summary of the assets and liabilities acquired and the consideration given for all acquisitions made during 2004 and 2003:
                 
    2004   2003
         
    (In thousands)
Accounts receivable
  $     $ 210  
Property, plant and equipment
    15,061       10,945  
Permits
    36,956       19,499  
Goodwill
    45,762       7,795  
Investments
    2,512       11,993  
             
      100,291       50,442  
Other liabilities
    (3,058 )     (6,354 )
Deferred tax
    (2,355 )     49  
             
      (5,413 )     (6,305 )
             
Cash paid for acquisitions
  $ 94,878     $ 44,137  
             
      The Company has entered into certain agreements relating to acquisitions that provide for purchase price adjustments and other future contingent payments based on the financial performance of the acquired company. The Company will continue to accrue additional amounts related to such contingent payments if and when it is determinable that the applicable financial performance targets will be met. The

F-16


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
aggregate of these contingent payments, if performance targets were met, would not significantly impact the Company’s financial position or results of operations.
Restructuring :
      As a result of the Company’s acquisition of Ackerley in June 2002, the Company recorded a $9.4 million accrual related to the restructuring of Ackerley’s operations. Of the $9.4 million, $5.3 million is related to severance and $4.1 million is related to lease terminations. The Ackerley corporate office closed in July 2002. At December 31, 2004, the accrual balance for this restructuring was $1.9 million. This restructuring has resulted in the actual termination of 19 employees. The Company recorded a liability in purchase accounting for Ackerley primarily related to severance for terminated employees and lease terminations as follows:
                           
    2004   2003   2002
             
    (In thousands)
Severance and lease termination costs:
                       
 
Accrual at January 1
  $ 2,661     $ 8,940     $  
 
Estimated costs charged to restructuring accrual in purchase accounting
                9,375  
 
Adjustments to restructuring accrual
    (377 )     (5,265 )      
 
Payments charged against restructuring accrual
    (357 )     (1,014 )     (435 )
                   
Remaining severance and lease termination accrual at December 31
  $ 1,927     $ 2,661     $ 8,940  
                   
      The remaining restructuring accrual is comprised solely of lease termination, which will be paid over the next five years. During 2004, there were no payments charged to the restructuring reserve related to severance. The Company made adjustments to finalize the purchase price allocation for the Ackerley merger in 2003.
      In addition to the restructuring described above, the Company restructured its operations in Spain during the fourth quarter of 2004. As a result, the Company has recorded a $4.1 million accrual in selling, general and administrative expenses. Of the $4.1 million, $2.2 million was related to severance and $1.9 million was related to consulting and other costs. As of December 31, 2004, this accrual balance remained $4.1 million. It is expected that this accrual will be paid over the next year. This restructuring will result in the termination of 44 employees.
      During 2003, the Company restructured its operations in France resulting in a $13.8 million restructuring accrual being recorded in selling, general and administrative expenses. Of the $13.8 million, $12.5 million was related to severance and $1.3 million was related to lease terminations and consulting costs. As of December 31, 2004, this accrual balance was $.8 million. It is expected that this accrual will be paid during 2005. This restructuring resulted in the termination of 134 employees.
NOTE D — INVESTMENTS
      The Company’s most significant investments in nonconsolidated affiliates are listed below:
Clear Media
      At December 31, 2004, the Company owned 48.1% of the total number of shares of Hainan White Horse Advertising Media Investment Co. Ltd. (“Clear Media”), formerly known as White Horse, a Chinese company that operates street furniture displays throughout China. At December 31, 2004, the fair market value of the Company’s shares of Clear Media was $231.3 million.

F-17


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Clear Channel Independent
      The Company owns a 50% interest in Clear Channel Independent (“CCI”), formerly known as Corp Comm, a South African company involved in outdoor advertising.
Alessi
      The Company owns a 35% interest in Alessi, an Italian company involved in outdoor advertising.
Summarized Financial Information
      The following table summarizes the Company’s investments in these nonconsolidated affiliates:
                                         
    Clear           All    
    Media   CCI   Alessi   Others   Total
                     
    (In thousands)
At December 31, 2003
  $ 77,257     $ 29,557     $ 22,977     $ 25,855     $ 155,646  
Acquisition (disposition) of investments
          1,456       520       (298 )     1,678  
Transfers from cost investments and other reclasses
                      852       852  
Additional investment, net
          7,508             (522 )     6,986  
Equity in net earnings (loss)
    (3,990 )     5,475       707       (2,268 )     (76 )
Foreign currency translation adjustment
    (33 )     7,372       1,894       738       9,971  
                               
At December 31, 2004
  $ 73,234     $ 51,368     $ 26,098     $ 24,357     $ 175,057  
                               
      The above investments are not consolidated, but are accounted for under the equity method of accounting, whereby the Company records its investments in these entities in the balance sheet as “Investments in, and advances to, nonconsolidated affiliates.” The Company’s interests in their operations are recorded in the statement of operations as “Equity in earnings (loss) of nonconsolidated affiliates.” Accumulated undistributed earnings included in retained deficit for these investments were $5.5 million, $5.4 million and $.3 million for December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively.
Other Investments
      Cost and fair value of other investments at December 31, 2004 and 2003 was $3.2 million and $16.5 million, respectively. At December 31, 2004, these marketable securities were all classified as other cost investments. At December 31, 2003, $11.9 million of these marketable securities were classified as trading and the remaining $4.6 million was classified as other cost investments.
NOTE E — ASSET RETIREMENT OBLIGATION
      The Company has an asset retirement obligation of $49.2 million as of December 31, 2004, which is reported in “Other long-term liabilities.” The liability relates to the Company’s obligation to dismantle and remove its advertising displays from leased land and to reclaim the site to its original condition upon the termination or non-renewal of a lease. The liability is capitalized as part of the related long-lived assets’ carrying value. Due to the high rate of lease renewals over a long period of time, the calculation assumes that all related assets will be removed at some period over the next 50 years. An estimate of third-party cost information is used with respect to the dismantling of the structures and the reclamation of the site. The interest rate used to calculate the present value of such costs over the retirement period is based on an estimated risk adjusted credit rate for the same period. During 2004, the Company increased its liability due to a change in estimate associated with the remediation costs used in the calculation. This change was recorded as an addition to the liability and related assets’ carrying values.

F-18


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
      The following table presents the activity related to the Company’s asset retirement obligation:
           
    (In thousands)
Balance at December 31, 2003
  $ 24,000  
 
Adjustment due to change in estimate of related costs
    26,850  
 
Accretion of liability
    1,800  
 
Liabilities settled
    (3,434 )
       
Balance at December 31, 2004
  $ 49,216  
       
NOTE F — LONG-TERM DEBT
      Long-term debt at December 31, 2004 and 2003 consisted of the following:
                 
    December 31,
     
    2004   2003
         
    (In thousands)
Debt with Clear Channel Communications
  $ 1,463,000     $ 1,463,000  
Bank credit facilities
    23,938       50,119  
Other long-term debt
    152,442       156,898  
             
      1,639,380       1,670,017  
Less: current portion
    146,268       136,763  
             
Total long-term debt
  $ 1,493,112     $ 1,533,254  
             
Debt with Clear Channel Communications
      In 2002, the Company converted its $1.3 billion line of credit with Clear Channel Communications and issued two intercompany notes to Clear Channel Communications in the aggregate original principal amount of approximately $1.5 billion. The Company received $.2 million in excess proceeds that were used to acquire operating assets. The first intercompany note in the original principal amount of approximately $1.4 billion matures on December 31, 2017 and may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 10%. The second intercompany note in the original principal amount of approximately $73.0 million matures on December 31, 2017 and may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 9%. Prior to the issuance of the two intercompany notes, the Company recorded interest at a per annum rate of 6% on all net borrowings from Clear Channel Communications.
Bank Credit Facility
      An international subsidiary of the Company had a $150.0 million five-year revolving credit facility with a group of international banks. This facility allowed for borrowings in various foreign currencies, which were used to hedge net assets in those currencies and provide funds to the Company’s international operations for certain working capital needs. At December 31, 2003, $50.1 million was outstanding. On July 30, 2004, the Company paid in full this $150.0 million five-year revolving credit facility. The $150.0 million five-year revolving credit facility was then terminated on August 6, 2004.
      On July 13, 2004, Clear Channel Communications, entered into a five-year, multi-currency revolving credit facility in the amount of $1.75 billion. Certain of the Company’s international subsidiaries are offshore borrowers under a $150.0 million sub-limit within this $1.75 billion credit facility. This sub-limit allows for borrowings in various foreign currencies, which are used to hedge net assets in those currencies and provide funds to the Company’s international operations for certain working capital needs. Certain of the Company’s international subsidiary borrowings under this sub-limit are guaranteed by Clear Channel

F-19


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Communications. The interest rate is based upon, LIBOR, or, in the case of Euro, EURIBOR, plus a margin. At December 31, 2004, interest rates on this bank credit facility varied from 1.9% to 5.76%. At December 31, 2004, the outstanding balance on the $150.0 million sub-limit was $23.9 million and $126.1 million was available for future borrowings, with the entire balance to be repaid on July 12, 2009.
Debt Covenants
      Clear Channel Communications’ significant covenants on its $1.75 billion five-year, multi-currency revolving credit facility relate to leverage and interest coverage contained and defined in the credit facility. The leverage ratio covenant requires Clear Channel Communications to maintain a ratio of consolidated funded indebtedness to operating cash flow (as defined by the credit facility) of less than 5.25x. The interest coverage covenant requires Clear Channel Communications to maintain a minimum ratio of operating cash flow (as defined by the credit facility) to interest expense of 2.50x. In the event that Clear Channel Communications does not meet these covenants, it is considered to be in default on the credit facility at which time the credit facility, including the $150.0 sub-limit utilized by certain of the Company’s international subsidiaries, may become immediately due. At December 31 2004, Clear Channel Communications’ leverage and interest coverage ratios were 3.1x and 6.4x, respectively. This credit facility contains a cross default provision that would be triggered if Clear Channel Communications were to default on any other indebtedness greater than $200.0 million. At December 31, 2004, Clear Channel Communications was in compliance with all debt covenants.
Other Debt
      Other debt includes various borrowings and capital leases utilized for general operating purposes. Included in the $152.4 million and $156.9 million balances at December 31, 2004 and 2003, is $146.3 million and $136.8 million, respectively, that mature in less than one year.
      Future maturities of long-term debt at December 31, 2004 are as follows:
         
    (In thousands)
2005
  $ 146,268  
2006
    3,728  
2007
    841  
2008
    660  
2009
    24,110  
Thereafter
    1,463,773  
       
Total
  $ 1,639,380  
       
NOTE G — COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
      The Company leases office space, equipment and the majority of the land occupied by its advertising structures under long-term operating leases. Some of the lease agreements contain renewal options and annual rental escalation clauses (generally tied to the consumer price index), as well as provisions for the payment of utilities and maintenance by the Company.
      The Company has minimum franchise payments associated with non-cancelable contracts that enable it to display advertising on such media as buses, taxis, trains, bus shelters and terminals, as well as other type contacts. The majority of these contracts contain rent provisions that are calculated as the greater of a percentage of the relevant advertising revenue or a specified guaranteed minimum annual payment. In addition, the Company has commitments relating to required purchases of property, plant, and equipment under certain street furniture contracts.

F-20


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
      As of December 31, 2004, the Company’s future minimum rental commitments under non-cancelable operating lease agreements with terms in excess of one year, minimum payments under non-cancelable contracts in excess of one year, and capital expenditure commitments consist of the following:
                         
    Non-Cancelable   Non-Cancelable   Capital
    Operating Leases   Contracts   Expenditures
             
    (In thousands)
2005
  $ 177,567     $ 382,528     $ 119,687  
2006
    157,150       281,051       44,186  
2007
    133,677       191,959       18,879  
2008
    117,503       149,640       18,876  
2009
    100,524       133,945       6,346  
Thereafter
    567,593       528,429       15,742  
                   
Total
  $ 1,254,014     $ 1,667,552     $ 223,716  
                   
      Rent expense charged to operations for 2004, 2003 and 2002 was $822.8 million, $721.5 million and $610.4 million, respectively.
      The Company is currently involved in certain legal proceedings and, as required, has accrued its estimate of the probable costs for the resolution of these claims. These estimates have been developed in consultation with counsel and are based upon an analysis of potential results, assuming a combination of litigation and settlement strategies. It is possible, however, that future results of operations for any particular period could be materially affected by changes in the Company’s assumptions or the effectiveness of its strategies related to these proceedings.
      In various areas in which the Company operates, outdoor advertising is the object of restrictive and, in some cases, prohibitive zoning and other regulatory provisions, either enacted or proposed. The impact to the Company of loss of displays due to governmental action has been somewhat mitigated by federal and state laws mandating compensation for such loss and constitutional restraints.
      Various acquisition agreements include deferred consideration payments including future contingent payments based on the financial performance of the acquired companies, generally over a one to five year period. Contingent payments involving the financial performance of the acquired companies are typically based on the acquired company meeting certain EBITDA targets as defined in the agreement. The contingent payment amounts are generally calculated based on predetermined multiples of the achieved EBITDA not to exceed a predetermined maximum payment. At December 31, 2004, the Company believes its maximum aggregate contingency, which is subject to the financial performance of the acquired companies, is approximately $36.5 million. In addition, certain acquisition agreements include deferred consideration payments based on performance requirements by the seller, generally over a one to five year period. Contingent payments based on performance requirements by the seller typically involve the completion of a development or obtaining appropriate permits that enable the Company to construct additional advertising displays. At December 31, 2004, the Company believes its maximum aggregate contingency, which is subject to performance requirements by the seller, is approximately $36.7 million. As the contingencies have not been met or resolved as of December 31, 2004, these amounts are not recorded. If future payments are made, amounts will be recorded as additional purchase price.
      The Company has various investments in nonconsolidated affiliates that are subject to agreements that contain provisions that may result in future additional investments to be made by the Company. The put values are contingent upon financial performance of the investee and are typically based on the investee meeting certain EBITDA targets, as defined in the agreement. The contingent payment amounts are generally calculated based on predetermined multiples of the achieved EBITDA not to exceed a predetermined maximum amount.

F-21


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
NOTE H — RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
      The Company has an account that represents net amounts due to or from Clear Channel Communications, which is recorded as “Due from Clear Channel Communications” on the combined balance sheets. The account does not accrue interest and is generally payable on demand. Included in the account is the net activity resulting from day-to-day cash management services provided by Clear Channel Communications. As a part of these services, the Company maintains collection bank accounts that are swept daily by Clear Channel Communications. In return, Clear Channel Communications funds the Company’s controlled disbursement accounts as checks or electronic payments are presented for payment. At December 31, 2004 and 2003, the balance in “Due from Clear Channel Communications” was $302.6 million and $154.4 million, respectively.
      The Company has issued two intercompany notes to Clear Channel Communications in the aggregate original principal amount of approximately $1.5 billion. These notes are further disclosed in Note F.
      Clear Channel Communications has provided funding for certain of the Company’s acquisitions of outdoor advertising net assets. The amounts funded by Clear Channel Communications for these acquisitions are recorded in “Owner’s net investment,” a component of owner’s equity.
      The Company provides advertising space on its billboards for radio stations owned by Clear Channel Communications. For the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002, the Company recorded $12.4 million, $17.5 million, and $12.5 million, respectively, in revenue for these advertisements.
      Clear Channel Communications provides management services to the Company, which include, among other things: (i) treasury, payroll and other financial related services; (ii) human resources and employee benefits services; (iii) legal and related services; (iv) information systems, network and related services; (v) investment services; (vi) corporate services; and (vii) procurement and sourcing support services. These services are charged to the Company based on actual direct costs incurred or allocated by Clear Channel Communications based on a seasonally adjusted headcount calculation. For the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002, the Company recorded $16.6 million, $19.6 million, and $17.6 million, respectively, as a component of corporate expenses for these services.
      Clear Channel Communications owns the trademark and trade names used by the Company. Beginning January 1, 2003, Clear Channel Communications charges the Company a royalty fee based upon a percentage of annual revenue. Clear Channel Communications used a third party valuation firm to assist in the calculation of the royalty fee. For the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003, the Company recorded $15.8 million and $14.1 million, respectively, of royalty fees in “Other income (expense) — net.”
      The operations of the Company are included in a consolidated federal income tax return filed by Clear Channel Communications. The Company’s provision for income taxes has been computed on the basis that the Company files separate consolidated income tax returns with its subsidiaries. Tax payments are made to Clear Channel Communications on the basis of the Company’s separate taxable income. Tax benefits recognized on employee stock options exercises are retained by Clear Channel Communications.
      The Company computes its deferred income tax provision using the liability method in accordance with Statement 109, as if the Company was a separate taxpayer. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on differences between financial reporting bases and tax bases of assets and liabilities and are measured using the enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the periods in which the deferred tax asset or liability is expected to be realized or settled. Deferred tax assets are reduced by valuation allowances if the Company believes it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the asset will not be realized. The Company’s provision for income taxes is further disclosed in Note I.
      The Company’s employees participate in Clear Channel Communications employee benefit plans, including employee medical insurance and a 401(k) retirement benefit plan. These costs are recorded as a

F-22


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
component of selling, general and administrative expenses and were approximately $8.2 million, $7.1 million, and $6.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively.
NOTE I — INCOME TAXES
      The operations of the Company are included in a consolidated federal income tax return filed by Clear Channel Communications, Inc. However, for financial reporting purposes, the Company’s provision for income taxes has been computed on the basis that the Company files separate consolidated income tax returns with its subsidiaries.
      Significant components of the provision for income tax expense (benefit) are as follows:
                           
    2004   2003   2002
             
    (In thousands)
Current — federal
  $ (10,291 )   $ (27,813 )   $ (85,352 )
Current — foreign
    34,894       22,734       20,796  
Current — state
    (1,181 )     (7,013 )     (7,452 )
                   
 
Total current
    23,422       (12,092 )     (72,008 )
Deferred — federal
    40,048       44,098       50,476  
Deferred — foreign
    (18,339 )     (27,714 )     (37,759 )
Deferred — state
    17,423       7,560       8,653  
                   
 
Total deferred
    39,132       23,944       21,370  
                   
Income tax expense (benefit)
  $ 62,554     $ 11,852     $ (50,638 )
                   
      The increases in current and deferred expense of $35.5 million and $15.2 million, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2004 were due to an increase in “Income (loss) before income taxes and cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle” of $93.2 million and additional deferred tax expense of approximately $16.0 million being recorded in order to adjust the deferred tax asset balance to an amount determined to be realizable by the Company.
      The decrease in current tax benefit recorded of $59.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2003 was due primarily to an increase in income before income taxes of approximately $83.2 million.

F-23


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
      Significant components of the Company’s deferred tax liabilities and assets as of December 31, 2004 and 2003 are as follows:
                   
    2004   2003
         
    (In thousands)
Deferred tax liabilities:
               
 
Foreign
  $ 37,185     $ 55,524  
 
Other
    1,816       2,605  
             
Total deferred tax liabilities
    39,001       58,129  
Deferred tax assets:
               
 
Intangibles and fixed assets
    266,053       209,214  
 
Accrued expenses
    1,163       1,273  
 
Equity in earnings
    2,138       776  
 
Net operating loss carryforwards
          753  
 
Bad debt reserves
    1,624       1,396  
 
Deferred income
    8,762       11,463  
 
Other
    95       47  
             
Total gross deferred tax assets
    279,835       224,922  
             
Net deferred tax assets
    240,834       166,793  
Less current portion
    9,778       11,600  
             
Long term deferred tax asset
  $ 231,056     $ 155,193  
             
      The deferred tax asset related to intangibles and fixed assets primarily relates to the difference in book and tax basis of acquired permits and tax deductible goodwill created from the Company’s various stock acquisitions. As discussed in Note B, in 2004 the Company adopted D-108, which resulted in the Company recording a non-cash charge of approximately $162.9 million, net of deferred tax of $113.2 million, related to its permits. In accordance with Statement No. 142, the Company no longer amortizes permits. Thus, a deferred tax benefit for the difference between book and tax amortization for the Company’s permits and tax-deductible goodwill is no longer recognized, as these assets are no longer amortized for book purposes. As the Company continues to amortize its tax basis in its permits and tax deductible goodwill, the deferred tax asset will decrease over time.
      Deferred tax assets and liabilities are computed by applying the U.S. federal and state income tax rate in effect to the gross amounts of temporary differences.

F-24


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
      The reconciliation of income tax computed at the U.S. federal statutory tax rates to income tax expense (benefit) is:
                         
    2004   2003   2002
             
    (In thousands)
Income tax expense (benefit) at statutory rates
  $ 24,511     $ (8,100 )   $ (37,221 )
State income taxes, net of federal tax benefit
    16,242       547       1,201  
Foreign taxes
    11,379       5,974       (19,620 )
Nondeductible items
    607       560       476  
Additional deferred tax expense
    4,804              
Tax contingencies
    4,626       10,116       3,892  
Subpart F income
    441       2,542       871  
Other, net
    (56 )     213       (237 )
                   
    $ 62,554     $ 11,852     $ (50,638 )
                   
      During 2004, the Company recorded tax expense of approximately $62.6 million on income (loss) before income taxes of $70.0 million. Foreign income (loss) before income taxes was approximately $14.8 million for 2004. The Company recorded additional deferred tax expense of approximately $16.0 million in 2004 in order to adjust the deferred tax asset balance to an amount determined to be realizable by the Company. In addition, the Company did not record a tax benefit on certain tax losses in its foreign operations due to the uncertainty of the ability to utilize those tax losses in the future.
      During 2003, the Company recorded tax expense of approximately $11.9 million on income (loss) before income taxes of ($23.1) million. Foreign income (loss) before income taxes was approximately ($31.3) million. The Company recorded additional current tax expense due to certain tax contingencies of approximately $10.1 million in 2003. In addition, the Company did not record a tax benefit on certain tax losses in its foreign operations due to the uncertainty of the ability to utilize those tax losses in the future.
      During 2002, the Company recorded tax benefit of approximately $50.6 million on income (loss) before income taxes of ($106.3) million. The Company recorded a tax benefit from foreign operations of approximately $17.0 million on foreign income (loss) before income taxes of approximately $7.6 million. The tax benefit was the result of the blending of income taxed in low tax rate jurisdictions and losses benefited in high tax rate jurisdictions.
      All tax liabilities owed by the Company are paid by Clear Channel Communications through an operating account that represents net amounts due to or from Clear Channel Communications.
NOTE J —  OWNER’S EQUITY
Stock Options
      Clear Channel Communications has granted options to purchase Clear Channel Communications common stock to employees of the Company and its affiliates under various stock option plans at no less than the fair market value of the underlying stock on the date of grant. These options are granted for a term not exceeding ten years and are forfeited in the event the employee or director terminates his or her employment or relationship with the Company or one of its affiliates. All option plans contain anti-dilutive provisions that require the adjustment of the number of shares of the Company common stock represented by each option for any stock splits or dividends.
Restricted Stock Awards
      On behalf of the Company, Clear Channel Communications began granting restricted stock awards to the Company’s employees in 2004. These Clear Channel Communications common shares bear a legend

F-25


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
which restricts their transferability for a term of from three to five years and are forfeited in the event the employee terminates his or her employment or relationship with the Company prior to the lapse of the restriction. The restricted stock awards were granted out of the Clear Channel Communications’ stock option plans. All option plans contain anti-dilutive provisions that require the adjustment of the number of shares of the Clear Channel Communications common stock represented by each option for any stock splits or dividends. Additionally, recipients of the restricted stock awards are entitled to all cash dividends as of the date the award was granted. The Company had 12,345 restricted stock awards outstanding at December 31, 2004 at a weighted average share price at the date of grant of $44.48.
NOTE K — EMPLOYEE STOCK AND SAVINGS PLANS
      The Company’s employees are eligible to participate in various 401(K) savings and other plans provided by Clear Channel Communications for the purpose of providing retirement benefits for substantially all employees. Both the employees and the Company make contributions to the plan. The Company matches a portion of an employee’s contribution. Beginning January 1, 2003, the Company match was increased from 35% to 50% of the employee’s first 5% of pay contributed to the plan. Company matched contributions vest to the employees based upon their years of service to the Company. Contributions to these plans of $1.9 million, $1.6 million and $1.2 million were charged to expense for 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively.
      The Company’s employees are also eligible to participate in a non-qualified employee stock purchase plan provided by Clear Channel Communications. Under the plan, shares of Clear Channel Communications’ common stock may be purchased at 85% of the market value on the day of purchase. Employees may purchase shares having a value not exceeding 10% of their annual gross compensation or $25,000, whichever is lower. During 2004, 2003 and 2002, all Clear Channel Communications employees purchased 262,163, 266,978 and 319,817 shares at weighted average share prices of $32.05, $34.01 and $33.85, respectively. The Company’s employees represent approximately 12% of the total participation in this plan.
      Certain highly compensated executives of the Company are eligible to participate in a non-qualified deferred compensation plan provided by Clear Channel Communications, which allows deferrals up to 50% of their annual salary and up to 80% of their bonus before taxes. The Company does not match any deferral amounts and retains ownership of all assets until distributed. There is no liability recorded by the Company under this deferred compensation plan as the liability of this plan is Clear Channel Communications’.
NOTE L — OTHER INFORMATION
                           
    For the Year Ended December 31,
     
    2004   2003   2002
             
    (In thousands)
The following details the components of “Other income (expense) — net”:
                       
 
Royalty fee to Clear Channel Communications
  $ (15,809 )   $ (14,063 )   $  
 
Gain on sale of operating and fixed assets
    11,718       11,047       7,118  
 
Asset retirement obligation
          (7,000 )      
 
Minority interest
    (7,602 )     (3,906 )     1,778  
 
Other
    (1,648 )     5,327       268  
                   
Total other income (expense) — net
  $ (13,341 )   $ (8,595 )   $ 9,164  
                   

F-26


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
NOTE M — SEGMENT DATA
      The Company has two reportable operating segments — domestic and international. The domestic segment includes operations in North and South America, and the international segment includes operations in Europe, Asia, Africa and Australia.
                                 
    Domestic   International   Corporate   Combined
                 
    (In thousands)
2004
                               
Revenue
  $ 1,092,089     $ 1,354,951     $     $ 2,447,040  
Direct operating expenses
    468,687       793,630             1,262,317  
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    173,010       326,447             499,457  
Depreciation and amortization
    186,620       201,597             388,217  
Corporate expenses
                53,770       53,770  
                         
Operating income (loss)
  $ 263,772     $ 33,277     $ (53,770 )   $ 243,279  
                         
Identifiable assets
  $ 3,378,761     $ 1,862,172     $     $ 5,240,933  
Capital expenditures
  $ 60,506     $ 115,634     $     $ 176,140  
2003
                               
Revenue
  $ 1,006,376     $ 1,168,221     $     $ 2,174,597  
Direct operating expenses
    435,075       698,311             1,133,386  
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    161,579       295,314             456,893  
Depreciation and amortization
    194,237       185,403             379,640  
Corporate expenses
                54,233       54,233  
                         
Operating income (loss)
  $ 215,485     $ (10,807 )   $ (54,233 )   $ 150,445  
                         
Identifiable assets
  $ 3,507,019     $ 1,725,801     $     $ 5,232,820  
Capital expenditures
  $ 60,685     $ 144,460     $     $ 205,145  
2002
                               
Revenue
  $ 911,493     $ 948,148     $     $ 1,859,641  
Direct operating expenses
    399,006       558,824             957,830  
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    158,159       234,644             392,803  
Depreciation and amortization
    179,947       156,948             336,895  
Corporate expenses
                52,218       52,218  
                         
Operating income (loss)
  $ 174,381     $ (2,268 )   $ (52,218 )   $ 119,895  
                         
Identifiable assets
  $ 3,494,697     $ 1,431,508     $     $ 4,926,205  
Capital expenditures
  $ 83,563     $ 206,624     $     $ 290,187  
      Revenue of $57.5 million, $46.6 million and $42.7 million and identifiable assets of $35.7 million, $28.9 million and $14.9 million derived from the Company’s foreign operations are included in the Domestic data above for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively.

F-27


Table of Contents

NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
NOTE N —  2004 QUARTERLY RESULTS OF OPERATIONS (Unaudited)
                                   
    For the Three Months Ended
     
    March 31   June 30   September 30   December 31
                 
    (In thousands)
Revenue
  $ 521,593     $ 639,549     $ 600,166     $ 685,732  
Operating expenses:
                               
 
Direct operating expenses
    293,833       312,815       317,754       337,897  
 
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    118,040       119,310       120,856       141,269  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    99,750       92,806       96,254       99,407  
 
Corporate expenses
    11,856       14,681       12,914       14,319  
                         
Operating income (loss)
    (1,886 )     99,937       52,388       92,840  
Interest expense
    3,675       3,600       3,836       3,066  
Intercompany interest expense
    36,413       36,413       36,413       36,414  
Equity in earnings of nonconsolidated affiliates
    319       4,468       (2,517 )     (2,346 )
Other income (expense) — net
    (6,435 )     (5,203 )     (5,572 )     3,869  
                         
Income (loss) before income taxes and cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    (48,090 )     59,189       4,050       54,883  
Income tax (expense) benefit
    35,706       (43,946 )     (3,009 )     (51,305 )
                         
Income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle
    (12,384 )     15,243       1,041       3,578  
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax of $113,173
                      (162,858 )
                         
Net income (loss)
  $ (12,384 )   $ 15,243     $ 1,041     $ (159,280 )
                         
NOTE O —  SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
      In July, 2005, the Company increased its investment in Clear Media Limited, a Chinese outdoor advertising company, to over 50%. As a result, the Company will no longer account for this investment under the equity method, but rather will begin consolidating the results of Clear Media Limited beginning in the third quarter of 2005.
      On July 27, 2005, the Company announced to the trade union representatives and to employees a draft plan to restructure its operations in France. In connection with the restructuring, the Company expects to record approximately $25.0 million in restructuring costs, including employee termination and other costs, as a component of selling, general and administrative expenses during the third quarter of 2005.
      On August 2, 2005, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company entered into a $2.5 billion intercompany note payable to the Company which was subsequently distributed as a dividend to Clear Channel Communications. This note accrues interest at a variable per annum rate equal to the weighted average cost of debt for Clear Channel Communications, calculated on a monthly basis. The estimated weighted average interest rate for the period ended September 30, 2005 is 5.7%. This note will mature on August 2, 2010.

F-28


Table of Contents

      The following report is in the form that will be signed upon the completion of the transaction described in Basis of Presentation of Note A to the financial statements.
  /s/ Ernst & Young LLP
San Antonio, Texas
October 24, 2005
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
The Board of Directors
Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
      We have reviewed the accompanying combined balance sheet of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and subsidiaries (the Company) as of September 30, 2005, and the related combined statements of operations for the nine-month periods ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, and the combined statements of cash flows for the nine-month periods ended September 30, 2005 and 2004. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management.
      We conducted our review in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). A review of interim financial information consists principally of applying analytical procedures and making inquiries of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters. It is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board, the objective of which is the expression of an opinion regarding the financial statements taken as a whole. Accordingly, we do not express such an opinion.
      Based on our review, we are not aware of any material modifications that should be made to the combined financial statements referred to above for them to be in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
      We have previously audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the combined balance sheet of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2004, and the related combined statements of operations, owners’ equity, and cash flows for the year then ended and in our report dated August 4, 2005, except as to Basis of Presentation of Note A, as to which date is                     , 2005 we expressed an unqualified opinion on those combined financial statements and included an explanatory paragraph indicating in 2004 the Company changed its method of accounting for indefinite lived intangibles and in 2002 the Company changed its method for goodwill. In our opinion, the information set forth in the accompanying combined balance sheet as of December 31, 2004, is fairly stated, in all material respects, in relation to the combined balance sheet from which it has been derived.
San Antonio, Texas
October 20, 2005

F-29


Table of Contents

COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS
                   
    September 30,   December 31,
    2005   2004
         
    (In thousands)
    (Unaudited)    
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS
               
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 91,676     $ 37,948  
Accounts receivable, less allowance of $22,930 at September 30, 2005 and $19,487 at December 31, 2004
    679,469       661,244  
Due from Clear Channel Communications
    362,154       302,634  
Prepaid expenses
    69,060       59,601  
Other current assets
    40,928       45,813  
             
 
Total Current Assets
    1,243,287       1,107,240  
PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
               
Land, buildings and improvements
    310,156       318,478  
Structures
    3,287,778       3,110,233  
Furniture and other equipment
    237,304       238,973  
Construction in progress
    54,977       54,021  
             
      3,890,215       3,721,705  
Less accumulated depreciation
    1,718,018       1,525,720  
             
      2,172,197       2,195,985  
INTANGIBLE ASSETS
               
Definite-lived intangibles, net
    255,028       334,284  
Indefinite-lived intangibles — permits
    212,507       211,690  
Goodwill
    760,455       787,006  
OTHER ASSETS
               
Notes receivable
    5,821       5,872  
Investments in, and advances to, nonconsolidated affiliates
    99,447       175,057  
Deferred tax asset
    243,030       231,056  
Other assets
    302,915       189,513  
Other investments
    835       3,230  
             
 
Total Assets
  $ 5,295,522     $ 5,240,933  
             
LIABILITIES AND OWNER’S EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES
               
Accounts payable
  $ 209,948     $ 243,542  
Accrued expenses
    325,477       264,567  
Accrued interest
    2,443       558  
Accrued income tax
    19,520        
Deferred income
    98,135       94,120  
Current portion of long-term debt
    152,377       146,268  
             
 
Total Current Liabilities
    807,900       749,055  
Long-term debt
    96,759       30,112  
Debt with Clear Channel Communications
    3,963,000       1,463,000  
Other long-term liabilities
    175,965       205,811  
Minority interest
    163,549       63,302  
Commitment and contingent liabilities (Note 4)
               
OWNER’S EQUITY
               
Owners net investment
    4,179,664       6,679,664  
Retained deficit
    (4,229,060 )     (4,250,222 )
Accumulated other comprehensive income
    137,745       300,211  
             
 
Total Owner’s Equity
    88,349       2,729,653  
             
 
Total Liabilities and Owner’s Equity
  $ 5,295,522     $ 5,240,933  
             
See Notes to Combined Financial Statements

F-30


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                   
    Nine Months Ended September 30,
     
    2005   2004
         
    (In thousands)
Revenue
  $ 1,931,471     $ 1,761,308  
Operating expenses:
               
 
Direct operating expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    988,448       924,420  
 
Selling, general and administrative expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    410,075       358,188  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    290,233       288,810  
 
Corporate expenses (exclusive of depreciation and amortization)
    39,397       39,451  
             
Operating income
    203,318       150,439  
Interest expense
    9,874       11,111  
Intercompany interest expense
    133,093       109,239  
Equity in earnings of nonconsolidated affiliates
    9,908       2,270  
Other income (expense) — net
    (17,353 )     (17,210 )
             
Income before income taxes
    52,906       15,149  
Income tax (expense) benefit:
               
 
Current
    (37,767 )     6,481  
 
Deferred
    6,023       (17,730 )
             
Net income
    21,162       3,900  
             
Other comprehensive loss, net of tax:
               
 
Foreign currency translation adjustments
    (162,466 )     (8,103 )
             
Comprehensive loss
  $ (141,304 )   $ (4,203 )
             
See Notes to Combined Financial Statements

F-31


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN OWNER’S EQUITY
                                 
    Owner’s Net       Accumulated Other    
    Investment   Retained Deficit   Comprehensive Income   Total
                 
    (In thousands)
Balances at December 31, 2004
  $ 6,679,664     $ (4,250,222 )   $ 300,211     $ 2,729,653  
Net income
          21,162             21,162  
Dividend payable to Clear Channel Communications
    (2,500,000 )                 (2,500,000 )
Currency translation adjustment
                (162,466 )     (162,466 )
                         
Balances at September 30, 2005
  $ 4,179,664     $ (4,229,060 )   $ 137,745     $ 88,349  
                         
See Notes to Combined Financial Statements

F-32


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                   
    Nine Months Ended
    September 30,
     
    2005   2004
         
    (In thousands)
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES
               
Net income
  $ 21,162     $ 3,900  
Reconciling Items:
               
 
Depreciation and amortization
    290,233       288,810  
 
Deferred taxes
    (6,023 )     17,730  
 
(Gain) loss on sale of operating and fixed assets
    (2,762 )     (1,530 )
 
Equity in earnings of nonconsolidated affiliates
    (9,908 )     (2,270 )
 
Increase (decrease) other, net
    8,870       4,007  
Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of effects of acquisitions:
               
 
Decrease (increase) in accounts receivable
    275       22,303  
 
Decrease (increase) in prepaid expenses
    (9,459 )     (3,959 )
 
Decrease (increase) in other current assets
    33,038       (4,854 )
 
Increase (decrease) in accounts payable, accrued expenses and other liabilities
    (24,183 )     (36,036 )
 
Increase (decrease) in accrued interest
    1,860       797  
 
Increase (decrease) in deferred income
    2,547       13,334  
 
Increase (decrease) in accrued income taxes
    30,987       27,661  
             
Net cash provided by operating activities
    336,637       329,893  
 
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES
               
Decrease (increase) in notes receivable, net
    51       506  
Decrease (increase) in investments in, and advances to, nonconsolidated affiliates — net
    1,114       (7,219 )
Purchases of investments
          (407 )
Proceeds from sale of investments
          12,076  
Purchases of property, plant and equipment
    (130,484 )     (117,733 )
Proceeds from disposal of assets
    9,593       5,672  
Acquisition of operating assets, net of cash acquired
    (43,737 )     (86,861 )
Decrease (increase) in other — net
    (59,726 )     (33,420 )
             
Net cash used in investing activities
    (223,189 )     (227,386 )
 
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
               
Draws on credit facilities
    58,206       65,948  
Payments on credit facilities
    (46,840 )     (75,749 )
Net transfers to Clear Channel Communications
    (59,520 )     (85,958 )
             
Net cash used in financing activities
    (48,154 )     (95,759 )
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash
    (11,566 )     (1,713 )
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
    53,728       5,035  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
    37,948       34,105  
             
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
  $ 91,676     $ 39,140  
             
See Notes to Combined Financial Statements

F-33


Table of Contents

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Note 1: SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Preparation of Interim Financial Statements
      Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”) includes the entities principally comprising the outdoor segment of Clear Channel Communications, Inc. (“Clear Channel Communications”), a diversified media company with operations in radio broadcasting, outdoor advertising and live entertainment. The Company has two principal business segments: domestic and international. The domestic segment includes operations in North and South America; and the international segment includes operations in Europe, Asia, Africa and Australia.
      The combined financial statements have been prepared by the Company pursuant to the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and, in the opinion of management, include all adjustments (consisting of normal recurring accruals and adjustments necessary for adoption of new accounting standards) necessary to present fairly the results of the interim periods shown. Certain information and footnote disclosures normally included in financial statements prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States have been condensed or omitted pursuant to such SEC rules and regulations. Management believes that the disclosures made are adequate to make the information presented not misleading. Due to seasonality and other factors, the results for the interim periods are not necessarily indicative of results for the full year.
      The combined financial statements include assets and liabilities of Clear Channel Communications not currently owned by the Company that will be transferred to the Company prior to or concurrent with the initial public offering of 10% of the Company’s common stock. The combined financial statements are comprised of businesses included in the consolidated financial statements and accounting records of Clear Channel Communications, using the historical results of operations, and historical basis of assets and liabilities of the outdoor business. Investments in companies in which the Company owns 20 percent to 50 percent of the voting common stock or otherwise exercises significant influence over operating and financial policies of the company are accounted for under the equity method. Significant intercompany accounts among the combined businesses have been eliminated in consolidation.
Recent Developments
      In July 2005, the Company increased its investment in Clear Media Limited (“Clear Media”), a Chinese company that operates street furniture displays throughout China, to a controlling majority ownership interest. As a result, the Company began consolidating the results of Clear Media in the third quarter of 2005. The Company had been accounting for Clear Media as an equity investment prior to July 2005. Included in the consolidated balance sheet as of September 30, 2005, are total assets of $266.1 million and total liabilities of $164.4 million related to Clear Media.

F-34


Table of Contents

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Stock-Based Compensation
      The Company does not have any compensation plans under which it grants stock awards to employees. Clear Channel Communications grants stock options to the Company’s officers and other key employees on behalf of the Company. Clear Channel Communications accounts for its stock-based award plans in accordance with APB 25, and related interpretations, under which compensation expense is recorded to the extent that the current market price of the underlying stock exceeds the exercise price. Clear Channel Communications calculates the pro forma stock compensation expense as if the stock-based awards had been accounted for using the provisions of Statement 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation. The stock compensation expense is then allocated to the Company based on the percentage of options outstanding to employees of the Company. The required pro forma disclosures, based on this allocated expense are as follows:
                   
    The Nine Months
    Ended September 30,
     
    2005   2004
         
    (In thousands)
Income (loss):
               
 
Reported
  $ 21,162     $ 3,900  
 
Pro forma stock compensation expense, net of tax
    (1,595 )     (4,921 )
             
 
Pro Forma
  $ 19,567     $ (1,021 )
             
Recent Accounting Pronouncements
      In March 2005, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Interpretation No. 47, Accounting for Conditional Asset Retirement Obligations (“FIN 47”). FIN 47 is an interpretation of FASB Statement 143, Asset Retirement Obligations, which was issued in June 2001. According to FIN 47, uncertainty about the timing and (or) method of settlement because they are conditional on a future event that may or may not be within the control of the entity should be factored into the measurement of the asset retirement obligation when sufficient information exists. FIN 47 also clarifies when an entity would have sufficient information to reasonably estimate the fair value of an asset retirement obligation. FIN 47 is effective no later than the end of fiscal years ending after December 15, 2005. Retrospective application of interim financial information is permitted, but is not required. The Company adopted FIN 47 on January 1, 2005, which did not materially impact the Company’s financial position or results of operations.
      In March 2005, the SEC issued Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 107 Share-Based Payment (“SAB 107”). SAB 107 expresses the SEC staff’s views regarding the interaction between Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123(R) Share-Based Payment (“Statement 123(R)”) and certain SEC rules and regulations and provides the staff’s views regarding the valuation of share-based payment arrangements for public companies. In particular, SAB 107 provides guidance related to share-based payment transactions with nonemployees, the transition from nonpublic to public entity status, valuation methods (including assumptions such as expected volatility and expected term), the accounting for certain redeemable financial instruments issued under share-based payment arrangements, the classification of compensation expense, non-GAAP financial measures, first time adoption of Statement 123(R) in an interim period, capitalization of compensation cost related to share-based payment arrangements, the accounting for income tax effects of share-based payment arrangements upon adoption of Statement 123(R) and the modification of employee share options prior to adoption of Statement 123(R). The Company is unable to quantify the impact of adopting SAB 107 and Statement 123(R) at this time because it will depend on levels of share-based payments granted in the future. Additionally, the Company is still evaluating the assumptions it will use upon adoption.
      In April 2005, the SEC issued a press release announcing that it would provide for phased-in implementation guidance for Statement 123(R). The SEC would require that registrants that are not

F-35


Table of Contents

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
small business issuers adopt Statement 123(R)’s fair value method of accounting for share-based payments to employees no later than the beginning of the first fiscal year beginning after June 15, 2005. The Company intends to adopt Statement 123(R) on January 1, 2006.
      In June 2005, the Emerging Issues Task Force (“EITF”) issued EITF 05-6, Determining the Amortization Period of Leasehold Improvements (“EITF 05-6”). EITF 05-6 requires that assets recognized under capital leases generally be amortized in a manner consistent with the lessee’s normal depreciation policy except that the amortization period is limited to the lease term (which includes renewal periods that are reasonably assured). EITF 05-6 also addresses the determination of the amortization period for leasehold improvements that are purchased subsequent to the inception of the lease. Leasehold improvements acquired in a business combination or purchased subsequent to the inception of the lease should be amortized over the lesser of the useful life of the asset or the lease term that includes reasonably assured lease renewals as determined on the date of the acquisition of the leasehold improvement. The Company adopted EITF 05-6 on July 1, 2005, which did not materially impact the Company’s financial position or results of operations.
Note 2: INTANGIBLE ASSETS AND GOODWILL
Definite-lived Intangibles
      The Company has definite-lived intangible assets which consist primarily of transit and street furniture contracts and other contractual rights, all of which are amortized over the respective lives of the agreements. Other definite-lived intangible assets are amortized over the period of time the assets are expected to contribute directly or indirectly to the Company’s future cash flows. The following table presents the gross carrying amount and accumulated amortization for each major class of definite-lived intangible assets at September 30, 2005 and December 31, 2004:
                                 
    September 30, 2005   December 31, 2004
         
    Gross       Gross    
    Carrying   Accumulated   Carrying   Accumulated
    Amount   Amortization   Amount   Amortization
                 
    (In thousands)
Transit, street furniture, and other contractual rights
  $ 641,316     $ 396,720     $ 688,373     $ 364,939  
Other
    56,652       46,220       57,093       46,243  
                         
Total
  $ 697,968     $ 442,940     $ 745,466     $ 411,182  
                         
      Total amortization expense from definite-lived intangible assets for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and for the year ended December 31, 2004 was $64.2 million and $67.1 million, respectively. The following table presents the Company’s estimate of amortization expense for each of the five succeeding fiscal years for definite-lived intangible assets:
         
    (In thousands)
2006
  $ 71,309  
2007
    40,458  
2008
    20,319  
2009
    16,759  
2010
    10,632  
      As acquisitions and dispositions occur in the future and as purchase price allocations are finalized, amortization expense may vary.

F-36


Table of Contents

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Indefinite-lived Intangibles
      The Company’s indefinite-lived intangible assets consist of billboard permits. Billboard permits are issued in perpetuity by state and local governments and are transferable or renewable at little or no cost. Permits typically include the location for which the permit allows the Company the right to operate an advertising structure. The Company’s permits are located on either owned or leased land. In cases where the Company’s permits are located on leased land, the leases are typically from 10 to 30 years and renew indefinitely, with rental payments generally escalating at an inflation based index. If the Company loses its lease, the Company will typically obtain permission to relocate the permit or bank it with the municipality for future use.
      The Company does not amortize its billboard permits. The Company tests these indefinite-lived intangible assets for impairment at least annually using the direct method. Under the direct method, it is assumed that rather than acquiring indefinite-lived intangible assets as a part of a going concern business, the buyer hypothetically obtains indefinite-lived intangible assets and builds a new operation with similar attributes from scratch. Thus, the buyer incurs start-up costs during the build-up phase which are normally associated with going concern value. Initial capital costs are deducted from the discounted cash flows model which results in value that is directly attributable to the indefinite-lived intangible assets.
      Under the direct method, the Company continues to aggregate its indefinite-lived intangible assets at the market level for purposes of impairment testing. The Company’s key assumptions using the direct method are market revenue growth rates, market share, profit margin, duration and profile of the build-up period, estimated start-up capital costs and losses incurred during the build-up period, the risk-adjusted discount rate and terminal values. This data is populated using industry normalized information representing an average station within a market.
Goodwill
      The Company tests goodwill for impairment using a two-step process. The first step, used to screen for potential impairment, compares the fair value of the reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. The second step, used to measure the amount of the impairment loss, compares the implied fair value of the reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. The following table presents the changes in the carrying amount of goodwill in each of the Company’s reportable segments for the nine-month period ended September 30, 2005:
                         
    Domestic   International   Total
             
    (In thousands)
Balance as of December 31, 2004
  $ 397,377     $ 389,629     $ 787,006  
Acquisitions
    1,403       15,884       17,287  
Foreign currency
    462       (42,512 )     (42,050 )
Adjustments
    (1,612 )     (176 )     (1,788 )
                   
Balance as of September 30, 2005
  $ 397,630     $ 362,825     $ 760,455  
                   

F-37


Table of Contents

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Note 3: RESTRUCTURING
      The following represents the ongoing restructuring activities of the Company, including the 2002 Ackerley restructuring, the 2003 restructuring of the France operations, the 2004 restructuring of the Spain operations, and the additional restructuring of the France operations in 2005:
                   
    Nine Months    
    Ended   Year Ended
    September 30, 2005   December 31, 2004
         
    (In thousands)
Accrual at January 1
  $ 6,867     $ 7,469  
 
Estimated costs charged to restructuring accrual
    26,576       4,131  
 
Adjustments to restructuring accrual
          (377 )
 
Payments charged against restructuring accrual
    (5,460 )     (4,356 )
             
Ending balance of accrual
  $ 27,983     $ 6,867  
             
2002 Restructuring
      As a result of Clear Channel Communications’ merger with Ackerley in June 2002, the Company recorded a $9.4 million accrual related to the restructuring of Ackerley’s outdoor advertising operations. Of the $9.4 million, $5.3 million was related to severance and $4.1 million was related to lease terminations. The Ackerley corporate office closed in July 2002. This restructuring resulted in the termination of 19 employees. There were no payments charged to the restructuring reserve related to severance during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 or during the year ended December 31, 2004. At September 30, 2005, the accrual balance for this restructuring was $1.6 million. The remaining restructuring accrual is comprised solely of lease termination, which will be paid over the next five years.
2003 Restructuring
      The Company restructured its operations in France during 2003. As a result, the Company recorded a $13.8 million accrual in selling, general and administrative expenses; $12.5 million was related to severance and $1.3 million was related to lease terminations and consulting costs. As of September 30, 2005, the accrual balance relating to the France restructuring was $0.7 million, which is related to severance. It is expected that these accruals will be paid in the current year. This restructuring has resulted in the termination of 134 employees.
2004 Restructuring
      The Company restructured its operations in Spain during 2004. As a result, the Company recorded a $4.1 million accrual in selling, general and administrative expenses; $2.2 million was related to severance and $1.9 million was related to consulting and other costs. As of September 30, 2005, the accrual balance for this restructuring was $1.8 million, which consists of $0.4 million related to severance and $1.4 million related to lease termination and other costs. It is expected that these accruals will be paid in the current year. This restructuring has resulted in the termination of 44 employees.
2005 Restructuring
      In the third quarter of 2005, the Company restructured its operations in France. As a result, the Company recorded $26.6 million in restructuring costs as a component of selling, general and administrative expenses during the third quarter of 2005; $22.5 million was related to severance costs and $4.1 million was related to other costs. It has been announced that the restructuring will result in the termination of 101 employees. In addition, $2.7 million of related other costs were incurred during the quarter and applied against the reserve. As of September 30, 2005, the accrual balance was $23.9 million.

F-38


Table of Contents

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Note 4: COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
      Certain agreements relating to acquisitions provide for purchase price adjustments and other future contingent payments based on the financial performance of the acquired companies. The Company will continue to accrue additional amounts related to such contingent payments if and when it is determinable that the applicable financial performance targets will be met. The aggregate of these contingent payments, if performance targets are met, would not significantly impact the financial position or results of operations of the Company.
      The Company is currently involved in certain other legal proceedings and, as required, has accrued an estimate of the probable costs for the resolution of these claims, inclusive of those discussed above. These estimates have been developed in consultation with counsel and are based upon an analysis of potential results, assuming a combination of litigation and settlement strategies. It is possible, however, that future results of operations for any particular period could be materially affected by changes in the Company’s assumptions or the effectiveness of its strategies related to these proceedings.
Note 5: RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
      The Company has an account that represents net amounts due to or from Clear Channel Communications, which is recorded as “Due from Clear Channel Communications” on the combined balance sheets. The account did not accrue interest during the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and the year ended December 31, 2004 and is generally payable on demand. Included in the account is the net activity resulting from day-to-day cash management services provided by Clear Channel Communications. As a part of these services, the Company maintains collection bank accounts that are swept daily by Clear Channel Communications. In return, Clear Channel Communications funds the Company’s controlled disbursement accounts as checks or electronic payments are presented for payment. At September 30, 2005 and December 31, 2004, the balance in “Due from Clear Channel Communications” was $362.2 million and $302.6 million, respectively.
      The Company has issued two intercompany notes to Clear Channel Communications in the aggregate original principal amount of approximately $1.5 billion. The first intercompany note in the original principal amount of approximately $1.4 billion matures on December 31, 2017 and may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 10%. The second intercompany note in the original principal amount of approximately $73.0 million matures on December 31, 2017 and may be prepaid in whole at any time, or in part from time to time, and accrues interest at a per annum rate of 9%.
      On August 2, 2005, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company entered into a $2.5 billion intercompany note payable to the Company which was subsequently distributed as a dividend to Clear Channel Communications. This note accrues interest at a variable per annum rate equal to the weighted average cost of debt for Clear Channel Communications, calculated on a monthly basis. The estimated weighted average interest rate for the period ended September 30, 2005 is 5.7%. This note will mature on August 2, 2010.
      Clear Channel Communications has provided funding for certain of the Company’s acquisitions of outdoor advertising net assets. The amounts funded by Clear Channel Communications for these acquisitions are recorded in “Owner’s net investment,” a component of owner’s equity.
      The Company provides advertising space on its billboards for radio stations owned by Clear Channel Communications. For the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 the Company recorded $7.0 million and $9.7 million, respectively, in revenue for these advertisements.
      Clear Channel Communications provides management services to the Company, which include, among other things: (i) treasury, payroll and other financial related services; (ii) human resources and employee benefits services; (iii) legal and related services; (iv) information systems, network and related

F-39


Table of Contents

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
services; (v) investment services; (vi) corporate services; and (vii) procurement and sourcing support services. These services are charged to the Company based on actual direct costs incurred or allocated by Clear Channel Communications based on a seasonally adjusted headcount calculation. For the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, the Company recorded $11.8 million and $11.8 million, respectively, as a component of corporate expenses for these services.
      Clear Channel Communications owns the trademark and trade names used by the Company. Clear Channel Communications charges the Company a royalty fee based upon a percentage of annual revenue. Clear Channel Communications used a third party valuation firm to assist in the calculation of the royalty fee. For the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, the Company recorded $11.0 million and $12.2 million, respectively of royalty fees in “Other income (expense) — net.”
      The operations of the Company are included in a consolidated federal income tax return filed by Clear Channel Communications. The Company’s provision for income taxes has been computed on the basis that the Company files separate consolidated income tax returns with its subsidiaries. Tax payments are made to Clear Channel Communications on the basis of the Company’s separate taxable income. Tax benefits recognized on employee stock options exercises are retained by Clear Channel Communications.
      The Company computes its deferred income tax provision using the liability method in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes, as if the Company was a separate taxpayer. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on differences between financial reporting bases and tax bases of assets and liabilities and are measured using the enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the periods in which the deferred tax asset or liability is expected to be realized or settled. If the Company believes it is more likely than not that some portion or all of a deferred tax asset will not be realized, it will reduce the asset by a valuation allowance.

F-40


Table of Contents

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
Note 6: SEGMENT DATA
      The Company has two reportable segments — domestic and international. The domestic segment includes operations in North and South America, and the international segment includes operations in Europe, Asia, Africa, and Australia.
                                 
    Domestic   International   Corporate   Combined
                 
    (In thousands)
Nine months ended September 30, 2005
                               
Revenue
  $ 886,649     $ 1,044,822     $       1,931,471  
Direct operating expenses
    359,263       629,185             988,448  
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    136,919       273,156             410,075  
Depreciation and amortization
    127,019       163,214             290,233  
Corporate expenses
                39,397       39,397  
                         
Operating income (loss)
  $ 263,448     $ (20,733 )   $ (39,397 )     203,318  
                         
Identifiable assets
  $ 3,428,948     $ 1,866,574     $     $ 5,295,522  
Capital expenditures
  $ 50,012     $ 80,472     $     $ 130,484  
Nine months ended September 30, 2004
                               
Revenue
  $ 800,744     $ 960,564           $ 1,761,308  
Direct operating expenses
    347,619       576,801             924,420  
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    126,838       231,350             358,188  
Depreciation and amortization
    141,479       147,331             288,810  
Corporate expenses
                39,451       39,451  
                         
Operating income (loss)
  $ 184,808     $ 5,082     $ (39,451 )     150,439  
                         
Identifiable assets
  $ 3,529,756     $ 1,670,651     $     $ 5,200,407  
Capital expenditures
  $ 38,190     $ 79,543     $     $ 117,733  
      Revenue of $46.3 million and $39.2 million and identifiable assets of $50.0 million and $30.1 million derived from the Company’s foreign operations are included in the Domestic data above for the nine months ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, respectively.

F-41


Table of Contents

      The following report is in the form that will be signed upon the completion of the transaction described in the Basis of Presentation discussed in Note A to the financial statements.
  /s/ Ernst & Young LLP
San Antonio, Texas
September 22, 2005
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM ON
FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULE
      We have audited the combined balance sheets of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2004 and 2003, and the related combined statements of operations, changes in owner’s equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2004, and have issued our report thereon dated August 4, 2005, except as to Basis of Presentation of Note A, as to which date is                     , 2005 (included elsewhere in this Registration Statement). Our audits also included the financial statement Schedule II in this Registration Statement. This schedule is the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion based on our audits.
      In our opinion, the financial statement schedule referred to above, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.
  Ernst & Young LLP
San Antonio, Texas
August 4, 2005

F-42


Table of Contents

Schedule II — Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
(In thousands)
                                         
        Charges            
    Balance at   to Costs,   Write-off of       Balance
    Beginning of   Expenses   Accounts       at end of
Description   period   and other   Receivable   Other(1)   Period
                     
Year ended December 31, 2002
  $ 13,751     $ 17,588     $ 13,296     $ 776     $ 18,819  
                               
Year ended December 31, 2003
  $ 18,819     $ 6,996     $ 12,311     $ 2,209     $ 15,713  
                               
Year ended December 31, 2004
  $ 15,713     $ 8,731     $ 6,112     $ 1,155     $ 19,487  
                               
 
(1)  Foreign currency adjustments.

F-43


Table of Contents

(MAP OF OUR INTERNATIONAL MARKETS)
             See inside front cover for a map of our domestic markets.


Table of Contents

 
 
          No dealer, salesperson, or other person is authorized to give any information or to represent anything not contained in the prospectus. You must not rely on any unauthorized information or representations. This prospectus is an offer to sell only the shares offered hereby, but only under circumstances and in jurisdictions where it is lawful to do so. The information contained in this prospectus is current only as of its date.
 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
         
    Page
     
    1  
    13  
    29  
    30  
    31  
    31  
    33  
    34  
    39  
    44  
    70  
    73  
    86  
    101  
    111  
    112  
    119  
    121  
    122  
    125  
    129  
    129  
    129  
    F-1  
 
          Through and including                     , 2005 (the 25th day after the date of this prospectus), all dealers effecting transactions in these securities, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to a dealer’s obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as an underwriter and with respect to an unsold allotment or subscription.
 
 
 
 
                             Shares
CLEAR CHANNEL OUTDOOR LOGO
Class A Common Stock
 
PROSPECTUS
 
Global Coordinator & Senior Bookrunner
Goldman, Sachs & Co.
Joint Bookrunners
Deutsche Bank Securities
JPMorgan
Merrill Lynch & Co.
UBS Investment Bank
Co-Managers
Banc of America Securities LLC
Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc.
Credit Suisse First Boston
Allen & Company LLC
Barrington Research
Harris Nesbitt
SunTrust Robinson Humphrey
Wachovia Securities
 
 


Table of Contents

PART II
INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
Item 13. Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution.
      The estimated expenses paid by Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”) in connection with the issuance and distribution of the Class A common stock being registered on this Form S-1, other than underwriting discounts and commission, are as follows:
           
Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee
  $ 41,195  
New York Stock Exchange fees
    250,000  
Blue sky fees and expenses
    *  
Printing and engraving fees
    *  
Accounting fees and expenses
    *  
Legal fees and expenses
    *  
Transfer agent and registrar fees
    *  
NASD filing fees
    *  
Miscellaneous fees and expenses
    *  
       
 
Total
  $ *  
       
 
To be filed by amendment
Item 14. Indemnification of Directors and Officers.
      Section 145 of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware provides as follows:
      (a) A corporation shall have power to indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (other than an action by or in the right of the corporation) by reason of the fact that the person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise, against expenses (including attorneys’ fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by the person in connection with such action, suit or proceeding if the person acted in good faith and in a manner the person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe the person’s conduct was unlawful. The termination of any action, suit or proceeding by judgment, order, settlement, conviction, or upon a plea of nolo contendere or its equivalent, shall not, of itself, create a presumption that the person did not act in good faith and in a manner which the person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had reasonable cause to believe that the person’s conduct was unlawful.
      (b) A corporation shall have power to indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action or suit by or in the right of the corporation to procure a judgment in its favor by reason of the fact that the person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise against expenses (including attorneys’ fees) actually and reasonably incurred by the person in connection with the defense or settlement of such action or suit if the person acted in good faith and in a manner the person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation and except that no indemnification shall be made in respect of any claim, issue or matter as to which such person shall have been adjudged to be liable to the corporation unless and only to the extent that the

II-1


Table of Contents

Court of Chancery or the court in which such action or suit was brought shall determine upon application that, despite the adjudication of liability but in view of all the circumstances of the case, such person is fairly and reasonably entitled to indemnity for such expenses which the Court of Chancery or such other court shall deem proper.
      As permitted by the Delaware General Corporation Law, we have included in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation a provision to eliminate the personal liability of our directors for monetary damages for breach of their fiduciary duties as directors, subject to certain exceptions. In addition, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws provide that we are required to indemnify our officers and directors under certain circumstances, including those circumstances in which indemnification would otherwise be discretionary, and we are required to advance expenses to our officers and directors as incurred in connection with proceedings against them for which they may be indemnified.
      The underwriting agreement provides that the underwriters are obligated, under certain circumstances, to indemnify our directors, officers and controlling persons against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act. Reference is made to the form of underwriting agreement filed as Exhibit 1.1 hereto.
      The Master Agreement by and between the company and Clear Channel Communications provides for indemnification by the company of Clear Channel Communications and its directors, officers and employees for certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.
      We maintain directors and officers liability insurance for the benefit of our directors and officers.
Item 15. Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities.
      Not applicable.
Item 16. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules.
      (a)  Exhibits
         
Exhibit    
Number   Exhibit Title
     
  1 .1*   Form of Underwriting Agreement.
 
  3 .1**   Form of Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  3 .2**   Form of Amended and Restated Bylaws of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  4 .1***   Form of Specimen Class A Common Stock certificate of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  4 .2***   Form of Specimen Class B Common Stock certificate of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  5 .1*   Opinion of Fulbright & Jaworski L.L.P.
 
  10 .1**   Form of Master Agreement between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
 
  10 .2**   Form of Registration Rights Agreement between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
 
  10 .3***   Form of Corporate Services Agreement between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Management Services, L.P.
 
  10 .4**   Form of Tax Matters Agreement by and between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
 
  10 .5**   Form of Employee Matters Agreement between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
 
  10 .6***   Form of Amended and Restated License Agreement between Clear Channel Identity, L.P. and Outdoor Management Services, Inc.
 
  10 .7**   Subordinated Promissory Note effective January 1, 2003, in the original principal amount of $1.39 billion.

II-2


Table of Contents

         
Exhibit    
Number   Exhibit Title
     
  10 .8**   Subordinated Promissory Note effective January 1, 2003, in the original principal amount of $73.0 million.
 
  10 .9**   Senior Unsecured Term Promissory Note dated August 2, 2005 in the original principal amount of $2.5 billion.
 
  10 .10**   First Amendment to Senior Unsecured Term Promissory Note dated October 7, 2005.
  10 .11**   Form of 2005 Stock Incentive Plan of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  10 .12**   Form of 2006 Annual Incentive Plan of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  10 .13**   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement by and between Clear Channel Communications, Inc. and Mark P. Mays dated March 10, 2005 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. Form 10-K (Commission File No. 1-9645) filed March 11, 2005).
  10 .14**   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement by and between Clear Channel Communications, Inc. and Randall T. Mays dated March 10, 2005 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. Form 10-K (Commission File No. 1-9645) filed March 11, 2005).
  10 .15**   Employment Agreement by and between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Paul J. Meyer dated August 5, 2005 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. Form 8-K (Commission File No. 1-9645) filed August 10, 2005).
  15 .1***   Letter regarding unaudited interim financial information.
  21 .1**   Subsidiaries of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  23 .1***   Form of Consent of Auditor.
  23 .2*   Consent of Fulbright & Jaworski L.L.P. (included in Exhibit 5.1).
  24 .1**   Powers of Attorney.
 
  99 .1***   Consent of Prospective Director of James M. Raines dated October 21, 2005.
  99 .2**   Consent of Prospective Director of Marsha M. Shields dated September 21, 2005.
  99 .3**   Consent of Prospective Director of Dale W. Tremblay dated September 22, 2005.
  99 .4**   Consent of Prospective Director of William D. Parker dated September 22, 2005.
 
  To be filed by amendment
  **  Previously filed
***  Filed herewith
  (b)  Financial Statement Schedules
                Schedule II — Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
Item 17. Undertakings.
      The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes:
      (1) That for purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act of 1933 shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.
      (2) That for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

II-3


Table of Contents

      (3) To provide to the underwriters at the closing specified in the underwriting agreement certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.
      (4) Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act of 1933 and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act of 1933 and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

II-4


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES
      Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant has duly caused this Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of San Antonio and State of Texas on October 24, 2005.
  CLEAR CHANNEL OUTDOOR HOLDINGS, INC.
  (Registrant)
  By:  /s/ Randall T. Mays
 
 
  Randall T. Mays
  Executive Vice President and
  Chief Financial Officer
      Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
             
Signature   Title   Date
         
 
*
 
Mark P. Mays
  Chief Executive Officer and Director
(Principal Executive Officer)
  October 24, 2005
 
/s/ Randall T. Mays
 
Randall T. Mays
  Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Director
(Principal Financial
and Accounting Officer)
  October 24, 2005
 
*
 
L. Lowry Mays
  Director   October 24, 2005
 
 
*By:   /s/ Randall T. Mays
 
Randall T. Mays
As Attorney-in-Fact
       

II-5


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT LIST
Exhibits and Financial Statements Schedules.
         
Exhibit    
Number   Exhibit Title
     
  1 .1*   Form of Underwriting Agreement.
  3 .1**   Form of Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  3 .2**   Form of Amended and Restated Bylaws of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  4 .1***   Form of Specimen Class A Common Stock certificate of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  4 .2***   Form of Specimen Class B Common Stock certificate of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  5 .1*   Opinion of Fulbright & Jaworski L.L.P.
 
  10 .1**   Form of Master Agreement between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
 
  10 .2**   Form of Registration Rights Agreement between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
 
  10 .3***   Form of Corporate Services Agreement between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Management Services, L.P.
 
  10 .4**   Form of Tax Matters Agreement by and between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
 
  10 .5**   Form of Employee Matters Agreement between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
 
  10 .6***   Form of Amended and Restated License Agreement between Clear Channel Identity, L.P. and Outdoor Management Services, Inc.
 
  10 .7**   Subordinated Promissory Note effective January 1, 2003, in the original principal amount of $1.39 billion.
 
  10 .8**   Subordinated Promissory Note effective January 1, 2003, in the original principal amount of $73.0 million.
 
  10 .9**   Senior Unsecured Term Promissory Note dated August 2, 2005 in the original principal amount of $2.5 billion.
 
  10 .10**   First Amendment to Senior Unsecured Term Promissory Note dated October 7, 2005.
  10 .11**   Form of 2005 Stock Incentive Plan of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  10 .12**   Form of 2006 Annual Incentive Plan of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  10 .13**   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement by and between Clear Channel Communications, Inc. and Mark P. Mays dated March 10, 2005 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. Form 10-K (Commission File No. 1-9645) filed March 11, 2005).
  10 .14**   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement by and between Clear Channel Communications, Inc. and Randall T. Mays dated March 10, 2005 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. Form 10-K (Commission File No. 1-9645) filed March 11, 2005).
  10 .15**   Employment Agreement by and between Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. and Paul J. Meyer dated August 5, 2005 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Clear Channel Communications, Inc. Form 8-K (Commission File No. 1-9645) filed August 10, 2005).
  15 .1***   Letter regarding unaudited interim financial information.
  21 .1**   Subsidiaries of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
  23 .1***   Form of Consent of Auditor.
 
  23 .2*   Consent of Fulbright & Jaworski L.L.P. (included in Exhibit 5.1).
 
  24 .1**   Powers of Attorney.
  99 .1***   Consent of Prospective Director of James M. Raines dated October 21, 2005.
  99 .2**   Consent of Prospective Director of Marsha M. Shields dated September 21, 2005.
  99 .3**   Consent of Prospective Director of Dale W. Tremblay dated September 22, 2005.
  99 .4**   Consent of Prospective Director of William D. Parker dated September 22, 2005.
 
  To be filed by amendment
  **  Previously filed
***  Filed herewith
 

Exhibit 4.1
(CLEARCHANNEL OUTDOOR STCK CRTFCT)
ClearChannel OUTDOOR SHARES NUMBER 660 INCORPORATED UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARE SEE REVERSE FOR CERTAIN DEFINITIONS CUSIP 18451C 10 9 THIS CERTIFIES THAT IS THE OWNER CLASS A COMMON STOCK PAR VALUE OF $0.01 PER SHARE FULLY PAID AND NONASSESSABLE SHARES OF THE COMMON STOCK OF HOLDINGS INC. TRANSFERRABLE ON THE BOOKS OF THE cORPORATION BY THE HOLDER HEREOF IN PERSON OR BY DULY AUTHORIZED ATTORNEY UPON SURRENDER OF THIS CERTIFICATE PROPERLY ENDORSED. THIS CERTIFICATE IS NOT VALID UNTIL COUNTERSIGNED BY THE TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTERED BY THE REGISTER WITNESS THE FACSIMILE SEAL OF THE CORPORATION AND THE FACSIMILE OF ITS DULY AUTHORIZED OFFICERS. DATED SEAL SECRETARY CHAIRMAN COUNTERSIGNED AND REGISTERED THE BANK OF NEW YORK TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR

 


 

CLEAR CHANNEL OUTDOOR HOLDINGS, INC.
     As stated in the bylaws of the Company, pursuant to the requirements of the Communications Act of 1934 as amended, if the stock records of the Company shall at any time reflect one-fifth alien ownership, no transfers of additional shares to or for the account of aliens shall be made and, if it shall thereafter be found that any such additional shares are in fact held by or for the account of an alien, such shares shall not be entitled to vote, receive dividends or to have any other rights, and the holder of such shares will be required to transfer them to a United States citizen or to the Company.
     The following abbreviations, when used in the inscription on the face of this certificate, shall be construed as though they were written out in full according to applicable laws or regulations:

         
TEN COM
    as tenants in common
TEN ENT
    as tenants by the entireties
JT TEN
    as joint tenants with right of survivorship and not as tenants in common
             
UNIF GIFT MIN ACT —
      Custodian    
 
           
 
  (Cust)       (Minor)
    under     Uniform     Gifts     to     Minors
 
  Act        
     
    (State)


Additional abbreviations may also be used though not in the above list.
     For value received,                                                hereby sell, assign and transfer unto
         
PLEASE INSERT SOCIAL SECURITY OR OTHER        
IDENTIFYING NUMBER OF ASSIGNEE        
 
       
 
 
Please print or typewrite name and address, including postal zip code, of assignee.
 
 
 
Shares of the Common Stock represented by the within Certificate, and do hereby irrevocably constitute and appoint
 
 
Attorney to transfer the said stock on the books of the within-named Corporation with full power of substitution in the premises.
         
Dated,
       
 
       

         
 
       
 
  NOTICE:    
 
  THE SIGNATURE(S) TO THIS ASSIGNMENT MUST CORRESPOND WITH THE NAME(S) AS WRITTEN UPON THE FACE OF THE CERTIFICATE IN EVERY PARTICULAR WITHOUT ALTERATION OR ENLARGEMENT OR ANY CHANGE WHATEVER.   è
     
 
X
 
 
 
 
 
(SIGNATURE)
 
 
 
 
 
X
 
 
 
 
 
(SIGNATURE)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
THE SIGNATURE(S) SHOULD BE GUARANTEED BY AN “ELIGIBLE GUARANTOR INSTITUTION” AS DEFINED IN RULE 17AD-15 UNDER THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934, AS AMENDED.
 
 
 
 
 
SIGNATURE(S) GUARANTEED BY:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 

 

EXHIBIT 4.2
(STOCK CERTIFICATE)
COPYRIGHT. 1930. BY DWIGHT & M. H. JACKSON CHICAGO PATENT PENDING
JT 1334 S-4
INCORPORATED UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARE
NUMBER SHARES
Class B Common Stock
CLEAR CHANNEL OUTDOOR HOLDINGS, INC.
AUTHORIZED CAPITAL SHARES $.01 PAR VALUE This Certifies That SPECIMEN is the Owner of ___fully paid and non-assessable
SHARES OF THE CAPITAL STOCK OF Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. transferable on the books of the Corporation in person or by duly authorized Attorney upon surrender of this Certificate properly endorsed.
In Witness Whereof, the said Corporation has caused this Certificate to be signed by its duly authorized officers and sealed with the Seal of the Corporation.
This ___day
of ___A.D. ___
SECRETARY
PRESIDENT
(c) DWIGHT & M.H. JACKSON 205 W. RANDOLPH STREET
DIV. OF
CORPORATION SUPPLY CO. CHICAGO, ILLINOIS 60606
SEE REVERSE SIDE FOR RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFER

 


 

For Value Received , ___hereby sell, assign and transfer unto                                                                                                          Shares represented by the within Certificate, and do hereby irrevocably constitute and appoint                                                                Attorney to transfer the said Shares on the books of the within named Corporation with full power of substitution in the premises.
         
Dated
       
 
       
 
  In Presence of    
 
       
 
       
     
NOTICE: THE SIGNATURE TO THIS ASSIGNMENT MUST CORRESPOND WITH THE NAME AS WRITTEN UPON THE FACE OF THE CERTIFICATE IN EVERY PARTICULAR, WITHOUT ALTERATION OR ENLARGEMENT, OR ANY CHANGE WHATEVER.
THE SHARES OF STOCK REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED, OR THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY STATE. SUCH SHARES MAY NOT BE SOLD OR TRANSFERRED EXCEPT UPON SUCH REGISTRATION OR UPON DELIVERY TO THE CORPORATION OF AN OPINION OF COUNSEL SATISFACTORY TO THE CORPORATION THAT REGISTRATION IS NOT REQUIRED FOR SUCH SALE OR TRANSFER.
THE SHARES OF CLASS B COMMON STOCK REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED TO ANY PERSON OR ENTITY IN CONNECTION WITH A TRANSACTION THAT IS NOT A “PERMITTED TRANSFER,” AS SUCH TERM IS DEFINED IN SECTION 3, PARAGRAPH (7)(C) OF ARTICLE IV OF THE CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION OF THIS CORPORATION. NO PERSON OR ENTITY WHO RECEIVES SUCH SHARES IN CONNECTION WITH A TRANSFER (OTHER THAN SUCH A “PERMITTED TRANSFER”) IS ENTITLED TO OWN OR TO BE REGISTERED AS THE RECORD HOLDER OF SUCH SHARES OF CLASS B COMMON STOCK, BUT THE RECORD HOLDER OF THIS CERTIFICATE MAY AT SUCH TIME AND IN THE MANNER SET FORTH IN SECTION 3, PARAGRAPH (6)(A) OF ARTICLE IV OF THE CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION CONVERT SUCH SHARES OF CLASS B COMMON STOCK INTO THE SAME NUMBER OF SHARES OF CLASS A COMMON STOCK FOR PURPOSES OF EFFECTING THE SALE OR OTHER DISPOSITION OF SUCH SHARES OF CLASS A COMMON STOCK TO ANY PERSON OR ENTITY. EACH HOLDER OF THIS CERTIFICATE, BY ACCEPTING THE SAME, ACCEPTS AND AGREES TO ALL OF THE FOREGOING.
     
 
THIS SPACE IS NOT TO BE

COVERED IN ANY WAY


 

 

 

Exhibit 10.3
CORPORATE SERVICES AGREEMENT
DATED                      , 2005
BETWEEN
CLEAR CHANNEL MANAGEMENT SERVICES, LP
AND
CLEAR CHANNEL OUTDOOR HOLDINGS, INC.

 


 

CORPORATE SERVICES AGREEMENT
     This CORPORATE SERVICES AGREEMENT, dated to be effective as of [                      ], 2005 (this “ Agreement ”), is made by and between Clear Channel Management Services, L.P., a Texas limited partnership (“ Management Services ”), and Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“ Outdoor ”). Management Services is indirectly wholly-owned by Clear Channel Communications, Inc., a Texas corporation (“ CCU ”), and as of the date hereof, Outdoor is an indirect, wholly-owned subsidiary of CCU. Certain capitalized terms used in this Agreement are defined in Section 1.1 and the definitions of the other capitalized terms used in this Agreement are cross-referenced in Section 1.2 .
W I T N E S S E T H:
     WHEREAS, CCU and Outdoor have entered into a Master Agreement, dated as of [                      ], 2005 (the “ Master Agreement ”), pursuant to which, among other things, CCU will separate its outdoor advertising and related businesses and operations from the other businesses and operations of CCU by contributing, assigning and transferring such businesses, operations and related assets and liabilities to Outdoor and its Subsidiaries, as set forth in the Master Agreement;
     WHEREAS, after the separation of the outdoor advertising and related businesses and operations from CCU by contribution, transfer and assignment to the Outdoor Group, it is contemplated that an initial public offering will be made of the class A common stock of Outdoor, resulting in partial public ownership of Outdoor;
     WHEREAS, after such separation and the initial public offering, both Outdoor and CCU desire for Management Services to provide certain administrative and support services and other assistance to the Outdoor Group in accordance with the terms and subject to the conditions set forth herein, and Management Services desires to provide, or cause to be provided by other members of the CCU Group, such services and assistance to the Outdoor Group;
     WHEREAS, because of the parent-subsidiary relationships among CCU, Outdoor and Management Services, the terms and conditions set forth herein have not resulted from arms length negotiations between the parties, and accordingly, such terms may be in some respects less favorable to Outdoor than those it could obtain from unaffiliated third parties;
     NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and the mutual agreements contained herein and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and adequacy of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:
ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS
      Section 1.1 Certain Defined Terms .
     The following capitalized terms used in this Agreement will have the meanings set forth below:

-1-


 

     “ Information Systems ” means computing, telecommunications or other digital operating or processing systems or environments, including, without limitation, computer programs, data, databases, computers, computer libraries, communications equipment, networks and systems. When referenced in connection with Services, Information Systems will mean the Information Systems accessed and/or used in connection with the Services.
     “ Intellectual Property ” means all of the following, whether protected, created or arising under the laws of the United States or any other foreign jurisdiction: (i) patents, patent applications (along with all patents issuing thereon), statutory invention registrations, divisions, continuations, continuations-in-part, substitute applications of the foregoing and any extensions, reissues, restorations and reexaminations thereof, and all rights therein provided by international treaties or conventions; (ii) copyrights, mask work rights, database rights and design rights, whether or not registered, published or unpublished, and registrations and applications for registration thereof, and all rights therein whether provided by international treaties or conventions or otherwise; (iii) trademarks, service marks, trade dress, logos and other identifiers of source, including all goodwill associated therewith and all common law rights, registrations and applications for registration thereof, and all rights therein provided by international treaties or conventions, and all reissues, extensions and renewals of any of the foregoing; (iv) intellectual property rights arising from or in respect of domain names, domain name registrations and reservations and URLs; (v) trade secrets; (vi) intellectual property rights arising from or in respect of Technology; and (vii) all other applications and registrations related to any of the intellectual property rights set forth in the foregoing clauses (i) through (vi) above.
     “ Provider ” means Management Services or another member of the CCU Group that is providing a Service pursuant to this Agreement.
     “ Recipient ” means Outdoor or another member of the Outdoor Group to whom a Service pursuant to this Agreement is being provided.
     “ Representative ” of a Person means any director, officer, employee, agent, consultant, accountant, auditor, financing source, attorney, investment banker or other representative of such Person.
     “ Service Termination Date ” means the effective date of the termination of this Agreement pursuant to Section 9.1 or such earlier scheduled termination date as may be specified in Schedule A or in Schedule D in respect of any specified Service.
     “ Software ” means the object and source code versions of computer programs and any associated documentation therefor.
     “ Tax Matters Agreement ” means the Tax Matters Agreement entered into pursuant to the Master Agreement and in substantially the form of Exhibit C to the Master Agreement.
     “ Technology ” means, collectively, all designs, formulas, algorithms, procedures, techniques, ideas, know-how, software, programs, models, routines, confidential and proprietary information, databases, tools, inventions, invention disclosures, creations, improvements, works of authorship, and all recordings, graphs, drawings, reports, analyses, other writings, and any other embodiment of the above, in any form, whether or not specifically listed herein.

-2-


 

     “ Trademark License ” means the Amended and Restated Trademark License Agreement entered into pursuant to the Master Agreement and in substantially the form of Exhibit E to the Master Agreement.
     “ Trigger Date ” means the first date on which members of the CCU Group cease to beneficially own more than fifty percent (50%) of the total voting power of Outdoor Common Stock.
     “ Undertakings ” means the obligations of the respective CCU and Outdoor Groups set forth in Article III .
      Section 1.2 Other Terms .
     For purposes of this Agreement, the following terms have the meanings set forth in the sections or agreements indicated.
     
Term   Section
 
   
Affiliate
  Master Agreement
After-Tax Basis
  Master Agreement
Agreement
  Preamble
Breaching Party
  Section 9.1(a)
CCU
  Preamble
CCU Confidential Information
  Master Agreement
CCU Executives
  Section 2.2
CCU Group
  Master Agreement
CCU Indemnified Parties
  Section 3.1(c)
CCU Services Manager
  Section 2.3
CCU Vendor Agreements
  Section 3.1(a)
Closing
  Master Agreement
Closing Date
  Master Agreement
Consents
  Section 5.2
Conversion Costs
  Section 5.3
Force Majeure
  Master Agreement
Group
  Master Agreement
Laws
  Master Agreement
Liabilities
  Master Agreement
Management Services
  Preamble
Master Agreement
  Recitals
Non-Breaching Party
  Section 9.1(a)

-3-


 

     
Term   Section
 
   
Other Costs
  Section 5.1(a)
Outdoor
  Preamble
Outdoor Business
  Master Agreement
Outdoor Common Stock
  Master Agreement
Outdoor Confidential Information
  Master Agreement
Outdoor Group
  Master Agreement
Outdoor Indemnified Parties
  Section 3.1(d)
Outdoor Services Manager
  Section 2.3
Outdoor Vendor Agreements
  Section 3.1(b)
Services
  Section 2.1(a)
Service Charges
  Section 5.1(a)
Standard for Services
  Section 6.1
Substitute Service
  Section 2.1(a)
Taxes
  Master Agreement
ARTICLE II
SERVICES AND TERMS
      Section 2.1 Services; Scope.
     (a) During the period commencing on the Closing Date and continuing until the earlier of the termination of this Agreement or an individual Service pursuant to Section 9.1 , subject to the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement, Management Services will provide, or will cause to be provided to the Outdoor Group, finance, information technology, human resources, legal services, management oversight and other general services of an administrative and/or advisory nature with respect to the Outdoor Business, as set forth on Schedule A (the “ Services ”), and Outdoor will, and will cause the other members of the Outdoor Group to, utilize such Services in the conduct of their respective businesses. The “Services” also will include (1) any Services to be provided by the CCU Group to the Outdoor Group as agreed pursuant to Section 10.3(a) , and (2) any Substitute Service; provided , however , that (i) the scope of each Service will be substantially the same as the scope of such service provided by the CCU Group to the Outdoor Group on the last day prior to the Closing in the ordinary course; (ii) the use of each Service by the Outdoor Group will include use by the Outdoor Group’s contractors in substantially the same manner as used by the contractors of the Outdoor Group prior to the Closing; and (iii) nothing in this Agreement will require that any Service be provided other than for use in, or in connection with, the Outdoor Business. Nothing in the preceding sentence or elsewhere in this Agreement will be deemed to restrict or otherwise limit the volume or quantity of any Service; provided , that , certain volume or quantity changes with respect to a Service may require the parties to negotiate in good faith and use their commercially reasonable efforts to agree upon a price change with respect to such Service. If, for any reason, Management Services is unable to provide any Service pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, Management Services will provide to the Outdoor Group a substantially equivalent service (a “ Substitute Service ”) at or below the cost for the substituted Service as set forth on Schedule A and otherwise in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, including the Standard for Services.

-4-


 

     (b) The Services will include, and the Service Charges reflect charges for, such maintenance, support, error correction, training, updates and enhancements normally and customarily provided by members of the CCU Group to other CCU Group members that receive such services. If Outdoor requests that Management Services provides a custom modification in connection with any Service, Outdoor will be responsible for the cost of such custom modification. The Services will include all functions, responsibilities, activities and tasks, and the materials, documentation, resources, rights and licenses to be used, granted or provided by the CCU Group that are not specifically described in this Agreement as a part of the Services, but are incidental to, and would normally be considered an inherent part of, or necessary subpart included within, the Services or are otherwise necessary for the CCU Group to provide, or the Outdoor Group to receive, the Services.
     (c) This Agreement will not assign any rights to Technology or Intellectual Property between the parties, other than as specifically set forth herein or in the Trademark License. Any upgrades, updates or other modifications to Software or other electronic content made available or delivered to the Outdoor Group pursuant to this Agreement will be deemed to be Intellectual Property of the CCU Group and licensed to the Outdoor Group, notwithstanding that such upgrades, updates or other modifications (i) were not used, held for use or contemplated to be used by the Outdoor Group as of the Closing Date, (ii) were not controlled by any member of the CCU Group as of the Closing Date, or (iii) may constitute improvements made after the Closing Date.
     (d) Throughout the term of this Agreement, the Provider and the Recipient of any Service will cooperate with one another and use their good faith, commercially reasonable efforts to effect the efficient, timely and seamless provision and receipt of such Service.
     (e) Any Software delivered by a Provider hereunder will be delivered, at the election of the Provider, either (i) with the assistance of the Provider, through electronic transmission or downloaded by the Recipient from the applicable intranet, or (ii) by installation by the Provider on the relevant equipment, with retention by the Provider of all tangible media on which such Software resides. The Provider and the Recipient acknowledge and agree that no tangible medium containing such Software (including any enhancements, upgrades or updates) will be transferred to the Recipient at any time for any reason under the terms of this Agreement, and that the Provider will, at all times, retain possession and control of any such tangible medium used or consumed by the Provider in the performance of this Agreement. Each party will comply with all reasonable security measures implemented by the other party in connection with the delivery of Software.
      Section 2.2 Executive Services .
     Until the earlier of the Trigger Date or termination of this Agreement in accordance with Section 9.1 , in conjunction with the provision of the Services, Management Services will make available to Outdoor, and Outdoor will utilize, the management oversight services of the executive officers of CCU referenced on Schedule A and from time to time as mutually agreed to by the parties, certain other officers of CCU (collectively, “ CCU Executives ”); provided , however , that Outdoor may terminate the provision of management oversight services by any particular executive officer of CCU at any time by providing notice of such termination to CCU,

-5-


 

such termination to be effective on the later of the date specified in the notice, if any, or the date that is six months after delivery of such notice. In rendering such services, until their resignation or the termination of Services as otherwise provided in this Section 2.2 , the Chief Executive Officer of CCU shall serve as the Chief Executive Officer of Outdoor, and the Chief Financial Officer of CCU shall serve as the Chief Financial Officer of Outdoor. The obligations of Management Services pursuant to this Section 2.2 will be subject to the reasonable demands imposed by, and the reasonable requirements of, the on-going operations of the CCU Group and the Outdoor Group, respectively.
      Section 2.3 Services Managers .
     Management Services will designate a dedicated services account manager (the “ CCU Services Manager ”) who will be directly responsible for coordinating and managing the delivery of the Services and will have authority to act on the CCU Group’s behalf with respect to the Services. Outdoor will designate a dedicated services account manager (the “ Outdoor Services Manager ”) who will be directly responsible for coordinating and managing the delivery of the Services and will have authority to act on the Outdoor Group’s behalf with respect to the Services. The CCU Services Manager and the Outdoor Services Manager will work together to address the Outdoor Group’s issues and the parties’ relationship under this Agreement.
      Section 2.4 Performance and Receipt of Services .
     Each of Management Services and Outdoor will, and will cause its respective Groups to, comply with the following provisions with respect to the Services:
     (a) Each Provider and Recipient will at all times comply with its own then in-force security guidelines and policies applicable to the performance, access and/or use of the Services and Information Systems.
     (b) Each Provider and Recipient will take commercially reasonable measures to ensure that no computer viruses or similar items are coded or introduced into the Services or Information Systems. If a computer virus is found to have been introduced into the Services or Information Systems, the parties hereto will use their commercially reasonable efforts to cooperate and to diligently work together to eliminate the effects of such computer virus.
     (c) Each Provider and Recipient will exercise reasonable care in providing and receiving the Services to (i) prevent access to the Services or Information Systems by unauthorized Persons, and (ii) not damage, disrupt or interrupt the Services or Information Systems.
      Section 2.5 WARRANTIES .
     THIS IS A SERVICE AGREEMENT. EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY STATED IN THIS AGREEMENT, THERE ARE NO EXPRESS WARRANTIES OR GUARANTIES, AND THERE ARE NO IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR GUARANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, TITLE AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.

-6-


 

ARTICLE III
OTHER ARRANGEMENTS
      Section 3.1 Vendor Agreements .
     (a) A member of the CCU Group is or may become a party to certain corporate purchasing contracts, master services agreements, vendor contracts, software and other Intellectual Property licenses or similar agreements unrelated to the Services (the “ CCU Vendor Agreements ”) under which (or under open work orders thereunder) the Outdoor Group purchases goods or services, licenses rights to use Intellectual Property and realizes certain other benefits and rights. Management Services agrees that prior to the Trigger Date, the Outdoor Group will continue to retain the right to purchase goods or services and continue to realize such other benefits and rights under each CCU Vendor Agreement to the extent allowed by such CCU Vendor Agreement until the expiration or termination date of such rights or benefits pursuant to the terms of such CCU Vendor Agreement (including, without limitation, any voluntary termination of such CCU Vendor Agreement by the CCU Group).
     (b) A member of the Outdoor Group is or may become a party to certain corporate purchasing contracts, master services agreements, vendor contracts, software and other Intellectual Property licenses or similar agreements unrelated to the Outdoor Services (the “ Outdoor Vendor Agreements ”) under which (or under open work orders thereunder) the CCU Group purchases goods or services, licenses rights to use Intellectual Property and realizes certain other benefits and rights. Outdoor agrees that prior to the Trigger Date, the CCU Group will continue to retain the right to purchase goods or services and continue to realize such other benefits and rights under each Outdoor Vendor Agreement to the extent allowed by such Outdoor Vendor Agreement until the expiration or termination date of such rights or benefits pursuant to the terms of such Outdoor Vendor Agreement (including, without limitation, any voluntary termination of such Outdoor Vendor Agreements by the Outdoor Group).
     (c) The Outdoor Group will indemnify, defend and hold harmless on an After-Tax Basis the CCU Group and each of their respective directors, officers and employees, and each of the heirs, executors, successors and assigns of any of the foregoing (collectively, the “ CCU Indemnified Parties ”), from and against any and all Liabilities of the CCU Indemnified Parties relating to, arising out of or resulting from the Outdoor Group purchasing goods or services, licensing rights to use Intellectual Property or otherwise realizing benefits and rights under any CCU Vendor Agreements.
     (d) The CCU Group will indemnify, defend and hold harmless on an After-Tax Basis the Outdoor Group and each of their respective directors, officers and employees, and each of the heirs, executors, successors and assigns of any of the foregoing (collectively, the “ Outdoor Indemnified Parties ”), from and against any and all Liabilities of the Outdoor Indemnified Parties relating to, arising out of or resulting from the CCU Group purchasing goods or services, licensing rights to use Intellectual Property or otherwise realizing benefits and rights under any Outdoor Vendor Agreements.

-7-


 

ARTICLE IV
ADDITIONAL AGREEMENTS
      Section 4.1 Leases .
     (a) Management Services and Outdoor agree that each lease or sublease listed on Schedule B , pursuant to which any member of the Outdoor Group leases or subleases real property from any member of the CCU Group, will remain in full force and effect pursuant to its terms unless otherwise agreed to in writing by the parties.
     (b) Management Services and Outdoor agree that each lease or sublease listed on Schedule C , pursuant to which any member of the CCU Group leases or subleases real property from any member of the Outdoor Group, will remain in full force and effect pursuant to its terms unless otherwise agreed to in writing by the parties.
      Section 4.2 Computer-Based Resources .
     (a) Management Services and Outdoor agree that (i) prior to the Trigger Date, the Outdoor Group will continue to have access to the Information Systems of the CCU Group, and (ii) on and after the Trigger Date, the Outdoor Group will not have access to all or any part of the Information Systems of the CCU Group, except to the extent necessary for the Outdoor Group to receive the Services (subject to the Outdoor Group complying with all reasonable security measures implemented by the CCU Group as deemed necessary by the CCU Group to protect its Information Systems; provided , that , the Outdoor Group has had a commercially reasonable period of time in which to comply with such security measures).
     (b) Management Services and Outdoor agree that (i) prior to the Trigger Date, the CCU Group will continue to have access to the Information Systems of the Outdoor Group, and (ii) on and after the Trigger Date, the CCU Group will not have access to all or any part of the Information Systems of the Outdoor Group, except to the extent necessary for the CCU Group to perform the Services (subject to the CCU Group complying with all reasonable security measures implemented by the Outdoor Group as deemed necessary by the Outdoor Group to protect its Information Systems; provided , that , the CCU Group has had a commercially reasonable period of time in which to comply with such security measures).
      Section 4.3 Access .
     Outdoor will allow the CCU Group and its Representatives reasonable access to the facilities of the Outdoor Group necessary for the performance of the Services and to enable the CCU Group and to fulfill its obligations under this Agreement.
ARTICLE V
COSTS AND DISBURSEMENTS; PAYMENTS
      Section 5.1 Service Charges .
     (a)  Schedule A sets forth with respect to each Service a description of the charges for such Service or the basis for the determination thereof (the “ Service Charges ”). Further, in

-8-


 

connection with performance of the Services and in connection with the Undertakings, the Provider will make payments for the benefit of and on behalf of the Recipient and will incur out-of-pocket costs and expenses (collectively, the “ Other Costs ”), which will be reimbursed to the Provider by the Recipient; provided , that , any Other Costs will only be payable by the Recipient if it receives from the Provider reasonably detailed data and other documentation sufficient to support the calculation of amounts due to the Provider as a result of such Other Costs.
     (b) (i) Prior to the Trigger Date, Management Services and Outdoor will arrange for the payment of all Service Costs and Other Charges in a manner consistent with past practices for similar services provided by the CCU Group to the Outdoor Group prior to the date hereof. The Recipient will have the right to dispute any Service Charges and Other Costs by delivering written notice of such dispute, setting forth in reasonable detail the basis therefor, to the Provider within, and no later than, 60 days after notice of billing. As soon as practicable after receipt of any such notice, the Provider will provide the Recipient with reasonably detailed data and documentation sufficient to support the calculation of any Service Charges and Other Costs that are the subject of the dispute. If the Provider’s furnishing of such information does not promptly resolve such dispute, the dispute will be resolved pursuant to Section 8.2 .
          (i) From and after the Trigger Date, the Provider will deliver an invoice to the Recipient on a monthly basis (or at such other frequency as is set forth on Schedule A ) in arrears for the Service Charges and any Other Costs. The Recipient will pay the amount of such invoice to the Provider in U.S. dollars within 30 days of the date of such invoice, provided , that , to the extent consistent with past practice with respect to Services rendered outside the United States, payments may be made in local currency. If the Recipient fails to pay such amount (excluding any amount contested in good faith) by such date, the Recipient will be obligated to pay to the Provider, in addition to the amount due, interest on such amount at the lesser of (i) the three month London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR) plus 100 basis points or (ii) the maximum rate of interest allowed by applicable law, from the date the payment was due through the date of payment. As soon as practicable after receipt by the Provider of any reasonable written request by the Recipient, the Provider will provide the Recipient with reasonably detailed data and documentation sufficient to support the calculation of any amount due to the Provider under this Agreement for the purpose of verifying the accuracy of such calculation. If, after reviewing such data and documentation, the Recipient disputes the Provider’s calculation of any amount due to the Provider, then the dispute will be resolved pursuant to Section 8.2 .
      Section 5.2 Consents .
     Management Services and Outdoor acknowledge and agree that certain Software and other licenses, consents, approvals, notices, registrations, recordings, filings and other actions (collectively, “ Consents ”) may be required by Management Services, Outdoor or members of their respective Groups in connection with the provision of the Services. With respect to each Service, the Recipient will, after consultation with the Provider, either directly pay the out-of-pocket expenses incurred to obtain, perform or otherwise satisfy each such Consent or after any such Consent is obtained, performed or otherwise satisfied, reimburse the Provider for all actual, out-of-pocket costs incurred by the Provider and related to such Consent. Prior to payment of, or reimbursement for, such out-of-pocket expenses, the Provider will provide the Recipient with an invoice accompanied by reasonably detailed data and documentation sufficient to evidence the

-9-


 

out-of-pocket expenses for which the Provider is seeking payment or reimbursement. Upon receipt of such invoice and data and documentation, the Recipient will either pay the amount of such invoice directly in accordance with its general payment terms with vendors or reimburse the Provider for its payment of the invoice within 30 days of the date of its receipt of such invoice. If the Recipient disputes the invoiced amount, then the parties will work together to resolve such dispute. If the parties are unable to resolve such dispute, the dispute will be resolved pursuant to Section 8.2 . Management Services and Outdoor acknowledge and agree that no prior approval of the Recipient will be required for the Provider to seek any reimbursement pursuant to this Section 5.2 .
      Section 5.3 Conversion Costs .
     Management Services and Outdoor acknowledge and agree that in connection with the implementation, provision, receipt and transition of the Services, there will be certain nonrecurring, out-of-pocket conversion costs incurred by Management Services, Outdoor and their respective Groups (“ Conversion Costs ”). With respect to each Service, the Recipient of the Service will either reimburse the Provider as incurred for all actual, out-of-pocket Conversion Costs incurred by the Provider and related to such Service or, after consultation with the Provider, pay such Conversion Costs directly on an as-incurred basis, in either case regardless of whether the Recipient replaces such Service with the same application, system, vendor or other means of effecting the Service. Prior to payment of, or reimbursement for, such actual out-of-pocket Conversion Costs, the Provider will provide the Recipient with an invoice accompanied by reasonably detailed data and documentation sufficient to evidence the out-of-pocket expenses for which the Provider is seeking payment or reimbursement. Upon receipt of such invoice and data and documentation, the Recipient will either pay the amount of such invoice directly in accordance with its general payment terms with vendors or reimburse the Provider for its payment of the invoice within 30 days of the date of its receipt of such invoice. If the Recipient disputes the invoiced amount, then the dispute will be resolved pursuant to Section 8.2 . Management Services and Outdoor acknowledge and agree that no prior approval will be required from the Recipient for the Provider to seek any reimbursement for Conversion Costs pursuant to this Section 5.3 .
ARTICLE VI
STANDARD FOR SERVICE; COMPLIANCE WITH LAWS
      Section 6.1 Standard for Service .
     Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement (including in Schedule A ), Management Services agrees that the Provider will perform the Services such that the nature, quality, standard of care and the service levels at which such Services are performed are no less than the nature, quality, standard of care and service levels at which the substantially same services were provided to the members of the Outdoor Group by or on behalf of the Provider on the last day prior to the Closing Date in the ordinary course (the “ Standard for Services ”).

-10-


 

      Section 6.2 Compliance with Laws .
     Each of Management Services and Outdoor will be responsible for its, and its respective Group’s, compliance with any and all Laws applicable to its performance under this Agreement; provided , however , that each of Management Services and Outdoor will, subject to reimbursement of out-of-pocket expenses by the requesting party, use commercially reasonable efforts to cooperate and provide the other party with all reasonably requested assistance (including, without limitation, the execution of documents and the provision of relevant information) to ensure compliance with all applicable Laws in connection with any regulatory action, requirement, inquiry or examination related to this Agreement or the Services.
ARTICLE VII
INDEMNIFICATION; LIMITATION ON LIABILITY
      Section 7.1 Limited Liability of a Provider .
     Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 6.1 , none of Management Services, any other members of the CCU Group, their respective Affiliates or any of their respective directors, officers or employees, or any of the heirs, executors, successors or assigns of any of the foregoing (each, a “ Provider Indemnified Party ”), will have any liability in contract, tort or otherwise, including for any such party’s ordinary or contributory negligence, to the Recipient or its Affiliates or Representatives for or in connection with (i) any Services rendered or to be rendered by any Provider Indemnified Party pursuant to this Agreement, (ii) the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, or (iii) any Provider Indemnified Party’s actions or inactions in connection with any such Services or transactions; provided , however , that such limitation on liability will not extend to or otherwise limit any Liabilities that have resulted directly from such Provider Indemnified Party’s (a) gross negligence or willful misconduct, (b) improper use or disclosure of information of, or regarding, a customer or potential customer of a Recipient Indemnified Party or (c) violation of applicable Law.
      Section 7.2 Indemnification by Each Provider .
     Management Services will, and will cause each Provider to indemnify, defend and hold harmless each relevant Recipient and each of its Subsidiaries and each of their respective directors, officers and employees, and each of the heirs, executors, successors and assigns of any of the foregoing (each, a “ Recipient Indemnified Party ”), from and against any and all Liabilities of the Recipient Indemnified Parties relating to, arising out of, or resulting from (a) the gross negligence or willful misconduct of a Provider Indemnified Party in connection with such Provider Indemnified Party’s provision of the Services, (b) the improper use or improper disclosure of information of, or regarding, a customer or potential customer of a Recipient Indemnified Party in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or such Provider Indemnified Party’s provision of the Services, or (c) any violation of applicable Law by a Provider Indemnified Party in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or such Provider Indemnified Party’s provision of the Services; provided , that , the aggregate liability of the CCU Group as Providers pursuant to this Article VII will in no event exceed an amount equal to the aggregate payments made by the Recipients to the Providers for Services pursuant to this Agreement for the 12 month period preceding the date of such event giving rise to indemnification hereunder.

-11-


 

      Section 7.3 Indemnification by Each Recipient .
     Outdoor will, and will cause each member of the Outdoor Group to, indemnify, defend and hold harmless each relevant Provider Indemnified Party from and against any and all Liabilities of the Provider Indemnified Parties relating to, arising out of, or resulting from the provision of the Services by any Provider or any of its Affiliates, except for (a) any Liabilities that result from a Provider Indemnified Party’s gross negligence in connection with the provision of the Services, and (b) any Liabilities that result from a Provider Indemnified Party’s material breach of this Agreement.
      Section 7.4 Indemnification Matters; Exclusivity .
     The indemnification provisions set forth in Sections 5.6 through 5.8 of the Master Agreement are hereby incorporated into, and made a part of, this Article VII , Sections 3.1(c) and 3.1(d) and as otherwise applicable to this Agreement. The provisions of this Article VII will constitute the sole and exclusive remedy for Liabilities arising under this Agreement, other than Liabilities arising under Sections 3.1(c) and 3.1(d) .
      Section 7.5 Limitation on Liability .
      Notwithstanding any other provision contained in this Agreement, Management Services and Outdoor agree on their behalf, and on behalf of their respective Groups, that no member of the CCU Group on the one hand, and no member of the Outdoor Group, on the other hand, will be liable to any member of the other Group, whether based on contract, tort (including negligence), warranty or any other legal or equitable grounds, for any special, indirect, punitive, incidental or consequential losses, damages or expenses of the other Group, including, without limitation, loss of data, loss of profits, interest or revenue, or use or interruption of business, arising from any claim relating to breach of this Agreement or otherwise relating to any of the Services or Undertakings provided hereunder . For clarification purposes only, the parties hereto agree that the limitation on liability contained in this Section 7.5 will not apply to (a) damages awarded to a third party pursuant to a third party claim for which a Provider is required to indemnify, defend and hold harmless any Recipient Indemnified Party under Section 7.2 ; (b) damages awarded to a third party pursuant to a third party claim for which a Recipient is required to indemnify, defend and hold harmless any Provider Indemnified Party under Section 7.3 ; (c) damages awarded to a third party pursuant to a third party claim for which the Outdoor Group is required to indemnify, defend and hold harmless any CCU Indemnified Party under Section 3.1(c) ; and (d) damages awarded to a third party pursuant to a third party claim for which the CCU Group is required to indemnify, defend and hold harmless any Outdoor Indemnified Party under Section 3.1(d) .
      Section 7.6 Liability for Payment Obligations .
     Nothing in this Article VII will be deemed to eliminate or limit, in any respect, any member of the CCU Group’s or any member of the Outdoor Group’s express obligation in this Agreement to pay or reimburse, as applicable, for (a) Service Charges; (b) Other Costs;

-12-


 

(c) amounts payable or reimbursable with respect to any custom modification provided pursuant to Section 2.1(b) ; (d) any amounts payable or reimbursable pursuant to the terms of the leases referred to in Section 4.1 ; (e) any amounts payable or reimbursable pursuant in respect of the Consents pursuant to Section 5.2 ; (f) amounts payable or reimbursable in respect of Conversion Costs pursuant to Section 5.3 ; (g) amounts payable or reimbursable pursuant to Section 6.2 with respect to compliance with Laws; (h) amounts payable or reimbursable pursuant to Section 10.3(b) with respect to books and records; and (i) amounts payable or reimbursable pursuant to Section 10.6 with respect to Taxes.
ARTICLE VIII
DISPUTE RESOLUTION
      Section 8.1 Applicable Law .
     This Agreement will be governed by, and construed and interpreted in accordance with, the laws of the State of Texas, without giving effect to any conflicts of law rule or principle that might require the application of the laws of another jurisdiction.
      Section 8.2 Dispute Resolution .
     To the extent not resolved through discussions between the CCU Services Manager and the Outdoor Services Manager, any dispute, controversy or claim arising out of, or relating to, this Agreement will be resolved in accordance with Article VII of the Master Agreement, which dispute resolution provisions are hereby incorporated into, and made a part of, this Section 8.2 .
ARTICLE IX
TERMINATION
      Section 9.1 Termination .
     (a) This Agreement may be terminated (1) after the Trigger Date by either Management Services or Outdoor upon no less than six months’ prior written notice; provided, however , after the Trigger Date, Management Services will continue to provide, and Outdoor will utilize, and will cause the other members of the Outdoor Group to utilize, the Services identified on Schedule D for the applicable time periods after the Trigger Date set forth in Schedule D , and therefore (A) the effective date of such termination of this Agreement must be no earlier than the latest date provided on Schedule D for the provision of Services, (B) the effective date of termination of individual Services specified on Schedule D must be no earlier than the date provided on Schedule D for such individual Service, and (C) all other Services that are not specified on Schedule D will terminate upon the effective termination date provided in such written notice, or (2) at any time upon mutual agreement of Management Services and Outdoor. Notwithstanding the foregoing, with respect to specific Services provided hereunder, (i) either party hereto (the “ Non-Breaching Party ”) may terminate this Agreement with respect to any individual Service, in whole but not in part, at any time upon prior written notice by the Non-Breaching Party to the other party (the “ Breaching Party ”) if the Breaching Party (including any member of its respective Group) has failed to perform any of its material obligations under this Agreement relating to such Service, and such failure will have continued without cure for a period of 60 days after receipt by the Breaching Party of a written notice of such failure from the

-13-


 

Non-Breaching Party seeking to terminate such Service; provided , however , that no Service may be terminated pursuant to this clause (i) until the parties have completed the dispute resolution process set forth in Section 8.2 with respect to such Service; (ii) Management Services and Outdoor may from time to time mutually agree to terminate any individual Service, in whole but not in part, provided , that , any such agreement to terminate a Service will comply with Section 10.10 and include all terms and conditions applicable to termination of the Service to be terminated and (iii) as provided in Section 2.2 , Outdoor may terminate the provision of management oversight services by any particular executive officer of CCU at any time by providing notice of such termination to CCU, such termination to be effective on the later of the date specified in the notice, if any, or the date that is six months after delivery of such notice. Any such termination of an individual Service will not in any way affect the obligations of the party terminating such Service to continue to receive all other Services not so terminated and to continue to provide Services as required by this Agreement.
     (b) In addition to and not in limitation of the rights and obligations set forth in Section 2.1(d) , upon the request of the Recipient of a Service, (i) the Provider of such Service will cooperate with the Recipient and use its good faith, commercially reasonable efforts to assist the transition of such Service to the Recipient (or Affiliate of the Recipient or such third-party vendor designated by the Recipient) by the Service Termination Date for such Service.
      Section 9.2 Effect of Termination .
     Upon termination or expiration of any Service or Undertaking pursuant to this Agreement, the relevant Provider will have no further obligation to provide the terminated Service or expired Undertaking, and the relevant Recipient will have no obligation to pay any future Service Charges or Other Costs relating to any such Service or Undertaking (other than for or in respect of Services or Undertakings provided in accordance with the terms of this Agreement and received by such Recipient prior to such termination). Upon termination of this Agreement in accordance with its terms, no Provider will have any further obligation to provide any Service or Undertaking, and no Recipient will have any obligation to pay any Service Charges or Other Costs relating to any Service or Undertaking or make any other payments under this Agreement (other than for or in respect of Services or Undertakings received by such Recipient prior to such termination).
      Section 9.3 Survival .
     Each of Section 4.1 (Leases), Section 4.2 (Computer-Based Resources), Article V (Costs and Disbursements), Article VII (Indemnification; Limitation on Liability), Article VIII (Dispute Resolution), Section 9.2 (Effect of Termination), this Section 9.3 (Survival), and Article X (General Provisions) will survive the expiration or other termination of this Agreement and remain in full force and effect.
      Section 9.4 Force Majeure .
     No party hereto (or any member of its Group or any other Person acting on its behalf) will have any liability or responsibility for failure to fulfill any obligation (other than a payment obligation) under this Agreement so long as and to the extent to which the fulfillment of such

-14-


 

obligation is prevented, frustrated, hindered or delayed as a consequence of circumstances of Force Majeure. A party claiming the benefit of this provision will, as soon as reasonably practicable after the occurrence of any such event: (a) notify the other party of the nature and extent of any such Force Majeure condition and (b) use commercially reasonable efforts to remove any such causes and resume performance under this Agreement as soon as feasible.
ARTICLE X
GENERAL PROVISIONS
      Section 10.1 Independent Contractors .
     In providing Services hereunder, the Provider will act solely as independent contractor and nothing in this Agreement will constitute or be construed to be or create a partnership, joint venture, or principal/agent relationship between the Provider, on the one hand, and the Recipient, on the other. All Persons employed by the Provider in the performance of its obligations under this Agreement will be the sole responsibility of the Provider.
      Section 10.2 Subcontractors .
     Any Provider may hire or engage one or more subcontractors to perform any or all of its Services; provided , that , Management Services will in all cases remain responsible for all its obligations under this Agreement, including, without limitation, with respect to the scope of the Services, the Standard for Services and the content of the Services provided to the Recipient. Under no circumstances will any Recipient be responsible for making any payments directly to any subcontractor engaged by a Provider.
      Section 10.3 Additional Services; Books and Records .
     (a) If, during the term of this Agreement, a party hereto identifies a need for additional or other corporate services to be provided by or on behalf of Management Services, the parties hereto agree to negotiate in good faith to provide such requested services (provided that such services are of a type generally provided by the CCU Group at such time) and the applicable service fees, payment procedures, and other rights and obligations with respect thereto. To the extent practicable, such additional or other services will be provided on terms substantially similar to those applicable to Services of similar types and otherwise on terms consistent with those contained in this Agreement.
     (b) All books, records and data maintained by a Provider for a Recipient with respect to the provision of a Service will be the exclusive property of such Recipient. The Recipient, at its sole cost and expense, will have the right to inspect, and make copies of, any such books, records and data during regular business hours upon reasonable advance notice to the Provider. At the sole cost and expense of the Provider, upon termination of the provision of any Service, the relevant books, records and data relating to such terminated Service will be delivered by the Provider to the Recipient in a mutually agreed upon format to the address of Outdoor set forth in Section 10.5 or any other mutually agreed upon location; provided , however , that the Provider will be entitled to retain one copy of all such books, records and data relating to such terminated Service for archival purposes and for purposes of responding to any dispute that may arise with respect thereto.

-15-


 

      Section 10.4 Confidential Information .
     Outdoor agrees to, and will cause the other members of the Outdoor Group to, maintain and safeguard all the Information pursuant to Section 6.2 of the Master Agreement and Management Services agrees to, and will cause the other members of the CCU Group to, maintain and safeguard all Outdoor Confidential Information pursuant to Section 6.2 of the Master Agreement, and each party hereto agrees that Section 6.2 of the Master Agreement is hereby incorporated by reference into, and made a part of, this Agreement.
      Section 10.5 Notices .
     All notices, requests, claims, demands and other communications under this Agreement will be in writing and will be given or made (and will be deemed to have been duly given or made upon receipt) by delivery in person, by overnight courier service, by facsimile with receipt confirmed (followed by delivery of an original via overnight courier service) or by registered or certified mail (postage prepaid, return receipt requested) to the respective parties at the following addresses (or at such other address for a party as will be specified in a notice given in accordance with this Section 10.5 ):
     If to any member of the CCU Group:
     
Clear Channel Management Services, LP
 
   
 
 
   
 
Attention:
   
 
   
Facsimile:
   
 
   
     If to any member of the Outdoor Group:
     
Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
 
   
 
 
   
 
Attention:
   
 
   
Facsimile:
   
 
   
      Section 10.6 Taxes . Except as otherwise specifically provided for in the Tax Matters Agreement:
     (a) Each party will be responsible for any personal property Taxes on property it owns or leases, for franchise and privilege Taxes on its business, and for Taxes based on its net income or gross receipts.
     (b) Each Recipient may report and (as appropriate) pay any sales, use, excise, value-added, services, consumption, and other Taxes directly if the Recipient provides the applicable Provider with a direct pay or exemption certificate.

-16-


 

     (c) A Provider will promptly notify the applicable Recipient of, and coordinate with the Recipient the response to and settlement of, any claim for Taxes asserted by applicable taxing authorities for which the Recipient is alleged to be financially responsible hereunder.
     (d) Each Recipient will be entitled to receive and to retain any refund of Taxes paid to a Provider pursuant to this Agreement. In the event a Provider receives a refund of any Taxes paid by a Recipient to the Provider, the Provider will promptly pay, or cause the payment of, such refund to the Recipient.
     (e) Each of the parties hereto agrees that if reasonably requested by the other party, it will cooperate with such other party to enable the accurate determination of such other party’s Tax liability and assist such other party in minimizing its Tax liability to the extent legally permissible. The Provider’s invoices will separately state the amounts of any Taxes the Provider is proposing to collect from the Recipient.
      Section 10.7 Severability .
     If any term or other provision of this Agreement is invalid, illegal or incapable of being enforced under any Law or as a matter of public policy, all other conditions and provisions of this Agreement will nevertheless remain in full force and effect. Upon such determination that any term or other provision is invalid, illegal or incapable of being enforced, the parties hereto will negotiate in good faith to modify this Agreement so as to effect the original intent of the parties hereto as closely as possible in a mutually acceptable manner in order that the transactions contemplated by this Agreement be consummated as originally contemplated to the greatest extent possible.
      Section 10.8 Entire Agreement .
     Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, this Agreement constitutes the entire agreement of the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter of this Agreement and supersedes all prior agreements and undertakings, both written and oral, between or on behalf of the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter of this Agreement. The Schedules and Recitals to this Agreement are hereby incorporated by reference into and made part of this Agreement for all purposes.
      Section 10.9 Assignment; No Third-Party Beneficiaries .
     This Agreement will not be assigned by any party hereto without the prior written consent of the other party hereto; provided , however , Management Services may assign this Agreement in connection with a merger, consolidation, reorganization, sale of all or substantially all of its assets or similar transaction within the CCU Group whether or not Management Services is the surviving entity. Except as provided in Article III and Article VII with respect to indemnified parties, this Agreement is for the sole benefit of the parties to this Agreement, the members of their respective Group and their permitted successors and assigns and nothing in this Agreement, express or implied, is intended to or will confer upon any other Person any legal or equitable right, benefit or remedy of any nature whatsoever under or by reason of this Agreement. Outdoor will cause each member of the Outdoor Group receiving Services hereunder as a Recipient to abide by the terms and conditions of this Agreement, and

-17-


 

Management Services will cause each member of the CCU Group providing Services hereunder as a Provider to abide by the terms and conditions of this Agreement.
      Section 10.10 Amendment .
     No provision of this Agreement may be amended or modified except by a written instrument signed by all the parties to such agreement. No waiver by any party of any provision hereof will be effective unless explicitly set forth in writing and executed by the party so waiving. The waiver by either party hereto of a breach of any provision of this Agreement will not operate or be construed as a waiver of any other subsequent breach.
      Section 10.11 Rules of Construction .
     (a) Interpretation of this Agreement will be governed by the following rules of construction: (i) words in the singular will be held to include the plural and vice versa and words of one gender will be held to include the other gender as the context requires, (ii) references to the terms Article, Section, paragraph, and Schedule are references to the Articles, Sections, paragraphs, and Schedules to this Agreement unless otherwise specified, (iii) the word “including” and words of similar import will mean “including, without limitation,” (iv) provisions will apply, when appropriate, to successive events and transactions, (v) the headings contained herein are for reference purposes only and will not affect in any way the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement, (vi) the recitals are and (vii) this Agreement will be construed without regard to any presumption or rule requiring construction or interpretation against the party drafting or causing any instrument to be drafted.
     (b) Unless specifically stated in the Master Agreement that a particular provision of the Master Agreement should be given effect in lieu of a conflicting provision in this Agreement, to the extent that any provision contained in this Agreement conflicts with, or cannot logically be read in accordance with, any provision of the Master Agreement, the provision contained in this Agreement will prevail.
     (c) Unless specifically stated in the Schedules to this Agreement, to the extent that any provision contained in this Agreement conflicts with, or cannot logically be read in accordance with, any provision of a Schedule to this Agreement the provision contained in such Schedule will prevail.
      Section 10.12 Counterparts .
     This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts, and by the different parties to each such agreement in separate counterparts, each of which when executed will be deemed to be an original but all of which taken together will constitute one and the same agreement. Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page to this Agreement by facsimile or electronic mail will be as effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart of any such Agreement.

-18-


 

      Section 10.13 No Right to Set-Off.
     Outdoor will, and will cause each other Recipient to, pay the full amount of costs and disbursements, including Other Costs, incurred under this Agreement, and will not set-off, counterclaim or otherwise withhold any other amount owed to a Provider on account of any obligation owed by a Provider to a Recipient.
[ SIGNATURE PAGE FOLLOWS ]

-19-


 

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have caused this Corporate Services Agreement to be executed to be effective on the date first written above by their respective duly authorized officers.
                 
    CLEAR CHANNEL MANAGEMENT SERVICES, LP
 
               
 
               
 
  By:   [       ],
 
               
        its General Partner
 
               
 
               
 
  By:            
         
 
  Name:            
         
 
  Title:            
         
 
               
    CLEAR CHANNEL OUTDOOR HOLDINGS, INC.
 
               
 
               
 
  By:            
         
 
  Name:            
         
 
  Title:            
         

S-1


 

SCHEDULES
         
Schedule A
    Services
 
       
Schedule B
    Leased Facilities (CCU Group as Lessor)
 
       
Schedule C
    Leased Facilities (Outdoor Group as Lessor)
 
       
Schedule D
    Mandatory Services Post Trigger Date

 

 

Exhibit 10.6
AMENDED AND RESTATED
LICENSE AGREEMENT
     This Amended and Restated License Agreement (this “Agreement”) is made and entered into as of ___, 2005, by and between Clear Channel Identity, L.P., a Texas limited partnership, whose principal place of business is located at 200 E. Basse Road, San Antonio, Texas 78209 (“Owner”), and Outdoor Management Services, Inc., a Nevada corporation, whose principal place of business is located at 200 E. Basse Road, San Antonio, Texas 78209 (“Licensee”).
W I T N E S S E T H :
     WHEREAS, Owner and Licensee entered into that certain License Agreement as of January 1, 2003 (the “Original Agreement”);
     WHEREAS, Owner and Licensee are each indirect, wholly-owned subsidiaries of Clear Channel Communications, Inc. (“CCU”), and CCU is in the process of strategically realigning its businesses;
     WHEREAS, in connection with such strategic realignment, the parties desire to, and do hereby, amend and restate the Original Agreement with this Agreement;
     WHEREAS, Owner is the exclusive owner of all right, title and interest in and to all tradenames, trademarks, service marks, common law marks, applications therefor and other rights (the “Marks”) used by Owner including, without limitation, the Marks described in Exhibit A attached hereto and incorporated herein;
     WHEREAS, the Marks have achieved widespread recognition among members of the general public; and
     WHEREAS, it is the desire and intention of the parties that Licensee be permitted to use, throughout the Territory (as hereinafter defined), the Marks, together with such other trademarks, service marks and trade names owned and identified from time to time by Owner and accepted for license by Licensee;
     NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the promises and mutual obligations set forth herein and other good and valuable consideration, Owner and Licensee hereby agree as follows:
     1.  License . Subject to the terms of this Agreement, Owner hereby grants to Licensee a non-exclusive license to use the Marks as well as such other trademarks, service marks and trade names owned and identified from time to time by Owner and accepted for license by Licensee (the “License”). The parties agree that Exhibit A automatically shall be amended to include all of the Marks that Owner adopts in the Territory (as defined herein) and identifies to Licensee and that Licensee accepts for license under this Agreement. The parties further agree that Exhibit A automatically shall

1


 

be amended to include all Marks listed in any trademark or service mark application Owner may file as well as such other Marks agreed to by Owner and Licensee. Licensee shall use and may license others to use the Marks in connection with its outdoor advertising business operations in the Territory but shall not use the Marks on other goods or services unless otherwise agreed to by Owner.
     2.  Territory . The territory of the License shall encompass the area contained within the geographic bounds of the United States (the “Territory”); provided , however , that the License granted to Licensee hereunder entitles Licensee to use the Marks on the Internet in connection with its normal business operations.
     3.  Royalty Fee . Licensee shall pay Owner for the use of the Marks pursuant the amount as set forth on Exhibit B attached hereto. The amount owed by Licensee shall accrue throughout the fiscal year and shall be paid quarterly as follows: Within thirty (30) days after the end of Owner’s fiscal quarter, Licensee shall pay to Owner the total amount owed by Licensee to Owner for the use of the licensed property under this Agreement during such fiscal quarter, with a credit against such payment for any amounts owed by Owner to Licensee for such fiscal quarter.
     4.  Records . Licensee shall keep books of account containing accurate and complete records of all data necessary for the determination of the amounts payable to Owner under this Agreement. Such records shall be open for inspection, copying and audit by a designated representative of Owner at any time during the regular business hours of Licensee, provided that reasonable notice is given to Licensee.
     5.  Specification and Quality Assurance . Licensee agrees that all products and services which Licensee offers under the Marks shall be of high quality, and shall be rendered in accordance with such specifications and standards as may be communicated by Owner to Licensee from time to time. All advertising, promotion and other use of the Marks will be in good taste and in such manner as will maintain and enhance the value of the Marks and the reputation for high quality associated with the Marks. Licensee agrees to change any use of the Marks or any proposed use of the Marks of which Owner does not approve. Licensee shall comply with all applicable federal, state and regulatory laws concerning products and services offered under the Marks.
     6.  Acknowledgments by Licensee .
          (a) Licensee acknowledges that Owner has exclusive right in and to the Marks and will not at any time do or cause to be done any act or thing contesting or in any way impairing or tending to impair any part of such right. All use of the Marks by Licensee will inure to the benefit of Owner.
          (b) Licensee shall not in any manner represent that it has any ownership in the Marks or the registration thereof.

2


 

     7.  Term . Unless otherwise terminated in accordance with the terms hereof, this Agreement shall commence as of the date hereof and shall continue for a period of one (1) year; provided that this Agreement shall automatically renew for additional one (1) year periods unless either party gives notice of its election to terminate this Agreement at least ninety (90) days before the end of any one-year period.
     8.  Termination .
          (a) In the event of a breach by Licensee of any provision of this Agreement, Owner may give Licensee notice in writing of the breach. Licensee shall have a period of sixty (60) days from the date such notice is received to cure the breach specified therein, and if the breach is not cured within such period or Licensee notifies Owner of its intention not to cure such breach, then Owner shall be entitled to terminate this Agreement and exercise any other rights or remedies it may have hereunder or as otherwise provided by law; provided , however , that if such breach is not curable, for whatever reason, during such sixty (60) day period, Owner shall delay taking action so long as Licensee shall have begun to cure such breach within such period and thereafter proceeds diligently to complete the cure of the breach and such breach is cured within a reasonable period thereafter; provided , further , that if the breach is not curable, then Owner shall be entitled to immediately terminate this Agreement and exercise any other rights or remedies it may have hereunder or as otherwise provided by law upon giving notice in writing of the breach to Licensee.
          (b) In the event of a breach by Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. (“CCO”) of any provision of that certain Master Agreement, dated ___, 2005, between CCU and CCO, that certain Corporate Services Agreement, dated ___, 2005, between Clear Channel Management Services, L.P. and CCO, that certain Tax Matters Agreement, dated ___, 2005, between CCU and CCO, or that certain Employee Matters Agreement, dated ___, 2005, between CCU and CCO (collectively, the “Intercompany Agreements”), and the failure of CCO to cure (if permitted) such breach as provided in the applicable Intercompany Agreement, Owner shall be entitled to immediately terminate this Agreement and exercise any other rights or remedies it may have hereunder or as otherwise provided by law upon giving notice in writing of the breach to Licensee.
          (c) In the event of a Change of Control (as defined below), Owner, subject to the Transitional Period (as defined in Section 9(a)), shall be entitled to immediately terminate this Agreement and exercise any other rights or remedies it may have hereunder or otherwise provided by law upon giving written notice to Licensee. For purposes of this Section 8(c), “Change of Control” means the occurrence of any event or circumstances that result in CCU ceasing to beneficially own, directly or indirectly, more than fifty percent (50%) of the total voting power of the common stock of CCO.
          (d) Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, this Agreement may be terminated by mutual consent of Owner and Licensee.

3


 

          (e) Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, Owner’s rights of termination under Sections 8(a) , 8(b) and 8(c) and the parties’ rights of termination under Section 8(d) may be exercised with respect to less than all of the Marks by giving written notice to such effect, and in the event that Owner or the parties exercise their respective rights of termination with respect to less than all of the Marks, this Agreement shall continue in full force and effect with respect to the rest of the Marks.
     9.  Effect of Termination .
          (a) In the event of a termination pursuant to Section 7 or Section 8(c), Licensee (i) shall refrain from further use of the Marks, or any mark or name reasonably deemed by Owner to be similar thereto, in connection with the manufacture, sale, offering, distribution or promotion of goods or services; (ii) shall not operate its business in any manner which would falsely suggest to the public that the License is still in force or that any relationship exists between Owner and Licensee; and (iii) shall return all confidential information and promotional materials to Owner or destroy said materials and notify Owner in writing of their destruction. Licensee shall fully comply with this provision before the one year anniversary of the effective date of termination (such period between the date of termination and such one year anniversary is referred to herein as the “Transitional Period”).
          (b) During the Transitional Period, Licensee may wish to transition to use of a new mark owned by Licensee and phase out the use of the Marks gradually. In connection with such transition, Licensee may wish to utilize such new mark simultaneously with the Marks. In the event Licensee desires to utilize both the Marks and a new mark simultaneously during the Transitional Period, Licensee shall provide at least thirty (30) calendar days prior written notice to Owner of such proposed use, along with a rendering of the proposed usage. Owner shall have a period of thirty (30) calendar days following receipt of such notice and rendition in which to give or withhold its approval of such transitional usage and Owner shall be deemed to not have approved such transitional usage if Owner does not deliver to Licensee its written approval thereof within such thirty (30) calendar day period. Owner shall not unreasonably withhold or delay its approval, but such approval shall not be deemed to be unreasonable if (i) the proposed usage of the Marks with the new mark creates, in Owner’s reasonable business judgment, a composite mark that includes any of the Marks, (ii) if the new mark proposed to be used by Licensee in addition to the Marks is confusingly similar to any Mark, or (iii) if the proposed usage is derogatory or coveys a negative connotation with respect to Owner or any Mark.
          (c) In the event of a termination pursuant to any other subsection of Section 8, there shall be no Transitional Period, all rights granted to Licensee hereunder shall cease immediately except as provided in the last sentence of this Section 9(c), and Licensee (i) shall refrain from further use of the Marks, or any mark or name reasonably deemed by Owner to be similar thereto, in connection with the manufacture, sale, offering, distribution or promotion of goods or services; (ii) shall not operate its business in any manner which would falsely suggest to the public that the License is still in force

4


 

or that any relationship exists between Owner and Licensee; and (iii) shall return all confidential information and promotional materials to Owner or destroy said materials and notify Owner in writing of their destruction. Licensee shall have sixty (60) days from the effective date of termination to fully comply with this provision.
     10.  Indemnification . Owner shall indemnify and hold Licensee harmless from all costs including, without limitation, reasonable attorneys’ fees, incurred as a result of all claims asserted by third persons arising out of any allegations of infringement of the rights of any third party due to the authorized use of the Marks by Licensee pursuant to this Agreement. Licensee shall indemnify and hold Owner harmless from all costs including, without limitation, reasonable attorneys’ fees, incurred as a result of all claims asserted by third persons arising out of any allegations of infringement of the rights of any third party due to any use of the Marks by Licensee that is not authorized pursuant to this Agreement.
     11.  Assignability . Licensee shall have the right to sublicense, assign or transfer the License to any person or other legal or business entity at the time controlling, controlled by or under common control with the Licensee; provided that, as used in this Section 11, “control” shall mean ownership or control, directly or indirectly, of at least 50% of the outstanding stock or other voting rights entitled to elect directors or, if the legal or business entity is not a corporation, the corresponding managing authority.
     12.  Covenant by Owner . Owner shall be responsible for the costs and responsibilities relating to the maintenance, monitoring, and defense of the Marks. Owner shall take whatever steps are reasonable or necessary to ensure that any registrations issued with respect to the Marks which are current on the date hereof remain current including, without limitation, the timely filing with the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office of any and all documents necessary to secure the renewal or incontestability of the Marks. To the extent Licensee’s assistance is needed in relation to these activities, Licensee shall reasonably cooperate with Owner at the expense of Licensee.
     13.  Notice . Any notices required or permitted to be given under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given when received if personally delivered; when transmitted if transmitted by telecopy, electronic or digital transmission method; the day after it is sent, if sent for next day delivery by a recognized overnight delivery service (e.g., Federal Express); and upon receipt, if sent by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested. In each case, the notice shall be addressed to the party to be notified at its address shown in the preamble to this Agreement, or at such other address as may be furnished in writing to the notifying party.
     14.  Relationship . Nothing contained herein shall be construed to the parties in the relationship of franchisor/franchisee, partners or joint venturers, it being agreed and understood that each party is an independent contractor and is not an agent or employee of the other party.

5


 

     15.  Severability . If any term or other provision of this Agreement is determined by a court of competent jurisdiction to be invalid, illegal, or incapable of being enforced under any rule of applicable law, or public policy, all other conditions and provisions of this Agreement shall nevertheless remain in full force and effect so long as the economic or legal substance of the transactions contemplated herein are not affected in any manner materially adverse to any party. Upon such determination that any term or other provision is invalid, illegal, or incapable of being enforced, the parties hereto shall negotiate in good faith to modify this Agreement so as to effect the original intent of the parties as closely as possible in a mutually acceptable manner in order that the transactions contemplated herein are consummated as originally contemplated to the fullest extent possible.
     16.  Entire Agreement . This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement between the parties with respect to the matters contained herein and supersedes all prior negotiations, understandings and agreements, whether written or oral, between the parties with respect to the matters contained herein, including but not limited to the Original Agreement.
     17.  Amendments . This Agreement shall not be modified or amended except by an instrument in writing signed by both parties.
     18.  No Implied Warranties . Neither party makes any warranty or representation to the other except as specifically set forth herein.
     19.  Further Documents . Each party shall, upon request, make, execute and deliver such documents as shall be reasonably necessary to take such action as may be reasonably requested to fully implement and carry out the purposes of the License.
     20.  Captions . The captions contained herein are for convenience and reference only and in no way define, describe, extend, or limit the scope or intent of this Agreement or the intent of any provisions contained herein.
     21.  Parties in Interest . This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure solely to the benefit of each party hereto and their permitted successors, assigns and transferees, and nothing in this Agreement express or implied, is intended to confer upon any other person any rights or remedies of any nature whatsoever under or by reason of this Agreement.
     22.  Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts each of which shall be deemed an original and all of which shall be deemed one and the same Agreement.
     23.  Governing Law . This Agreement shall be construed, interpreted and enforced in accordance with, and the respective rights and obligations of the parties hereto shall be governed by, the laws of the State of Texas.
[Remainder of page intentionally blank]

6


 

     IN WITNESS OF WHEREOF this Agreement has been duly executed, effective as of the day and year first above written.
     
 
  OWNER:
 
   
 
  CLEAR CHANNEL IDENTITY, L.P.
 
   
 
  By:
 
 
 
 
  Name:
 
 
 
 
  Title:
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
  LICENSEE:
 
   
 
  OUTDOOR MANAGEMENT SERVICES, INC.
 
   
 
  By:
 
 
 
 
  Name:
 
 
 
 
  Title:
 
 
 

7

 

Exhibit 15.1
The following report is in the form that will be signed upon the completion of the transaction described in Basis of Presentation of Note A to the financial statements.
/s/ Ernst & Young LLP
San Antonio, Texas
October 24, 2005
October 20, 2005
The Board of Directors
Clear Channel Communications, Inc.
We are aware of the inclusion in the Registration Statement (Form S-1 No. 333-127375) of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. for the registration of ___shares of its Class A common stock of our report dated October 20, 2005 relating to the unaudited combined interim financial statements of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. for the nine-months ended September 30, 2005.

 

Exhibit 23.1
The following report is in the form that will be signed upon the completion of the transaction described in the Basis of Presentation in Note A to the financial statements.
/s/ Ernst & Young LLP
San Antonio, Texas
October 24, 2005
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
We consent to the reference to our firm under the caption “Experts” and to the use of our reports dated August 4, 2005 (except as to Basis of Presentation of Note A, as to which date is __________ ___, 2005), in Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement (Form S-1 No. 333-127375) and related Prospectus of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc.
San Antonio, Texas

 

Exhibit 99.1

CLEAR CHANNEL OUTDOOR HOLDINGS, INC.

Consent of Prospective Director

As required by Rule 438 under the U.S. Securities Act of 1933, as amended, I hereby consent to the reference to my name as a prospective director of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc. in the section entitled “Management” in the prospectus forming a part of a registration statement on Form S-1 of Clear Channel Outdoor Holdings, Inc., initially filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission on or about August 9, 2005, as amended from time to time.
         
     
  /s/ James M. Raines    
  James M. Raines   
     
 

Dated: October 21, 2005